Loading...
HomeMy WebLinkAboutA13-0026 details ��'�'�Gt I�Hl?r"1�C?�::�:�:,�r � F'�HD'�r' TI� F�F;d�� 6160 �- � ALPHA DISPLAY KEYPAD �� ����l7ISRf�hIE����� i �°_ � kE�tG�4` �� ��:fi� � WITH DOOR ATTACHED �,� ,,.� f „ p W �j „ � n.�_ ..� ,� .. s i s�... mr �,.-. e _, v._ _.. •,_, 17 A' WITHOUT DOOR The 6160 Deluxe Keypad is easy to install and simple to The oversized function keys are easily accessed even when use. The attractive white console blends with any decor and the keypad door is closed, and can be programmed for fire, features a contoured, removable door that conceals burglary, personal emergencies and other operations. Colored illuminated soft-touch keys. The 6160 also features a new self-adhesive labels are included. larger and brighter 32-character display with easy-to-read plain-English status messages. FEATURES • Large, easy-to-use keypad • Zones and system events displayed • System functions clearly labeled • Keys continuously backlit for greater in plain English • Functions performed by just entering visibility • No confusing blinking lights security code plus command • Speaker with audible beeps • Four programmable function keys • White with removable door blends to indicate: with any decor - System status - Entry/exit delay - Other alarm situations SPECIFICATIONS Physical Wiring Compatibility • 5-5/16"H x 7-3/8"W x 1-3/16"D • - (Black): Ground • Fully compatible with all (135mm x 190mm x 30mm) . + (Red): +12 VDC (Aux. Power) VISTA controls. Current • D1 (Green): "Data in"to control panel • Standby-40mA • DO (Yellow):"Data out"from •Activated Transmission-160mA control panel ORDERING 6160 Alpha Display Keypad Honeywell Security&Custom Electronics ����_,,,,,"��� Honeywell International Inc. ��'V� PO Box 9035 cooso,o Syosset, NY 11791 U6160/D September 2006 www.honeywell.com OO 2006 Honeywell International Inc. K3590-ADV2 4/04 Rev.A HOI1eyWell ADEMCO 6150 & 6160 REMOTE KEYPADS INSTALLATION AND SETUP GUIDE Keypad Features �EMCO 6150 ADEMCO 6160 Fixed-Word 2-Line Alpha Backlit Display YES(see note) YES(see note) Dedicated Function Keys YES YES Built-in Sounder Piezo Speaker Note:Permanent display backlighting is an option on some controls(see the control's instructions for details). GENERAL INFORMATION WIRING AND INSTALLATION The ADEMCO 6150 and ADEMCO 6160 are addressable The keypads can be surface mounted directly to a drywall,or to Remote Keypads designed for use with ADEMCO control a single-or double-gang electrical box. panels.Addresses are set via the keypad keys. 1. Remove the case back by pushing down two "snaps." The keys on the keypads are continuously backlit for See diagram below. convenience. 2. Route wiring from the control panel through the KEYPAD DISPLAYS AND LEDS opening in the case back. The keypads have the following display features: 3. Mount the case back to a wall or electrical box. Fixed 2-line Custom 4. Wire directly from the keypad's terminal block to the Model Word Alpha 2-digit Zone Zone terminal block on the control board as follows: Display Display Identifier Descriptors Wiring Table(All Keypads) 6150 X X Key ad Control Panel Wire Color 6160 X X G Data In Green Aux Pwr(GND) Black + +Aux.Pwr Red The following table shows the LEDs and their functions: y Data Out Yellow LED Function See the control panel's Installation and Setup Guide for Red Lights when the system is armed in any mode more complete details. Green Lights when the system is"ready"to be armed. 5. Reattach the keypad to its case back. SPECIAL FUNCTION KEYS The keypads also feature function keys. These keys may be programmed for panic alarms or other special functions such � as macros. See the control's instructions for details. � % .a�EO o � / Function keys must be held down for at "`"°"° � �� least 2 seconds to activate an alarm, key � pairs activate immediately. 0 NOTE: TO REMOVE CASE BACK � Function Keys PUSH IN THE TWO MOUNTING � SNAPS LOCATED ALONG THE A OT �l� a11C1 �*� BOTTOM OFTHE KEYPAD AND LIFT UP. °� � 0 O �:j B or [*] and [#] C or [3] and [#] \ ' i � D RETAINING � SNAPS SETTING THE KEYPAD ADDRESS FUNCTION KEY LABELS The keypad can either be set for an address of 00-30, or to A set of adhesive-backed labels with some typical function the non-addressable mode (31). The keypad's default symbols (i.e., fire, police, personal emergency, etc.) is provided. address is 31. These labels can be placed on or next to the keys to identify To change the keypad's address,do the following: each key's function for the end user (as determined by the 1. Enter address mode: Power up the keypad. Within 60 control panel's capability and programming; see the control's seconds of power-up, press and hold down the [1] and [3] instructions). keys at the same time for 3 seconds. (If unable to enter address mode,power up and try again.) SPECIFICATIONS The current keypad address will be displayed, and the physical• cursor will be under the "tens" digit. If 10 seconds have 6150: 4-7/8°H x 6-1/4"W x 1"D passed with no key entry, the keypad automatically 6160: 5-5/16°H x 7-3/8"W x 1-3/16"D exits address mode. You must power down, power up and start address mode again. Displays: NOTE: The keypad will not enter address mode if the 6150: Fixed-Word LCD(backlit). panel to which it is connected is in programming mode. 6160: 2 x 16 alpha-numeric supertwist LCD,backlit. 2. Set the current address to "00": Press [0] to clear the current "tens" digit. The cursor will move to the "ones" Sounder: digit position. Press [0] to clear the current "ones" digit. 6150: Piezo-electric(fire alarm is loud,pulsing single The cursor will move back to the"tens"digit position. tone;(all Keypads)burglary alarm is loud, 3. Enter the keypad's address:Enter the proper"tens" digit continuous, dual tone). of the keypad's address. The cursor will move to the 6160: Speaker. "ones" dig�t position. Enter the proper"ones" digit of the keypad's address. Note that address "31" sets the Voltage: keypad to non-addressable mode. 12VDC 4. Exit address mode: Press [�k] to save the displayed address and exit address Current: mode. 6150: 70mA (ARMED LED lit, LCD backlight and sounder on), reduces to 40mA when panel is VIEWING THE KEYPAD ADDRESS operating in standby mode(backlight off). Press and hold down the [1] and [3] keys at the same time 6160: 150mA (ARMED LED lit, LCD backlight and for about 3 seconds. The current address is displayed. No sounder on), reduces to 40mA when panel is key entry is allowed. Press any key to exit or wait 10 operating in standby mode(backlight off�. seconds to exit viewing mode. REFER TO INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS FOR THE CONTROL PANEL WITH WHICH THIS DEVICE IS USED FOR WAR,RANTY INFORMATION AND LIMITATIONS OF THE ENTIRE ALAR,M SYSTEM. Honeywell 165 Eileen Way, Syosset, New York 11791 Copyright OO 2004 Honeywell International Inc. www.honeywell.com/security II I II II II II I I II I II I II II I II I III I I III II III K3590-ADV2 4/04 Rev.A UOXX.S789 - Control Unit Accessories, System Page 1 of 2 uL �!NLIHE CERTIFICATION� dIRECT�R�' UOXX.S789 Control Unit Accessories, System Paae Bottom Control Unit Accessories, System See General Information for Control Unit Accessories.Svstem HONEYWELL SECURITY 5789 SUITE 100 2 CORPORATE CENTER DR PO BOX 9040 MELVILLE, NY 11747 USA Backup dialer modules, Model(s) 5140DLM Eight-zone remote point Class A interface modules, Model(s)4208SNF Eight-zone remote point modules, Model(s)4208SN,4208U Enclosures, Model(s) 5800BOX End-of-line resistors, Model(s)4100EOLR, EOL100, EOL20, EOL22, EOL82, EOLR470K Fire system annunciator keyswitch modules, Model(s) FSAKSM (d) Fire system annunciator modules, Model(s) FSA-24F, FSA-8F Internet and Digital Cellular Fire Communicator, Model(s) iPGSM-COM, IPGSM-DP Internet communicators, Model(s) 7845i-ent,7845i-entF(c) Isolation modules, Model(s) ECP-Isolator,VPLEX-VSI Keyswitches, Model(s)4146(a) LCD keypads, Model(s)6160CR-2, FA570CR Polling loop extender modules, Model(s)4297 RF receivers, Model(s) 5881ENHC RF transceiver subassemblies, Model(s) 5883H Sensor Interface Module Gateway, Model(s)472368 Supervised notification appliance modules, Model(s)4204CF Transformers, Model(s) 1451 Universal group zoning multiplex modules, Model(s)4209U Wireless transmitters, Model(s) 5817CB Zone expander modules, Model(s)4190SN,41935N (b),4193SNP(b) (a) - Must be installed adjacent to an alphanumeric(English language) keypad, Model 6160CR-2 when used as a fire alarm silencing switch. (b) - Must be mounted inside control panel cabinet or within a Listed junction box. Supervised Zone is required for Fire. Unsupervised Zone may be http://database.ul.com/cgi-bin/XYV/template/LISEXT/1 FRAME/showpage.html?name=U... 8/3 0/2011 UOXX.S789 - Control Unit Accessories, System Page 2 of 2 used for Burglary. (c)- For use with Model FOCUS 200 PLUS control unit. (d) - Keyswitch module must be installed adjacent to FSA unit if remote silence/reset desired. NOTE-Model numbers may include a prefix or suffix consisting of numbers and/or letters. For use with compatible Listed control unit systems as indicated in the installation instructions. Last Uodated on 2011-07-18 Ouestions? Print this oaqe Notice of Disclaimer Paae Tob Coovriqht c0 2011 Underwriters Laboratories Inc.00 The appearance of a company's name or product in this database does not in itself assure that products so identified have been manufactured under UL's Follow-Up Service. Only those products bearing the UL Mark should be considered to be Listed and covered under UL's Follow-Up Service.Always look for the Mark on the product. UL permits the reproduction of the material contained in the Online Certification Directory subject to the following conditions: 1.The Guide Information, Designs and/or Listings(files) must be presented in their entirety and in a non-misleading manner,without any manipulation of the data (or drawings). 2.The statement"Reprinted from the Online Certifications Directory with permission from Underwriters Laboratories Inc." must appear adjacent to the extracted material. In addition,the reprinted material must include a copyright notice in the following format: "Copyright �O 2011 Underwriters Laboratories Inc.00" A i �c�::p e n d r n i �r G a ri :a E G n v.��i h i n p I �. . .. . . . . . . _. . r i,�. . , . . . .� : � r,� � , . .� . i����.�, �::.�...�.:-- http://database.ul.com/cgi-bin/XYV/template/LISEXT/1 FRAME/showpage.html?name=U... 8/3 0/2011 � -�, � -n r � � r 'o m C� c � .r� a � ,p � � ° m � mo � p � m c o � � � � c �, � � �cp r r n° -+ � (� � z � �p C� = � � � � N -� W m � _ -°o � cny � � + � � m � ��-,� cn ino c`''n Z d C -e N r• z-p y � cD z � C� z � �O p' �p C1 Q. � O � N oi � � � � V !�P � ri o�i � �^ N � � � � 6y �� 3 � � �. � � aoN -�s o �* -': Z,�v m X � o D � � o m � C � � �' p� y 7 n rt � O n N' �'c p1 N' � � a d Q.'o � y � t°'/� � fD O cn "'' � o- � (A cau � o' o -' ^ .o• � c�n. _ � °� � ,� �' e�t � � -o r+ � c� . � d < cu � � a m -p d cn 0. � o � � n" I/l � � O � � N � � � � y � � � � �. m d c6n � oo c� -< � °— � o � o u�i � -��+ O• - � 3 3 co C� � c ,�+ � � � � x � � = � -1 v� 7' �• n m r -i � � N � y C� �C � � p � N <D T. z O m p ,� '+ d � 'a � � N �' p � n r � O � � n � � � Q. 3 � Z ,� r�+ � � p O p D � � ?, 6 � � (�p � CD 0 � � N � � fD � y N � C �' �n( � 0 v y 7 �. N � (p � '� � 3 z � Z � O � O O �, a � � m � 2 � C cn � O "p d � � p y � . f� m C < O n Q �, y � d �1 R�'� N ,�-r lL� `� .� p � fD r* � �' < � m � p) � � O � � N � O �' � m O "� � � R1 n. C� V {A 01 � r* p � � v � � 3 a � < d C l� �• o ,,,� � (p � � � � � cn � 0 5 < � �n 3 m � a � p � � = N � � � N 3 N O � 7 � O C tn r �*, � � < 3• �• -s r � (n �C O v r(n..� tp -i � . � w � r e V/ TA- P 5 V/ TA- P L 5 PARTITIONED SECURITY SYSTEM with SCHEDULING INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS and PROGRAMMING GUIDE i4�EMC0 N5944-6V1 Rev B 4/99 � : � � HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL .........................................................vii CONVENTI ONS USED I N TH I S MANUAL ................................. viii RECOMMENDATIONS FOR PROPER PROTECTION ............... ix Section 1: GENERAL DESCRIPTION ............................................................... 01 Section 2: PLANNING A PARTITIONED SYSTEM ........................................ 05 TheoryofPartitioning ............................................................................05 Setting Up a Partitioned System...........................................................05 CommonLobby Logic............................................................................. 06 Master Keypad Setup and Operation ...................................................OS Section 3: I NSTALLI NG TH E CONTROL ........................................................ 10 Mountingthe Cabinet ............................................................................ 10 VISTA-50PUL GradeA Mercantile Premises Listing ......................... 11 VISTA-50PUL GradeA MercantileSafeAnd Vault Listing ............... 11 I nstalling the Circuit Board .................................................................. 12 Standard Phone Line Connections ........................................................12 Connecting theAC Transformer ........................................................... 13 I nstal ling the Backup Battery ............................................................... 15 Earth Ground Considerations ............................................................... 15 Section 4: THE MECHANICSOF PROGRAMMING .......................................16 Using Data Field Program Mode........................................................... 16 System and Communication Defaults................................................... 16 Entering Data Field Program Mode......................................................16 Moving From One Page of Programming to Another .......................... 17 Viewing Data Fields............................................................................... 17 EntryErrors ...........................................................................................17 Programming System Wide dta fields ..................................................18 Programming Partition Specific Data Fields........................................ 18 #93 Menu Mode Programming .............................................................. 19 Section 5: INSTALLING THE KEYPADS ......................................................... 20 KeypadsThat May BeUsed ..................................................................20 WiringtotheKeypads ...........................................................................20 Using a Supplementary Power Supply .................................................21 Mountingthe Keypads ...........................................................................22 Addressing the Keypads/Preliminary Checkout ..................................22 Programming the Keypads ....................................................................23 -i - Section 6: BASIC HARDWIRED ZONES 1-9 .................................................... 25 Common Characteristics of Hardwired Zones ......................................25 Wiring Burglary and Panic Devices to ones 1-8 ..................................25 Wiring 2-Wire Smoke Detectors toZone 1 ............................................26 Compatible 2-Wire Smoke Detectors ....................................................27 Unsupervised Usageof Zone 1 ..............................................................27 Wiring 4-Wire Smoke Detectors to Zones 1-8 .......................................27 Compatible4-Wire Smoke Detetors ......................................................28 Configuring Zone 7 for Alternate Keyswitch Function ........................29 Wiring 2-Wire Glassbreak Detectors to Zone 8 ....................................29 Compatible Glassbreak Detectors .........................................................30 Zone9 Applications................................................................................30 Programming Hardwired Zones ............................................................ 30 Checkout Procedurefor Hardwired Zones............................................32 Section 7: POLLING LOOP ZONES 10-86 ........................................................ 33 Polling Loop Overview ...........................................................................33 Common Characteristics of Polling Loop Zones ...................................33 Wiring/Addressing Polling Loop Devices ..............................................33 Polling Loop Limitations........................................................................ 34 Polling Loop Supervision .......................................................................35 Programming Polling Loop Zones .........................................................36 Checkout Procedurefor Polling Loop Zones .........................................38 Compatible Polling Loop Devices ..........................................................39 Section 8: WIRELESS (RF) ZONE EXPANSION ............................................ 41 Common Characteristics of Wireless Zones..........................................41 Wireless Systems Available...................................................................41 Wireless System Operation and Supervision .......................................42 WirelessSystem Installation Advisories ..............................................42 I nstallation and Setup of 4281/5881 RF Receivers ..............................43 Installation/Wiringofthe5800TM Module ..........................................44 Programming The Wireless Receiver ....................................................44 HouselD Sniffer Mode...........................................................................45 5700 Series Transmitter Setup .............................................................46 Wireless Zone Assignments for 5700 Series Transmitters ..................47 Compatible 5700 Series Transmitters ..................................................48 5800 Series Transmitter Setup .............................................................49 Compatible 5800 Series Transmitters ..................................................50 Programming Wireless Transmitters ................................................... 52 Checkout Procedurefor WirelessZones................................................55 Section 9: RELAY OUTPUTS & POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES ......... 56 Output Device Basics............................................................................. 56 Wiring the4204 Relay Module.............................................................. 56 Wiring the4300 Transformer ................................................................57 Programming the4204 Relay Module ..................................................58 Output Programming Options Defined .................................................58 Programming Output Devices ............................................................... 60 ZoneList Programming .........................................................................63 Rel ay V oi ce D escr i pt or s .........................................................................63 -ii- Section 10: 4285VISTAINTERACTIVE PHONE (VIP) MODULE ................ 66 General Information ..............................................................................65 Mountingthe4285VIPModule ...........................................................65 Wiring the 4285 VI P Module .................................................................66 Programming 4285 VI P Module Options..............................................67 Custom Word Substitutesfor VIP ModuleAnnunciation ....................68 Section 11: AUDIO ALARM VERIFICATION (AAV) UNIT ............................. 6A General Information ..............................................................................69 AAV Module Operation ..........................................................................69 AAV Module Connections ......................................................................70 Programming AudioAlarm Verification Module Options ................... 70 Section 12: VOLTAGE TRIGGERS (Connector J7) ......................................... T2 General Information ..............................................................................72 Ground Start Trigger Setup ..................................................................74 Open/Close Trigger Setup ......................................................................75 Remote Keypad Sounder ........................................................................ 75 KeyswitchSetup .....................................................................................76 AuxiliaryAlarm Signaling Equipment (7720, 7920SE)....................... 78 Section 13: EXTERNAL SOUNDERS .................................................................. T9 GeneralInformation ..............................................................................79 Wiring ..................................................................................................... 79 UL985 Household Fire Installations.....................................................79 UL1023&UL609 Commercial Burglary Installations.......................... 80 Non-UL I nstallations .............................................................................80 Programming External Sounders..........................................................80 Compatible Sounders and Siren Drivers ..............................................81 Section 14: EVENT LOG OPTIONS ..................................................................... ffi GeneralI nformation ..............................................................................� Event Log Printer Connections .............................................................82 Programming Event Log Options ..........................................................83 Event Logging Procedures ..................................................................... 83 Section 15: FINAL POWER-UP PROCEDURE.................................................. �6 GeneralInformation ..............................................................................86 Earth Ground Considerations ...............................................................86 Connecting theAC Transformer ...........................................................86 Programming Power And AC Options ..................................................88 Polling Loop Current Draw Worksheet ................................................88 Auxiliary DeviceCurrent Draw Worksheet..........................................88 Connecting The Battery.........................................................................89 Section 16: FALSE ALARM REDUCTION FEATURES....................................90 GeneralInformation ..............................................................................90 ExitError Logic......................................................................................90 ExitDelay Reset .....................................................................................90 CrossZoning ...........................................................................................91 Call Waiting Defeat ...............................................................................91 -iii - Section 17: ZONE TYPE DEFINITIONS............................................................. � Section 18: DATA FI ELD DESCRI PTIONS........................................................ 94 Section 19: #93 MENU MODE PROGRAMMING ............................................ 108 #93 Main Menu Options ......................................................................108 ZoneProgrammi ng............................................................................... 110 Learning Serial Numbers .................................................................... 111 Programming Alpha Descriptors......................................................... 113 Alpha Descriptor Vocabulary And Character (ASCI I) Chart ............ 117 Device Programming ............................................................................ 118 Relay Voice Descriptors .......................................................................119 CustomWord I ndex ............................................................................. 121 Section 20: SCHEDULING OPTIONS ............................................................... 122 Introduction ToScheduling .................................................................122 Time Window Definitions .................................................................... 124 Open/Close Schedule Definitions......................................................... 125 Programming with #80 Scheduling Menu Mode ................................126 BasicScheduling Menu Structure....................................................... 127 Time Window Definitions Worksheet ................................................. 128 Programming Time Windows .............................................................. 129 Open/Close Worksheet .........................................................................129 Programming Open/Close Schedules ..................................................130 Holiday Definitions & Schedule Worksheet .......................................131 Programming Holiday Schedules ........................................................131 Time Driven Event Worksheet ............................................................ 132 Programming Time Driven Events .....................................................134 Limitation of Access by Time Worksheet ............................................ 136 Programming Access Control Schedules ............................................ 136 #81 Temporary Schedule Menu Mode................................................. 137 Programming Temporary Schedules................................................... 138 #83 U ser Sch ed u I i n g M en u M od e ........................................................139 Section 21: SYSTEM COMMUNICATION ........................................................ 141 A Successful Transmission .................................................................. 141 ReportingFormats ............................................................................... 141 Loading Communication Defaults....................................................... 144 Section 22: DOWNLOADING PRIMER ............................................................. 150 General Information ............................................................................ 150 Getting On-Linewith a Control Panel ................................................150 On-Line Control Functions .................................................................. 151 AccessSecu r i t y ..................................................................................... 152 Connecting a 4100SM Module for Direct Wire Downloading ............ 153 Section 23: SETTI N G TH E REAL-TI M E CLOCK ............................................ 154 GeneralInformation ............................................................................ 154 Setting theTime and Date .................................................................. 154 -iv- Section 24: SECURITY ACCESS CODES ..........................................................155 General Information ............................................................................ 155 User Codes and Levels of Authority.................................................... 155 ToADD, a Master, Manager or Operator Code.................................. 158 ToCHANGE a Master, Manager, or Operator Code ......................... 159 Adding an RF Key to an Existing User ............................................... 160 To DELETE a Master, Manager, or Operator Code........................... 160 To EXIT the User Edit Mode ............................................................... 160 Section 25: KEYPAD FUNCTIONS .................................................................... 161 General Information ............................................................................ 161 Arming Functions ................................................................................ 161 GlobalArming ......................................................................................162 AccessControl ......................................................................................163 Delay Closing Time .............................................................................. 163 Partition "GO TO" Command .............................................................. 163 Viewing Capabilities of a User ............................................................ 163 Viewing Zone Descriptors .................................................................... 163 Viewing Downloaded Messages........................................................... 164 Using the Built-in User's Manual ....................................................... 164 PanicKeys ............................................................................................ 164 Speed KeY ��l �M acros)........................................................................ 164 Manual RelayActivation Mode(#70).................................................. 165 Section 26: TESTING THE SYSTEM ................................................................. 166 UsingTest Mode................................................................................... 166 ArmedSystem Test .............................................................................. 167 Turning the System Over to the User ................................................. 167 TotheInstaller .....................................................................................167 Trouble Conditions............................................................................... 168 REGULATORY AGENCY STATEMENTS.................................... 170 DIP SWITCH TABLES..................................................................... 174 SUMMARYOF SYSTEM COMMANDS ........................................ 177 SPECI FI CATI ONS ........................................................................... 178 PROGRAM FORM/SYSTEM WORKSHEET ..................Bluelnsert SUMMARY OF CONNECTIONS DIAGRAM ... Inside Back Cover -v - LI ST O F FI GU RES 1. I nstalling The Lock ..........................................................................10 2. Cabinet Attack Resistance Considerations ..................................... 11 3. Mounting The PC Board .................................................................. 12 4. Standard Phone Line Connections ..................................................13 5. AC Power And Battery Connections ............................................... 14 6. 4300 Transformer Connections........................................................14 7. Keypad ConnectionstoKeypad Port Terminals.............................21 8. Using a Supplementary Power Supply for Additional Keypads ....22 9. Zones 1-9 Wiring Connections .........................................................25 10. Wiring 2-Wire Smoke Detectors to Zone 1 ......................................26 11. 4-Wire Smoke Detector Power Reset Using 4204 Relay Module ...28 12. Wiring Latching Glassbreak DetectorstoZone8 ...........................29 13. Pol I i n g L oop Con n ect i on s.................................................................34 14. Polling Loop Extender Module Wiring ............................................35 15, 5881 RF Receiver (showing receiver setup) ....................................43 16. 4204 Module......................................................................................57 17. 4300 Transformer Connections........................................................57 18. 4285 Voice Module Connections ......................................................67 19. AudioAlarm Verification Module Connections ..............................71 20. J7 Connector For Voltage Triggers .................................................73 21. Ground Start Module Connections..................................................74 22. Remote Keypad Sounding Connections...........................................75 23. Remote Keyswitch Wiring ...............................................................77 24. Auxiliary Alarm Signaling Equipment ...........................................78 25. External Sounder Connections ........................................................79 26. AB12 Bell Box Wiring ......................................................................80 27. Event Log Printer Connections .......................................................82 28. 1321 Transformer and Battery Connections ..................................87 29. 4300 Transformer Connections........................................................87 30. Direct Wire Downloading Connections (With 4100SM Module).. 153 Summary Of Connections Diagram ............... I nside Back Cover -vi- HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL This manual is written to accommodate both the new and the experienced installer of Ademco products. A general description of the entire system is located at the beginning of the manual, followed by the basics of programming. The wiring and physical setup of the hardware follows. The sections at the core of the manual include both hardware setup and programming requirements of each device to make that specific device operational in the system. A checkout procedure is included at the end of each section. We recommend this method to ensure that each device is working properly before proceeding to the next section. It must also be used if you are making a particular addition to the system of one of these devices. Each of the sections covering the installation of peripheral devices includes the programming for that device. If you are an experienced user of Ademco products, you may choose to wire and then program the entire system at once. If so, refer to Sections 18 through 20 (for complete system programming options) after the hardware setup is complete. A blank pull-out programming form is included with this manual. Use this in addition to the #93 and #80 Menu modes for complete system programming options. Without an understanding of the programming methodology, you will not be able to successfully perform the required programming in each of these sections. We therefore urge you to read Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING before any programming is performed. This manual uses various icons to denote critical notes and technical tips to assist you with the installation of this system. These are easily seen in the lefthand column of the relevent information. —vii— � � � � � . � � � . Before you begin using this manual, it is important that you understand the meaning of the following symbols (icons). U L These notes include specific information which must be followed if you are installing this system for a UL Listed application. /�,'� These notes include information that you should be aware of before continuing L�� with the installation, and which, if not observed, could result in operational difficulties. This symbol indicates a critical note that could seriously affect the operation of ' the system, or could cause damage to the system. Please read each warning • carefully. This symbol also denotes warnings about physical harm to the installer. Enter Zn Num. (00 = Quit) 01 Many system options are programmed in an interactive mode by responding to Alpha keypad display prompts. These prompts are shown in a double-line box. *�� When programming the system, data fields are indicated by a "star" (') followed by the data field number. PRODUCT MODEL NUMBERS: Unless noted otherwise, references to specific model numbers represent Ademco products. —viii— � � � � � � � ' . � ' . ' . � � The Following Recommendations For The Location Of Fire And Burglary Detection Devices Help Provide Proper Coverage For The Protected Premises. Recommendations For Smoke And Heat Detectors With regard to the number and placement of smoke/heat detectors, we subscribe to the recommendations contained in the National Fire Protection Association's (NFPA) Standard #72 noted below. Early warning fire detection is best achieved by the installation of fire detection equipment in all rooms and areas of the household as follows: For minimum protection a smoke detector should be installed outside of each separate sleeping area, and on each additional floor of a multi-floor family living unit, including basements. The installation of smoke detectors in kitchens, attics (finished or unfinished), or in garages is not normally recommended. For additional protection the NFPA recommends that you install heat or smoke detectors in the living room, dining room, bedroom(s), kitchen, hallway(s), attic, furnace room, utility and storage rooms, basements and attached garages. In addition, we recommend the following: • Install a smoke detector inside every bedroom where a smoker sleeps. • Install a smoke detector inside every bedroom where someone sleeps with the door partly or completely closed. Smoke could be blocked by the closed door. Also, an alarm in the hallway outside may not wake up the sleeper if the door is closed. • Install a smoke detector inside bedrooms where electrical appliances (such as portable heaters, air conditioners or humidifiers)are used. • Install a smoke detector at both ends of a hallway if the hallway is more than 40 feet (12 meters) long. • Install smoke detectors in any room where an alarm control is located, or in any room where alarm control connections to an AC source or phone lines are made. If detectors are not so located, a fire within the room could prevent the control from reporting a fire or an intrusion. KITCHEN 0 � 0 � � 0 DIN�ING - BEDROOM BEDR00 N ROOM KITCHEN DINING BDRM ■ LIVING ROOM Q BDRMQ � � 0 LIVING ROOM BEDROOM BEDROOM 0 � �Smoke Detectors for Minimum Protection . Q Smoke Detectors for Additional Protection BEDROOM �Heat-Activated Detectors � � 0 TO BEDROOM BR BEDROOM ■ KTCH - LVNG RM CLOSED GARAGE ' DOOR BASEMENT Recommendations For Proper Intrusion Protection For proper intrusion coverage, sensors should be located at every possible point of entry to a home or commercial premises. This would include any skylights that may be present, and the upper windows in a multi-level building. In addition, we recommend that radio backup be used in a security system so that alarm signals can still be sent to the alarm monitoring station in the event that the telephone lines are out of order(alarm signals are normally sent over the phone lines, if connected to an alarm monitoring station). —ix — -X- • ' � � ' ' • The VISTA-50P is an 8-Partition alarm control panel that supports up to 86 zones using basic hardwired, polling loop, and wireless zones. In addition, the control offers relay control and scheduling capabilities for automating system functions. The major system features are outlined below. Basic Hardwired Zones Provides 9 basic hardwire zones with the following characteristics: • EOLR supervision (optional for zones 2-8) supporting N.O. or N.C. sensors • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions • Up to 16 2-wire smoke detectors on zone 1 • 4-wire smoke or heat detectors on zones 1-8 (power to 4-wire smokes must be supervised for UL installations) • Up to 50 2-wire latching glassbreak detectors on zone 8 Optional Expansion Zones Polling Loop Expansion: Supports up to 77 additional hardwire zones using a built-in polling (multiplex) loop interface. Current draw can total up to 64mA. Polling loop zones have the following characteristics: • Must use RPM (Remote Point Module)devices • Supervised by control panel • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions Wireless Expansion: Supports up to 63 wireless zones using 4281 type RF Receiver or 86 wireless zones using 5881 type RF Receiver (less if using hardwire and/or polling loop zones). Wireless zones have the following characteristics: • Supervised by control panel for check-in signals (except certain non- supervised transmitters) • Supervised for low battery condition • Tamper protection for 5800 series supervised transmitters • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions For specific information regarding number of wireless zones supported by each RF receiver, see the section on Wireless Expansion later in this manual. Supervisory Zones Provides additional zones for supervision of the following: RF Receivers Zones 88-91 Polling Loop Zone 97 4285 VIP Module Zone 87 —1 — 8 Partitions Provides the ability to control 8 separate areas independently, each functioning as if it had its own separate control. Partitioning features include: • A"Common Lobby" partition, which arms automatically when the last partition (1-8)that shares the common lobby is armed and disarms when the first partition (1-8)that shares the common lobby is disarmed • A Master Partition (9) to which keypads may be assigned to view the status of all 8 partitions at the same time • Keypads assignable to one of 8 partitions or to Master Partition 9 to view system status • Ability to assign Relays/Powerline Carrier devices to one or all 8 partitions • Certain system options selectable for each partition , such as Entry/Exit Delay and Subscriber Account Number User Codes Acccommodates 75 user codes, all of which can operate any or all partitions. Each user, if assigned to more than one partition, retains the same user number across all partitions, and will only utilize one user "slot" in the system. Certain characteristics must be assigned to each user code, which are as follows: • Authority level for each partition (Master, Manager, or several other Operator levels) • Opening/Closing central station reporting option • What partitions the code can operate • Global arming capability(ability to arm and disarm all partitions the code has access to in one command) • Use of a wireless transmitter to arm and disarm the system (wireless transmitter must first be learned into the system Peripheral Devices Supports up to 16 addressable devices, which can be any combination of keypads (6139, 6137, 6128, 5137AD, 4137AD),RF receivers (4281/5881), relay modules (4204), and the 4285 VIP module. Peripheral Devices have the following characteristics: • Terminated at the Keypad Port terminals on the control panel • Each device set to an individual address (physically) according to the device's instructions • Each device enabled in the system using the Device Programming Mode (covered later in this manual) Keypad Panic Keys Accommodates three keypad panic keys: 1+* (A), *+# (B), and 3+# (C). Characteristics of the panic keys are: • Designated as zones 95(1+*), 96(3+#), and 99(*+#) • Activated by wired and wireless keypads • Activated and reported separately by partition, distinguished by Subscriber Acct. No. (or Partition No. if Contact ID reporting is used) —2— Keypad Macros Accommodates one keypad macro command per partition (each macro is a series of keypad commands), which can be assigned to the D key on each partition's keypads. This means, for example, that by pressing the "D" key, the system can be programmed to log onto another partition, bypass zones 2 and 3, and arm that partition in the AWAY mode (explained in detail later in this manual). Characteristics of keypad macros are: • Assignable to the "D" key by partition • Can each be 16 characters (keystrokes) in length Optional Output Devices (4204 Relays and Powerline Carrier(i.e., X-10) Devices) Accommodates the use of 16 output devices, which can be a combination of ADEMCO's 4204 Relay Modules or Powerline Carrier Devices (i.e., X-10, ACT, Leviton). Each 4204 module provides four "Form C" relays for general purpose use. Powerline Carrier Devices are controlled by signals sent through the electrical wiring at the premises via a 4300 transformer. Therefore, if using Powerline Carrier Devices, a 4300 transformer must be used in place of the regular system transformer. Output devices have the following characteristics: • Can be programmed to activate in response to system events • Can be programmed to activate using time intervals • Can be activated manually using the#70 relay command mode • Can each have an alpha descriptor assigned to it Optional Vista Interactive Phone Module Supports the Ademco 4285 VIP Module. This permits access to the security system to do the following: • Obtain system status information • Arm and disarm security system • Control relays and/or Powerline Carrier devices Access Control If programmed, provides users with a command which activates a relay for two seconds to open access doors (e.g. lobby door). Each partition can be assigned one access control relay. Optional Keyswitch Supports the Ademco 4146 keyswitch on any one of the systems's 8 partitions. If used, zone 7 is no longer available as a protection zone. Voltage Triggers Provides a trigger connector whose pins change state for different conditions. Used with LORRA (Long Range Radio) equipment or other devices such as a remote keypad sounder, keyswitch Armed and Ready LEDs, or a printer to print the system's Event Log. Event Log Keeps a log of different event types (enabled in programming). The Event Log has the following characteristics: • Stores a total of 224 events • Can be viewed at the keypad or through the use of V-Link software • Can be printed on a serial printer using a 4100SM module —3 — Scheduling Provides the following scheduling capabilities: • Open/Close schedules (for control of arming/disarming, and reporting) • Holiday schedules (allows different time windows for Open/Close schedules) • Timed Events (for activation of relays, auto-bypassing and unbypassing„ auto-arming and disarming, etc.) • Access schedules (for limiting system access to users by time) • End User Output Programming mode (provides 20 timers for relay control) Audio Alarm Verification Option Provides a programmable Audio Alarm Verification (AAV) option which can be used in conjunction with an output relay to permit voice dialog between an operator at the central station and a person at the premises • Requires the use of an optional AAV unit, such as Eagle model 1241 • If using, Zone 5 is no longer available as a protection zone Cross-Zoning Capability Helps prevent false alarms by preventing a zone from going into alarm unless its cross-zone is also faulted within five minutes. Exit Error False Alarm Prevention Feature • System can tell the difference between a regular alarm and an alarm caused by leaving an Entry/Exit door open. If not subsequently disarmed, faulted E/E zone(s)will be bypassed and the system will arm • Generates an "Exit Error" report by user and by zone so the Central Station knows it was an exit alarm and who caused it Communications Formats Supports the following formats for the Primary and Secondary Central Station receivers: • Ademco Low Speed (Standard or Expanded) • Sescoa/Radionics • Ademco Express • Ademco High Speed • Ademco Contact ID Built-in User's Manual and Descriptor Review Contains a built-in Users Manual and Descriptor Review mode (alpha keypad only). • By depressing and holding any of the function keys on the keypad for 5 seconds, a brief explanation of that particular function scrolls across the alpha-numeric display. • By pressing and holding the READY key for 5 seconds and then releasing it, all programmed zone descriptors can be displayed (one at a time). This serves as a check for installers to be sure all descriptors are entered properly. Improved Downloading Speed Uploads and downloads at 300 baud (old rate is 75 baud), making upload/download speed approximately three times faster. —4 � � � � � � � � � This section provides the following information: • Theory of partitioning • Setting up a partitioned system • Common Lobby Logic • Master keypad setup and operation Theory of Partitioning This system provides the ability to arm and disarm up to 8 different areas, each as if it had its own control. These areas are called partitions. Partitions are used when the user desires to disarm certain areas while leaving other areas armed, or to limit access to certain areas to specific individuals. Each user of the system can be assigned to operate any or all partitions, and can be given a different authority level in each. Facts you need to know about partitioning: First, you must determine how many partitions are required (1-8). This must be done before anything can be assigned to those partitions. Keypads Each keypad must be given a unique "address" and assigned to one partition (can also be assigned to Partition 9 if "Master" keypad operation is desired-- see Master Keypad Setup and Operation later in this section). Zones Each zone must be assigned to one partition. The zones assigned to a partition will be displayed on that partition's keypad(s). Users Each user can be assigned to one or more partitions. If a user is to operate more than one partition and would like to arm/disarm all or some of those partitions with a single command, the user must be enabled for "Global Arming"for those partitions (when entering user codes). A user with access to more than one partition (multiple access) can "log on"to one partition from another partition's keypad, provided that program field 2*18: ENABLE GOTO is enabled for each partition you want to log on to from another. A partition can be selected as a "common lobby" partition, and other partitions can affect this partition by causing arming/disarming of this partition to be automated (see Common Lobby Logic, later in this section). Setting Up a Partitioned System The basic steps to setting up a partitioned system are described below. If you need more information on how to program the prescribed options, see Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMM/NG, as well as each corresponding section's programming procedure. 1. Determine how many partitions the system will consist of(programmed in field 2*00). 2. Assign keypads to partitions (#93 Device Programming mode). 3. Assign zones to partitions (#93 Zone Programming mode). 4. Confirm zones are displayed at the keypad(s)assigned to those partitions. 5. Assign users to partitions. 6. Enable the GOTO feature (program field 2*18) for each partition a multiple- access user can "log on"to (alpha keypad only). 7. Program Partition-Specific fields (see Section 17: DATA FIELD DESCRIPTIONS). —5 — Common Lobby Logic When an installation consists of a partition shared by users of other partitions in a building, that shared partition may be assigned as the "common lobby" partition for the system (program field 1*17). An example of this might be in a medical building where there are two doctor's offices and a common entrance area (see example that follows explanation). This option employs logic for automatic arming and disarming of the common lobby . Two programming fields affect the way the common lobby will react relative to the status of other partitions. They are: 1*18 (Affects Lobby) and 1*19 (Arms Lobby). 1*18 Affects Lobby (must be programmed by partition) Setting this option to 1 for a specific partition causes that partition to affect the operation of the common lobby as follows: a. When the first partition that affects the lobby is disarmed, the lobby will also be disarmed. b. The common lobby cannot be armed unless every partition selected to affect the lobby is armed. c. Arming the last partition that affects the lobby will not automatically attempt to arm the lobby. 1*19 Arms Lobby (must be programmed by partition) Setting this option to 1 for a specific partition causes that partition to affect the operation of the common lobby as follows: a. When the first partition that affects the lobby is disarmed, the lobby will also be disarmed. b. The common lobby cannot be armed unless every partition selected to affect the lobby is armed. c. Arming the last partition that is programmed to arm the lobby will automatically attempt to arm the lobby. If any faults exist in the lobby partition, or another partition that affects the lobby is disarmed, the lobby cannot be armed, and the message "UNABLE TO ARM LOBBY PARTITION"will be displayed. L� ,� You cannot select a partition to "arm" the lobby unless it has first been selected �� to "affect"the lobby. Enable field 1*18 before enabling field 1*19. The following chart sums up how the common lobby partition will operate, if different options are set for another partition in fields 1*18 and 1*19. 1"18 1�19 Disarms when Attempts to arm when an be armed if Affects Lobby Arms Lobby partition disarms? partition arms? other partitions disarmed? 0 0 NO NO YES 1 0 YES NO NO 1 1 YES YES NO 0 1 ---ENTRY NOT ALLOWED--- —�- Example Here is an example of how the lobby would react in a typical setup. OFFICE#1 OFFICE#2 COMMON LOBBY MAIN ENTRANCE User#1 has access to Office#1 and the Common Lobby. User#2 has access to Office#2 and the Common Lobby. Office#1 is set up to affect the Common Lobby, but not arm it. Office#2 is set up to affect and arm the Common Lobby. For the purpose of this example, the ( ) indicate the current status of the other partition when the user takes action. Sequence#1: Office 1 Office 2 Lobb Action User#1: Disarms (Armed) Disarms User#2: (Disarmed) Disarms No Change User#1: Arms (Disarmed) No change User#2: Armed Arms Arms Sequence#2: Office 1 Office 2 Lobby Action User#2: (Armed) Disarms Disarms User#1: Disarms (Disarmed) (No change) User#2: (Disarmed) Arms No Change User#1: Arms Armed No Chan e Notice that in sequence #1, since Office #2 was the last to arm, the lobby also armed (Office #2 is programmed to affect and arm the lobby). In sequence #2, the lobby could not arm when Office#2 armed, because Office #1, which affects the lobby, was still disarmed. When Office #1 armed, the lobby still did not arm because Office #1 was not programmed to arm the lobby. User#1 would have to arm the lobby manually. Therefore, you would want to program a partition to affect and arm the lobby, if the users of that partition are expected to be the "last out" of the building. —7 — How User Access Codes Affect the Common Lobby Codes with "G/obal"Arminp If a code is given "global arming" when it is defined (see Section 24: SECURITY ACCESS CODES), the keypad will ask "Arm all?" or"Disarm all?" whenever the user tries to arm or disarm the partitions he has access to from an alpha keypad. This allows the user to pick and choose the partitions to be armed or disarmed, and so eliminates the "automatic" operation of the lobby. Keep in mind, however, that if attempting to arm all, and another"affecting" partition is disarmed, the user will not be able to arm the lobby, and the message "UNABLE TO ARM LOBBY PARTITION"will be displayed. Codes with "Non-Global"Arminp If arming with a non-global code, or if arming with a global code from a non-alpha keypad, the lobby partition operation will be automatic, as described by fields 1*18 and 1*19. Other Methods of Arming/Disarming When arming or disarming a partition that affects and/or arms the common lobby in one of the following manners, lobby logic remains active: • Quick-Arm • Keyswitch • Wireless Button • Wireless Keypad Arming/Disarming Remotely If arming or disarming remotely (through VLINK downloading software), the lobby will not automatically follow another partition that is programmed to arm or disarm the lobby. The lobby must be armed separately, after arming all affecting partitions first. Auto-Arming/Disarming If scheduling is used to automatically arm and/or disarm partitions, the Lobby partition will not automatically follow another partition that is programmed to arm or disarm the lobby. The lobby must be included as a partition to be armed/disarmed. �;�, If using auto-arming, make sure that the Auto-arm Delay and Auto-arm ��� Warning periods (fields 2*05 and 2"`06) combined are longer than that of any other artition that affects the lobb . This will cause the lobb to arm last. Master Keypad Setup and Operation Although this system has eight actual partitions, it provides an extra partition strictly for the purpose of assigning keypads as "Master" keypads for the system. Any keypad assigned to Partition 9 in #93 Device Programming mode will make that keypad a "Master" keypad. A Master keypad reflects the status of the entire system (Partitions 1-8) on its display at one time. This is useful because it eliminates the need for a security officer in a building to have to "log-on" to various partitions from one partition's keypad to find out where an alarm has occurred. —� The following is an example of a typical display: SYSTEM 12345678 � STATUS RRNNA * B I Possible status indications include: A=Armed Away M= Armed Maximum S =Armed Stay I = Armed Instant R= Ready N= Not Ready B = Bypassed/Ready *= Alarm Memory/Trouble present To obtain more information regarding a particular partition, enter * + [Partition No.] (i.e., *4). In order to affect that partition, the user must use a code that has access to that partition. Also, in order for a user of any partition to log onto Partition 9 to view the status of all partitions, that user must have access to all partitions. Otherwise, access will be denied. The following is an example of what would be displayed for a fault condition on Zone 2 (Loading Dock Window) on Partition 1 (Warehouse) when logging on from a keypad on Partition 9: WHSE DISARMED � HIT* FOR FAULTS � This is the normal display that appears at Partition 1's keypad(s). Pressing* will display: CI FAULT 02 LOADING 9 DOCK WINDOW ' , . Additional zone faults will be displayed one at a time. To display a new partition's status, press * + [Partition No.]. This will display the status of the new partition. The "Armed" LED on a Master keypad will be lit only if all partitions have been armed successfully. The "Ready" LED will be lit only if all partitions that are disarmed are "ready to arm." Neither LED will be lit if only some partitions are armed and only some disarmed partitions are "ready." The sounder on a Master keypad will reflect the sound of the most critical condition on all of the partitions. The priority of the sounds is as follows: A. Pulsing fire alarm sounds B. Steady burglar alarm sounds C. Trouble sounds (rapid beeping) The sounder may be silenced by pressing any key on the Master keypad or a keypad on the partition where the condition exists. L�� A Master keypad uses the same panics as Partition 1. Master keypad panics are sent to Partition 1, and will activate on Partitions 1. Therefore, panics must be ro rammed for Partition 1. —9 — • � • ' • This section provides installation instructions for the following: • Mounting the control cabinet • Installing the cabinet lock (if used) • Installing the main circuit board • Standard phone line connections • Connecting the AC transformer • Installing the backup battery in the cabinet • Making earth ground connections Mounting the Cabinet • Mount the control cabinet to a sturdy wall using fasteners or anchors (not supplied) in a clean, dry area which is not readily accessible to the general public. The back of the control cabinet has 4 holes for this purpose. • Before mounting the circuit board, remove the metal knockouts for the wiring entry that you will be using. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO REMOVE THE KNOCKOUTS AFTER THE CIRCUIT BOARD HAS BEEN INSTALLED. Installing The Cabinet Lock Use an Ademco No. N6277 Cam Lock and No. N6277-1 Push-On Retainer Clip (supplied). 1. Remove the lock knockout on the control cabinet cover. Insert the key into the lock. Position the lock in the ��RETAINER CLIP hole making certain that the latch will (NOTE POSITION) � make contact with the latch bracket Oo when the door is closed. ° LOCKED RETAINER 2. While holding the lock steady, insert � RETAINER s�o-rs �O CLIP the retainer clip into the retainer slots. �, , , , � y �UNLOCKED CABINET DOOR BOTTOM Figure 1. Installing The Lock U L For UL installations which are intended to provide certificated burglary service, refer to the special requirements and ATTACK RESISTANCE CONSIDERATIONS diagram to follow. —10— Grade A Mercantile Premises Listing • The panel door must be supervised. Mount the clip-on tamper switch (supplied)to the cabinet's right side wall as shown in the diagram and wire it to any EOLR supervised zone (1-8). Program this zone for Trouble by Day/Alarm by Night (type 05) or 24-hour audible alarm (type 07) response. The 24-hour alarm response must be used for multiple partitioned systems. • Use a bell with a tamper protected housing such as the Ademco AB12. The bell housing's tamper switch and inner linings tamper must be wired to the same zone that supervises the panel's tamper switch (see EXTERNAL SOUNDER section for more information. • All wiring between the bell and panel must be run in conduit. Remaining wires do not need to be run in conduit. • All wiring which is not run in conduit must exit from the knock-out openings on the bottom or back of the cabinet. • All unused knockouts must be plugged using the disc plugs and carriage bolts, supplied, as indicated in the diagram below • Fasten the cabinet door to the cabinet backbox using the 20 one inch long philips heads screws (supplied) after all wiring, programming and checkout procedures have been completed CABINET ATTACK RESISTANCE CONSIDERATIONS (Shows typical local Grade A listing installation) RUN BELL WIRES IN CONDUIT PLUG THIS 1 KNOCK-OUT + CLIP-ON DOOR � TAMPER SWITCH C� GCOM C�o CABWET p�g MOUNTING HOLE (4 PLACES) PLUG THIS PLUG THIS KNOCK-OU7� O 1O O � KNOCK-OUT TO PLUG AN UNUSED KNOCKOUT OPENING,REMOVE KNOCKOUT AND INSTALL A PAIR OF DISC PLUGS AND A CARRIAGE BOLT AS SHOWN: 0 0 O O DISC PWGS(DIMPLES IN DISC KNOCK-OUT �� KNOCK-OUT O EMNGTER INSIDE 1 1 OPENING PLUG THIS RUN ALL REMAINING r—CARRIAGE BOLT KNOCK-OUT WIRES THRU HERE � HEX NUT AND ��CABINET SIDEWALL IOCK WASHER (OUTSIDE) Figure 2: Cabinet Attack Resistance Considerations Grade A Mercantile Safe and Vault Listing • Follow the instructions given above for Mercantile Premises listing,. • In addition, mount a shock sensor such as Sentrol No. 5402 to the panel's backbox. Follow the manufacturer's instructions for proper sensor mounting. This sensor must also be wired to the same zone that is used to supervise the panel's tamper switch. —11 — Installing the Control's Circuit Board Refer to the diagram below when mounting the PC board. • Hang the three mounting clips on the raised cabinet tabs. Make sure the clip orientation is exactly as shown in the diagram to avoid damage to the clip when mounting screws are tightened. This will also avoid problems with insertion and removal of the PC board. • Insert the top of the circuit board into the slots at the top of the cabinet. Make certain that the board rests in the slots as indicated in step 2 detail. • Swing the base of the board into the mounting clips and secure the board to the cabinet with the accompanying screws (as illustrated in Figure 3). L�� Make certain that the mounting screws are tight. This insures that there is a good ground connection between the PC board and the cabinet. Also, dress field wiring away from the microprocessor(center) section of the PC board. Use the 2 loops on the left and right sidewalls of the cabinet for anchoring field wiring using tie wraps. These steps are important to minimizing the risk of panel RF interference with television reception. M � DETAIL SIDE VIEW OF BOARD � INSERTED INTO ` �� SLOTS � � A 6 DETAIL SIDE VIEW OF CLIP AND 3RD CLIP BAORD INSTALLED REQUIRED DETAIL SIDE VIEW OF CLIP INSTALLATION A-CAHINET TAB WITHOUT CLIP B-CABINET TAB WITH HANGING CLIP Figure 3. Mounting The PC Board Standard Phone Line Connections 1. Connect the incoming phone line and handset wiring to the main terminal block as follows (also see Figure 4): TB1-26: Local Handset(TIP) TB1-27: Local Handset(RING) TB1-28: Incoming Phone Line (TIP) TB1-29: Incoming Phone Line (RING) —12— 2. If you want to connect the panel to phone lines that require ground start capability, then a 675 Ground Start Module must be used. This module is triggered by one of the outputs on the connector labeled J7 (see VOLTAGE TR/GGERS section). The system must be connected to a phone line which provides loop start service. U L Phone lines which provide ground start service are not permitted in UL applications. To prevent the risk of shock, disconnect phone lines at telco jack before servicing � the panel. . PABX • If the communicator is connected to a telephone line inside a PABX, be sure the PABX has a back-up power supply that can support the PABX for 24 hours. Many PABXs are not power backed up and connection to such a PABX will result in a communication failure if power is lost. Incoming Z Handset Telco Line o ��� r� � 26 27 28 29 30 TERMINALS ON CONTROL ~ EARTH GROUND � � a INCOMWG TELCO LINE a � � Z C� d Z ~ Z Z � DIRECT F- � � } � p CONNECT � � � � CORD RJ31X RING PREMISES m C� � ♦ JACK PHONES r ee PLUG ° 0 Figure 4. Standard Telephone Line Connections Connecting the AC Transformer 1361: 1. Wire the 1361 transformer (1361 CN in Canada) to terminals 1 and 2 on the control panel (before connecting the battery) as shown Figure 5. See wiring table below for wire guage to use. � Do not plug the transformer into the AC outlet until you are instructed to do so. —13— PRIMARY POWER BATTERY Supplied by 1361` TABS + Plug-In Connect ro ❑ � Transformer which 12VDC,4AH � or 12VDC,7AH is rated at (� (2� n 16.5VAC,4OVA. GEL CELL �� �- �- �- BATTERY Caution must be � —� CHARGING m taken when wiring VOLTAGE this transformer to �3.7 VDC _ the panel to guard Replace 2 h�n120VAC, � against blowing the 3eyears 60 Hz Outlet � fuse inside the z z transformer(non- o replaceable). TRaNSFORnnER o 16.5VAC,40VA ADEMCO No.136� (IN CANADA USE No.1361CN) or 4300 IF X-�0 OEVICES WILL BE USED ��� NOTE: WHEN POWERING UP THE PANEL,PWG THE TRANSFORMER IN BEFORE CONNECTING THE BATTERY. Figure 5: AC Power And Battery Connections 4300 If using Powerline Carrier devices, the 4300 transformer interface must be used instead of the regular 1361 transformer. The 4300 supplies the control panel with AC, and also acts to send control pulses through the premises electrical system to control the Powerline Carrier devices. Connect the 4300 as follows: 1. Connect terminals 1 and 3 (AC) and terminal 2 (Ground) of the 4300 transformer interface to control panel terminals 1, 2, and 30, respectively. 2. Run a 6-conductor cable between the 4300 and the panel. Splice this cable to a 4142TR cable as shown in Figure 6. Note that the white and yellow wires of the 4142TR must be spliced together. 4300 TRANSFORMER/INTERFACE � � 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 �g CONNECTOR O Earth W ¢ � F � W � W U AC Ground AC Sync Data Com O � W = w CL � � a 1 2 3 4 OS 6 > � > � � � m m m 2� ?� ?� 2'� � �pJ J�J,��pJ�pJ C> O O C� C� 4142TR CABLE TB1 TB1 T81 -1 30 -2 Figure 6: 4300 Transformer Connections L� //,' Do not plug the transformer into the AC outlet until you are instructed to do so �� later in the manual. —14— The complete wiring for the 4300 transformer is also covered in Section 9: RELAY OUTPUTS& POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES. Installing The Back-Up Battery If necessary, refer to Section 15: FINAL POWER-UP PROCEDUREfor information regarding battery size to use, etc. L� � Do not attach the connector cable to the battery terminals until you are �� instructed to do so later in the manual. 1. Place the 12-volt back-up battery in the control cabinet. 2. Attach Red and Black wires on the battery connector cable as follows: a. Red to the positive (+) battery terminal on the control board (see Figure 4 or the Summary of Connections Diagram for location, if necessary). b. Black to the negative (—) battery terminal on the control board. U L Use a 4AH battery or larger for UL installations. Earth Ground Considerations In order for the lightning transient protective devices in this product to be effective, the designated earth ground terminal (terminal 30), must be terminated in a good earth ground. Recommended wire gauge for the ground connection is #16 AWG run no further than 30 feet. The following are examples of good earth grounds available at most installations: • Metal Cold Water Pipe: Use a non-corrosive metal strap (copper is recommended) firmly secured to the pipe to which the ground lead is electrically connected and secured. • AC Power Outlet Ground: Available from 3-prong, 120VAC, power outlets only. To test the integrity of the ground terminal, use a three-wire circuit tester with neon lamp indicators, such as the UL-Listed Ideal Model 61-035, or equivalent, available at most electrical supply stores. —15— � . . � � - � � � This section provides the following information: • Using Data Field Program Mode • System and communication defaults • Entering Data Field Program Mode • Moving from one level (page)of program fields to another • Entering and viewing data fields • Programming partition-specific data fields • #93 Menu Mode Programming Using Data Field Program Mode Data Field program mode is the program mode through which many system options are programmed. The field numbers on the program form show the number of entries required for each field. When an entry is completed, the keypad "beeps"three times and advanced to the next field. At this point, you can either make the required entry in the new field, or press '` + the next field number you want to program. There are several "question and answer" modes, which we call "Menu" modes that can be accessed once Data Field program mode has been entered. These modes prompt the user for information, and for this reason, a 2-line alpha keypad (5137AD, 6139) is required. System and Communication Defaults • The system is shipped with a set of pre-programmed default values that are designed to meet the needs of many installations. These can be changed by the installer to suit specific needs if desired. • There are four sets of pre-programmed communication defaults available, including Low Speed, 4+2 Express, Ademco High Speed, and Ademco Contact ID. Loading one of these defaults automatically programs industry standard codes that will suit most of your needs. • These defaults can be changed directly from the alpha keypad (5137AD or 6139), or they can be changed by using V-LINK downloading software (be sure that the software version used includes a VISTA 50 with scheduling menu selection). Downloading can be performed either remotely from an IBM compatible computer(using an approved modem)or at the job site (direct-wire download using the 4100SM Serial Module) � The factory loaded defaults (*97) enable keypad addresses 00-03 only. A keypad set to one of these addresses must be used to program the system. Entering Data Field Programming Mode 1. Enter program mode using either method A or B: A) Press both the [*] and [#] keys at the same time within 30 seconds after power is applied to the Control. B) Enter the [Installer Code] + [8] + [0] + [0] keys. The factory installer code can be changed once in the program mode (field *00). L� �, Local keypad programming can be disabled through VLink downloading software. � If this is done, programming can only be accomplished via the downloading softwa re. —16— 2. After entry into the program mode, the following will be displayed: Program Mode *Fill#View-00 I 3. Following this display, enter* and the first field number to be programmed. Enter the first field number to be programmed (ex. *00, installer's code) and make the desired entry. When the field is complete, the keypad will normally "beep"three times and will advance to the next field. If you do not desire to change the next field, press * and the next field number to be programmed. � First Page of fields (*00*90) press *99 or*98 to exit program mode Moving from One Page of Programming to Another • The data fields are grouped into three levels (referred to as "pages"). The first page is accessed as soon as programming mode is entered. • The second and third pages of data fields are indicated at the keypad by a "1" or "2" respectively in front of the 2-digit field address. The words "ALT PROGRAM MODE" along with a "100" or"200", depending on which page of program fields is accessed, to indicate the higher page of fields. 1. To access the next level of fields, press *94. 2. Then press * + [XX], where XX=the last two digits of the program field, and make the desired entry. 3.To return to the previous page of fields, press *99. press *94 to move to 2nd a e ress*99 to move back to 1st page second page of fields (1*01-1*76) press*94 to move to 3rd a e ress*99 to move back to 2nd page third page of fields (2*00-2*21) Viewing Data Fields To view the contents of a data field, press [#] plus the 2-digit field address. The field's entries will be displayed, but no changes can be made. Entry Errors • If an address is improperly entered, the keypad will display FC. • If a program entry is improperly entered (for example, a larger number than that which is permitted), the keypad display will go blank. • In either of the above cases, simply re-enter* +the correct field number. SUMMARY OF DATA FIELD PROGRAMMING COMMANDS *94 Next page of fields *99 Previous page of fields or exit programming mode with no installer lockout *91 Select partition for programming partition-specific fields *98 Exit programming mode with installer lock-out —17— Programming System-Wide Data Fields Values for some programming fields are system-wide (global), and some can be different for each partition (partition-specific). Note that the partition-specific programming fields are automatically skipped when programming the global fields. If the system has only 1 partition, the partition-specific fields will not be automatically skipped. To program system-wide data fields, do the following: 1. Enter Program Mode: Installer code + 8 0 0. 2. When the program screen is displayed, press *00 to begin programming the Installer Code data field. When you have completed the entry, the keypad sounds three beeps and automatically displays the next program field in sequential order. 3. To program specific data fields out of sequence, press� plus the 2-digit field address of the field number you want to program, then make the required entry. If the number of digits that you enter in a data field is less than the maximum permitted (ex. phone number), the keypad displays the last entry and waits. To proceed, enter* + the next data field you wish to program (ex. press *05). Partition-Specific programming fields are skipped. 4. To change to the next page of fields, press *94. To return to the previous page of fields, press *99. Programming Partition-Specific Data Fields To program partition-specific data fields once in program mode, do the following: 1. Press *91, which will prompt you for the partition number desired. 2. Enter a partition-specific field number (ex. *09) to begin programming. When the first field's entry is completed, the next partition-specific field will automatically be displayed. When all partition-specific fields are programmed, the system returns to the global programming fields (page 1 fields). To return to the global program fields before finishing all fields, enter any global field number. 3. Repeat this procedure for each partition in the installation. PROGRAMMING PARTITION-SPECIFIC FIELDS Press*91 to select a partition � Enter the partition to be programmed 1 Enter a partition-specific field#and make entry ♦ After partition -specific fields are programmed, press*91 to select next partition. Enter any global field number to return to the global fields at any time. —18— #93 Menu Mode Programming The #93 Menu Mode is a mode through which much of the system's programming is done. It offers main menu selections for the following: Zone Programming Serial Number Programming Alpha Programming Device Programming Relay Programming Relay Voice Descriptors Custom Index Programming (VIP Module substitute words) Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES) in response to the displayed menu selection. Pressing 0 will display the next choice in sequence. The keypad will then prompt you with questions regarding the programming of a particular zone or device. (Refer to the individual sections to program each option shown.) The following is a list of commands used while in the menu mode. #93 Menu Mode Ke Commands #93 Enters Menu mode * Serves as ENTER ke . Press to have ke ad acce t ent . # Backs u to revious screen. 0 Press to answer NO 1 Press to answer YES 00+[*] Escapes from menu mode, back into data field programming mode, if entered at the first prompt of each main menu option. —19— • � ' � � This section provides the following information: • A list of wired keypads that may be used • Instructions for wiring and mounting the keypads • Instructions for addressing the keypads • A preliminary check-out procedure to ensure that the keypads are functioning properly in the system Keypads That May Be Used • Two Line Alpha Display: 6139, 5137AD • Fixed-Word Display: 6137, 6128, 4137AD • Up to 16 addressable devices, including keypads, may be used in the system, as long as the auxiliary current is available (you may need to use an auxiliary power supply if the 750mA auxiliary output is exceeded) Wiring To The Keypads 1. Determine wire gauge by referring to the wiring length/gauge chart below. 2. Wire keypads to a single wire run or connect individual keypads to separate wire runs. The maximum wire run length from the control to a single keypad which is home-run back to the control must not exceed the lengths listed in the table. Wire Run Length Table Wire Gauge Length #22 gauge 450 feet #20 gauge 700 feet #18 gauge 1100 feet #16 gauge 1750 feet � 1. The length of all wire runs combined must not exceed 2000 feet when �� unshielded quad conductor cable is used (1000 feet if shielded cable is used.) 2. If more than one keypad is wired to a run, then the above maximum lengths must be divided by the number of keypads on the run (i.e. the maximum length would be 225 feet if two keypads are wired on a#22 gauge run). For keypads connected to a single 4-wire run, determine the current drawn by all units connected to the single wire run, then refer to the Wiring Run chart to determine the maximum wire length that can be safely used for each wire size. Current draw for all devices can be found in the SPECIFICATIONS AND ACCESSORIES section. 3. Run field wiring from the control to the keypads (using standard 4-conductor twisted wire cable using the wire gauge determined in step 1). —20— 4. Connect keypads to the Keypad Port terminals 6, 7, 8, and 9 on the control board, as shown in Figure 4. RED 6 BLACK 7 KEYPADS GREEN 8 YELLOW 9 CONTROL TERMINALS Figure 7. Keypad Connections To the Keypad Port terminals. Using a Supplementary Power Supply to Power Additional Keypads The control provides 750mA of auxiliary standby power for powering keypads and other devices from the auxiliary power output. Aside from this, the control can support up to 16 peripheral devices (keypads, RF receivers, relay modules, etc.). The backup battery will supply power to these devices in the event that AC power is lost. When the control's auxiliary power load for all devices exceeds 750mA, you can power additional keypads from a regulated, 12VDC power supply (e.g., 487-12 supplies 12V, 250mA; 488-12 supplies 12V, 500mA). Use a UL Listed, battery- backed supply for UL installations. The 487-12/488-12 power supplies have a backup battery which can power these keypads in the event of AC power loss. L�� Keypads powered from supplies which do not have a backup battery will not function when AC power is lost. Therefore, be sure to power at least one keypad from the Control's auxiliary power output. Connect the additional keypads as shown in Figure 8, using the keypad wire colors shown. Be sure to observe the current ratings for the power supply used. L�� 1. Make connections directly to the screw terminals as shown in Figure 5. Make no connection to the keypad blue wire (if present). 2. Be sure to connect the negative (—)terminal on the Power Supply unit to terminal 7 (AUX— )on the control. —21 — SUPPLEMENTARY CONTROL POWER SUPPLY TERMINAL STRIP + AUX AUX.DATA DATA + - IN OUT 6 7 8 9 w W � � � � � � � � IMPORTANT: W w W w � � � W MAKE THESE � � � � IMPORTANT: � m c� r CONNECTIONS o Y z � Make connections directly to screw 0 0 0 o DIRECTLY TO w � � w Q a Q a � m c� � terminals. Make no connection to the a a d � SCREW w w w w TERMINALS AS Q Q °a a keypad blue wire (if present). Y Y Y Y SHOWN. a a � � O O O O W W W W Y Y Y Y O O O O Figure 8: Using A Supplementary Power Supply For Keypads Mounting the Keypads 1. Mount the keypads at a height that is convenient for the user. Refer to the instructions provided with the keypad for mounting procedure. You can either surface mount or flush mount keypads (using an appropriate Trim Ring Kit: 5137TRK or 6139TRK). Refer to the mounting instructions and template included with the keypad and/or trim ring kit for specific information. Addressing the Keypads/Preliminary Check-out Procedure If you want to check that the system is working before connecting field wiring from zones and devices, do the following: 1. Temporarily connect a 2000 ohm end-of-line resistor across each of the basic hard-wire zones 1-8, as shown in the Summary of Connections diagram. Connect a jumper across the zone 9 terminals. Without actual zone wiring or EOL resistors connected, the keypads will not display the"Ready" message. 2. Power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer (previously wired to the control) into a 120VAC outlet. L� �� The keypads will not operate until they are physically addressed and enabled in �� the system's Device Programming Mode. 3. Set each keypad to an individual address (00-30) according to the keypad's instructions. Set one alpha keypad for address "00" and other keypads for higher addresses (01, 02, and 03 are enabled in the system's default program). Any keypads set for address 04 and above will appear blank until they are enabled in the system's program. L� � Keypads set to the non-addressable mode (address 31) may interfere with other � keypads (as well as other devices) connected to the keypad terminals. —22— 4. After addresses are set, the green "READY" LED (or"POWER" LED on some types of keypads) should light, and the word READY (Fixed-word keypads), or DISARMED...READY TO ARM (Alpha keypads) should be displayed on keypads set to addresses 00, 01, 02, and 03. If the "Ready"display does not appear on any of the keypads in the system (in either of the partitions), or a "Not Ready" message is displayed, check the keypad wiring connections, and make sure each of the 8 basic hard-wired zones has a 2000-ohm resistor connected across its terminals. 5. When the proper "Ready" message is displayed on the keypad(s) addressed at 00, 01, 02, and 03 the system is functioning properly at this point. Do not remove the EOL resistors until you are ready to make connections to the hard-wired zones, to allow for testing later in the manual. � If an OC or OPEN CIRCUIT is present on the keypad, data from the control is not reaching the keypad. Please check your wiring. Programming Remote Keypads Each keypad's corresponding address must be enabled in the system's Device Programming Mode in order to become operational. To accomplish this, do the following: With at least one two-line alpha keypad connected to the system and addressed as described previously: 1. Enter data field programming mode (Installer Code + 8 0 0 ). 2. Program field 2*00 (Number of Partitions) L�� Refer to Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING if you need information about how to move around in program mode). 3. From Data Field Programming mode, press #93. 4. Press 0 (NO) to each menu option until the "DEVICE PROG?" prompt appears. DEVICE PROG? � Press 1 (YES)to enter DEVICE PROGRAMMING mode. 1=YES 0=N0 The following prompts will appear. DEVICEADDRESS Q The device address identifies the keypad to the control. 01-31, 00-QUIT � Enter the 2-digit address number as set at the keypad (01-30). Press � to continue. C DEVICE TYPE � Select the type of addressable keypad as follows: �� �� 00 = device not used 01 = alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) 02 =fixed word keypad (4137AD/6137/6128) Press � to continue. �CONSOLE PART. � Enter the partition number to which you are assigning � � this keypad (01 to maximum number of partitions programmed for the system in field 2*00). This is the primary partition for which the keypad is intended to be used. Enter 09 if the keypad is to be used as a master keypad to view the status of all other partitions (see Master Keypad Setup and Operation in Section 3: PLANNING A PARTITION SYSTEM). Press n to continue. -23- i SOUND OPTION Keypads can be individually programmed to suppress � arm/disarm beeps, entry/exit beeps and chime mode I f beeps. This helps prevent unwanted sounds from disturbing users in other areas of the premises. Enter a number 00-03 for the keypad sounding suppression options desired for the keypad: 00 = no suppression. 01 = suppress arm/disarm &entry/exit beeps. 02 =suppress chime mode beeps only. 03 =suppress arm/disarm, entry/exit and chime mode beeps. Press � to continue. The screen will prompt for the next keypad address to be programmed. 4. Repeat the procedure above for each keypad used in the system. 5. When all keypads have been programmed, press 00 u at this prompt to exit Menu mode programming. The following fields are general keypad options you may want to program now. These fields do not include Response Types or Report Codes for panic keys, which must be programmed separately. *29 QUICK ARM 1*43 PERM. KEYPAD DISPLAY"BACKLIGHT" 6. Enter *99 to exit data field programming mode. 7. Unplug the AC transformer and move on to the next section. L��, Keypad address 00 is reserved for an alpha keypad with no sounder suppression options. —24— • � : � • ' � ' � � � This section provides the following information: • Common characteristics of hardwired zones • Wiring burglary and panic devices to zones 1-8 • Wiring 2-wire smoke detectors to zone 1 • Wiring 4-wire smoke detectors to zones 1-8 • Compatible smoke detectors (2-and 4-wire) • Wiring 2-wire glassbreak detectors to zone 8 • Zone 9 applications • Check-out procedure for hardwired zones Common Characteristics of Hardwired Zones 1-8 • EOLR supervision (optional for zones 2-8) supporting N.O. or N.C. sensors • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions • Up to 16 2-wire smoke detectors on zone 1. • 4-wire smoke or heat detectors on zones 1-8 (power to 4-wire smokes must be supervised for UL installations) • Up to 50 2-wire latching glassbreak detectors on zone 8. Wiring Burglary and Panic Devices to Zones 1-8 1. Connect sensors/contacts to the hardwire zone terminals (10 through 22). • Connect N.C. devices in series with the high (+)side of the loop. The 2K EOL resistor must be connected in series with the devices, following the last device. • Connect N.O. devices in parallel (across)the loop. Observe polarity when wiring smoke detectors. The 2K EOL resistor must be connected across the loop wires at the last device. � Red Jumper ZONE 2 ZONE 3 ZONE 4 ZONE 5 ZONE 6 ZONE 7 ZONE 8 ZONE 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 ZONE 1 ————————— —� � G t — t t — t ¢� a a° �� �°o p�' N.C. N.C. N.C. N.C. aw m� Q�U F'w mE E� g�? C�� �o ��� N.O. N.O. N.O. N.O. ZYQ �Z �Wr U� om �W a am a`L- Np y 2k EOLR 2k EOLR 2k EOLR 2k EOLR -� o + — t a t t �� f — ; Fire GLASS � Usage BREAK SMOKE N.C. N.C. N.C. N.C. _ ___________ _ �� N.C. N.O. N.O. � Butg. N.O. N.C. ', � Usage pkEOLR 2kEOLR N.O. 2k EOLR ' Zone resistance(Excluding EOLR): 2k EOLR ZONE 1,8:100 OHMS MAXIMUM Zone response time: ALL OTHER ZONES:300 OHMS MAXIMUM ZONES 1-8:350mSec-SOOmSec ZONE 9:Programmable for Fast:10mSec-15mSec N o r m a I:350 m S e c-500 m S e c (default response) Figure 9: Zones 1-9 Wiring Connections L� � The maximum zone resistance is 100 ohms for zones 1 and 8, and 300 ohms fo � all other zones (excluding the 2K EOL resistor). —25— u L 1. A zone must be EOLR supervised when used for fire or burglary in UL Listed Commercial Burglary installations. 2. Zone 9 is unsupervised and may not be used in UL Commercial Burglary installations 3. A closed-circuit, unsupervised zone may be used for burglary in UL Residential Burglary installations, provided that interconnecting wires are no longer than three feet with no intervening walls or barriers. Wiring 2-Wire Smoke Detectors to Zone 1 Zone 1 has the added capability of supporting 2-wire smoke detectors. This zone provides enough standby current (2 mA) to power up to sixteen of the smoke detectors listed on the following page. Each zone provides only enough alarm current (20 mA) to power one smoke detector in the alarmed state. When assigned zone type 9, the second entry of a Security Code + OFF sequence at a keypad will interrupt power to this zone to allow detectors to be reset following an alarm. 1. Connect 2-wire smoke detectors across zone 1 terminals (10 & 11) as shown in Figure 10. Observe proper polarity when connecting the detectors. 2. If an EOL resistor is presently connected across zone 1 terminals, remove it. The EOL resistors must be connected across the loop wires of each zone at the last detector. 3. See "Programming Hard-Wired Zones" later in this section for a detailed programming procedure. L� /�j The alarm current provided by zone 1 will support only one smoke detector in � the alarmed state. r----------� i -I- � i i N I I O � � � � N m i � i 2 WIRE SMOKE p � i � i DETECTOR m A I m ' O i / i _ i l-�i � i L__________J Figure 10: 2-Wire Smoke Detector Connected to Zone 1 —26— Compatible 2-Wire Smoke Detectors You may use up to sixteen 2-wire smoke detectors each on zone 1listed in the table below. DETECTOR TYPE DEVICE MODEL# Photoelectric w/heat sensor, direct wire S stem Sensor 2300T Photoelectric, direct wire S stem Sensor 2400 Photoelectric w/heat sensor, direct wire S stem Sensor 2400TH Photoelectric w/B401 B base S stem Sensor 2451 Photoelectric w/heat sensor and B401 B base S stem Sensor 2451 TH lonization, direct wire S stem Sensor 1400 lonization w/B401 B base S stem Sensor 1451 Photoelectric duct detect. w/DH400 base S stem Sensor 2451 lonization duct detector w/DH400 base System Sensor 1451 DH lonization, direct wire System Sensor 1100 lonization w/B110LP base System Sensor 1151 Photoelectric, direct wire, System Sensor 2100 Photoelectric w/heat sensor, direct wire System Sensor 2100T Photoelectric w/B110LP base S stem Sensor 2151 NOTE: These smoke detectors are Listed for use with the Vista-50P and are the only 2-wire smoke detectors that may be used in UL applications. Unsupervised Usage of Zone 1 Zone 1 can also be used for normally closed, unsupervised devices by doing the following: 1. Cut the red jumper on the PC board located above Zone 1 (see Figure 9). 2. Connect closed circuit devices in series with terminals 10 and 11. Wiring 4-Wire Smoke Detectors to Zones 1-8 When programmed for fire warning usage, all zones can monitor 4-wire smoke detectors or N.O. fire alarm initiating devices. You may use as many 4-wire smoke detectors as can be powered from the panel's auxiliary power output without exceeding the output's rating (see Section 15: FINAL POWER UP PROCEDURE for auxiliary power ratings). L� Auxiliary power to 4-wire smoke detectors is not automatically reset after an alarm and therefore must be momentarily interrupted using either a normally- closed momentary switch wired in series with one side of the aux. power to the smokes, or using a 4204 relay as described below. Using a 4204 relay allows the detectors to be reset via the second entry of a Security Code + OFF sequence. The 4204 relay must be programmed to activate on Zone Type/System Operation 54 (Fire Zone Reset). See Section 9: RELAY OUTPUTS& POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES for more information. 1. Connect 12 volt power for the detectors from Auxiliary Power terminals 6 and 7 as follows:: Wire the [+] side of Auxiliary Power (Terminal 6) to the N.C. contact of the 4204 relay. Wire the Pole of the Relay to the [+] Power side of the smoke detector. Connect the [-] side of the smoke detector to [-] Aux. Power (Terminal 7). Observe proper polarity when connecting detectors (see Figure 11). —27— u L Power to 4-wire smoke detectors must be supervised (use a System Sensor A77- 716-01 EOL relay module connected as shown). + EOL RELAY + TO 4-WIRE PANEL SMOKE + ZONE DETECTOR (ZONE 2-8) TO PANEL AUXILIARY + POWER (TERMINALS 6,7) NOTES: NO CONNECTION •PROGRAM THE RELAY TO TRANSFER ON FIRE ZONE RESET(ACTIVATION CODE 54). C NC NO SEE 4204 RELAY MODULE SECTION FOR DETAILS. RESET •SECOND CODE AND OFF RELAY 1,2,3 OR 4 ENTERED AT CONSOLE MOMENTARILY INTERRUPTS 4204 RELAY MODULE DETECTOR POWER. Figure 11: 4-Wire Smoke Detector Power Reset Using 4204 Relay Module 2. Connect detectors (including heat detectors, if used) across terminals of the zone selected. All detectors must be wired in parallel. Remove the 2000 ohm EOL resistor if connected across the selected zone terminals. You must connect the EOL resistor across the loop wires at the last detector. Compatible 4-Wire Smoke Detectors Use any UL listed 4-wire smoke detector which is rated for 10-14VDC operation and which has alarm reset time not exceeding 6 seconds. Some compatible 4- wire smoke detectors are listed below. Photoelectric, direct wire S stem Sensor 2412 Photoelectric w/heat sensor, direct wire S stem Sensor 2412TH lonization, direct wire S stem Sensor 1412 —28— Configuring Zone 7 for Alternate Keyswitch Function Zone 7 may be programmed to serve as a keyswitch input. If using a keyswitch, it can be assigned to only one partition. To enable the keyswitch, do the following: 1. Enter the partition number to which the keyswitch is assigned in program field *15. 2. Zone 7 is automatically assigned a response type 10 (Interior w/Delay). 3. Wire the keyswitch to zone 7. Connect the EOL resistor across the zone. If using keyswitch LEDs, wire as shown in the VOLTAGE TRIGGERS section. Wiring 2-Wire Latching Glass Break Detectors To Zone 8 Use zone 8 for connection of compatible 2-wire latching-type glass break detectors. Wire as follows (also see Figure 12): 1. Connect all detectors in parallel across zone 8 (terminals 21 and 22). L��� Remove the 2000 ohm EOL resistor if connected across the selected zone terminals. You must connect the EOL resistor across the loop wires at the last detector. GLASSBREAK DETECTOR 2000 ZONE 8 OHMS 21 (+� EOLR LATCHING TYPE GLASS BREAK DETECTOR LOOP 22 �') Figure 12: Wiring Latching Glassbreak Detectors to Zone 8. After an alarm, the first code + OFF turns off the siren and disarms the system; the second code + OFF clears the memory of alarm and resets the glassbreak detector. —29— Compatible Glass Break Detectors Use detectors that meet the following ratings: Standby Voltage: 5VDC-13.8VDC Standby Resistance: Greater than 20k ohms (equivalent resistance of all detectors in parallel) Alarm Resistance: Less than 1.1 k ohms (see note below) Alarm Current: 2 mA-10 mA Reset Time: Less than 6 seconds The IEI 735L series detectors have been tested and found to be compatible with these ratings. You can use up to fifty IEI 735L detectors connected in parallel. L�� The alarm current provided by zone 8 will support only one Glass Break detecto in the alarmed state. You can use detectors which exceed 1.1 k ohms in alarm, provided they maintain a voltage drop in alarm of less than 3.8 volts. L � 1. Do not use other N.O. or N.C. contacts when using glass break detectors on ��� zone 8. Other contacts may prevent proper glass break detector operation. 2. If latching type devices are installed on both zones 1 and 8, both zones should be assigned to the same partition. If they are not, and both devices are in alarm at the same time, the resetting of one could cause a loss of alarm memory in the other. Zone 9 Applications: This zone is unsupervised and is suitable for monitoring fast acting glass break sensors or vibration sensors. When using zone 9, keep the following in mind: • Use only closed circuit devices connected in series with one another. • Program zone 9 as any response type except fire (type 09)or panic (types 6,7 or 8) • Program fast (10 msec)or normal (350 msec-500 msec) response in data field *14. L��� Avoid using mechanical magnetic or relay type contacts on zone 9 when programmed for fast response. Programming Hardwired Zones 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0 and program the following data fields: *14 ZONE 9 FAST/NORMAL RESPONSE (1=fast; 0=normal) *41 NORMALLY CLOSED OR EOLR (Zones 2-8) (1=N.C. loops; O=EOLR) 2*00 NUMBER OF PARTITIONS (1-8) if you haven't already done this in previous : 3. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. —30— �ZONE PROG? � Press 1 to enter ZONE PROGRAMMING mode. �1=YES 0=N0 u While in this mode, press u to display the next screen, or press �# to display the previous screen. 'ENTER ZN NO. ''i Enter the zone number to be programmed 01-09. 00=QUIT 02 ; Press � to continue. 02 ZT P RC In:L A summary screen for that zone will appear. ZT = 00 1 00 HW:N zone type; P=partition to which zone is assigned; RC = report code for that zone; In = input type of zone; L = Loop number (applies only to 5800 series RF zones). Press � to continue. � 02 Zone Type I Zone disabled 00 � Each zone in a system must be assigned a zone � type, which defines the way in which the system responds to faults in that zone. Enter the zone response type for each zone. The screen will automatically display the zone type for the number entered. If a different zone response type is desired, enter a different number and press � to continue. Zones 1-9 can be assigned any response type (except zone 9, which cannot be assigned as a fire zone). Refer to the ZONE TYPE DEFINITIONS section for definitions of each zone type. Zone Types for hardwired zones are as follows: 00 Assign For Unused Zones 06 24 Hour Silent Alarm 01 Entry/Exit#1, Burglary 07 24 Hour Audible Alarm 02 Entry/Exit#2, Burglary 08 24 Hour Auxiliary 03 Perimeter, Burglary 09 Fire 04 Interior Follower, Burglary 10 Interior Delay, Burglary 05 Trouble By Day/Alarm By Night 23 No Alarm Response (Used for Relay Activation) !02 Partition y Enter the partition number (1-8) you are assigning � this zone to. Press � to continue. 02 Report Code � Enter the report code for this zone. (Enter the first digit and press C. Enter the second digit and press � again. A summary of both digits. will be displayed). Press � to continue. —31 — �02 Input Type � Enter the input device type as follows: �Hardwired 1:1� 0 = not used; 1=hardwired Press � to continue. The summary screen is displayed. Press � to display the "ENTER ZN NO?" prompt for programming the next hardwired zone. After all zones have been programmed, enter 00 at this prompt and press �. The system will prompt "Quit Menu Mode?" Press 1 to quit. This will return you to normal (data field) programming mode. Press '`99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. Check-Out Procedure For Hard-Wired Zones After installation of all hard-wired zones is complete, each partition of the security system should be checked as follows: 1. Make certain that all devices and sensors connected to the hard-wired zones are not in a faulted state. Doors and windows with contacts should be closed, PIRs should be covered (use a cloth to mask them temporarily if necessary). 2. With all hard-wired zones intact, the Alpha keypads connected to the system should display: DISARMED READY TO ARM. If the following is displayed, DISARMED Press * to show faults press the �`] key to display the faulted zone(s). Restore any faulted zone(s) as necessary (also make sure that you have connected a 2000 ohm EOL resistor across the terminals of unused zones). When the DISARMED...READY TO ARM message is displayed, you can proceed to the next step. 4. Fault and then restore every contact or sensor on each zone individually to ensure that it is being monitored by the system. Each time a zone is faulted, the keypads in the partition to which the zone is assigned should display the number of the faulted zone. When each zone is restored, the READY TO ARM message should appear again. L�� If a zone or zones are not displayed at the correct partition's keypad(s), chec � both keypad and zone programming to verify the correct partition assignment. 5. When you get the proper displays on the keypad(s), the hard-wired zones in the system are functioning properly. 6. Unplug the AC transformer and continue to the next section. —32— • ' ' • • • ' • 1 : . This section provides the following information: • Polling loop overview • Common characteristics of polling loop zones • Wiring RPM devices to the polling loop • Addressing RPM devices • Polling loop limitations • Programming polling loop zones • Checkout procedure for polling loop zones Polling Loop Overview You can expand the system from the basic 9 zones to up to 86 zones using the built-in 2-wire polling loop. Each device that is connected to the polling loop has the ability to communicate with the panel about its status. These devices are called RPMs (Remote Point Modules). The polling loop provides both power and data to the RPM zones, and is constantly monitoring the status of all zones enabled on the loop. The maximum current draw of all devices on the polling loop cannot total more than 64mA (unless using a 4197 Polling Loop Extender Module). Refer to the list of compatible devices at the end of this section. �� Common Characteristics of Polling Loop Zones Polling loop zones have the following characteristics: • Must use RPM (Remote Point Module)devices • Supervised by control panel • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions Wiring/Addressing RPM Devices All devices on the pollong loop must be wired in parallel to the [+] and [-] Polling Loop terminals of the control panel (24 and 25, respectively). You can wire from device to device, or have multiple branches connected directly to the control panel in a star configuration. Be sure to observe proper polarity. Although each polling loop device is wired in parallel, each device has its own unique zone number (or group of zones if it is an 8- zone expander). On some devices, this is determined by the setting of DIP switches. Other devices have a built-in unique serial number which must be "learned" into the control as the zone number desired. Set up the polling loop as follows: 1. Run wires to each device on the polling loop using the guidelines in the following table for maximum wire runs per wire gauge. Twisted pair wire is recommended for all wire runs. Maximum Pollin Loo Wire Runs Wire Gau e Max. Len th #22 gauge 650 feet #20 gau e 950 feet #18 au e 1500 feet #16 gauge 2400 feet Maximum total wire runs combined must not exceed 4000 ft regardless of wire gauge (2000 ft. if shielded wire is used). —33— i' When running polling loop wires, they must be at least 6" away from A.C. voltage, � telephone, or intercom wiring. Since the polling loop is carrying data between the control panel and the devices, interference on this loop can cause an interruption of this communication. The polling loop can also cause outgoing interference on the intercom or phone lines. If this spacing cannot be achieved, shielded wire must be used. (Note that the maximum total wire length supported is cut in half when shielded wire is used.) 2. Wire each device to the polling loop, making sure to use correct polarity when making connections (refer to the device's instructions). 3. Note the polling loop devices that have DIP switches on them. Set each device's DIP switches for the zone number you are assigning it. Refer to the device's instructions or the DIP Switch Tables found at the end of this manual when setting addresses. Certain polling loop devices, such as the 4139SN and 4191 SN, do not have DIP switches. Instead, they have embedded serial numbers which must be "enrolled" by the control during#93 Menu Mode Zone Programming. Note Twisted pair Z, ZZ 23 Z° ZS recommended for all normal + — wire runs. Polling loop rating: 64mA maximum. IMPORTANT: When in a star a ° configuration, no individual run can Z be longer than the table indicates, ° and the total length of all the sensor star runs, combined, cannot exceed 4000'. If using unshielded wire in RPM TORIGHTLOOP conduit or shielded wire, the ^ maximum is 2000'. If longer wire 4192SD Sv runs are needed, a 4197 Loop Extender Module must be used. 42�8 PIR Figure 13. Polling Loop Connections Polling Loop Limitations The built-in polling loop has the following limitations that must be observed: • The maximum allowable current draw from the polling loop is 64mA. (Refer to the POLLING LOOP CURRENT DRAW WORKSHEET (found in Section 15: FINAL POWER-UP PROCEDURE for current draws of various polling loop devices.) If devices total more than 64 mA, a 4197 Polling Loop Extender Module is required. • Regardless of current draw, no more than 64 devices can be connected to this loop. Installations which require up to 86 zones will require the use of zone expanders which accommodate more than one zone per RPM device (4190WH (2 zones) or 4208 (8 zones)). If more devices are needed, a 4197 Polling Loop Extender Module must be used. —34— The 4197 Polling Loop Extender Module may be used to provide additional polling loop current, to extend the polling loop wire run, and/or to provide individual, electrically isolated polling loops (see Figure 14). � Be sure to include the total current drawn on the polling loop when figuring the total auxiliary load on the panel's power supply (use the AUXILIARY CURREN DRAW WORKSHEET in Section 15: FINAL POWER UP PROCEDURE. POWER FOR 4197 4197 may be powered from: 12VDC AT 80 MA 'Panel's auxiliary power output Power wires may run up to 375 feet using 16 AWG wire •Separate supply VISTA-50P 4197 VISTA-50PUL POLLING RPM •••••• RPM LOOP EXTENDER INPUT POLLING LOOP EXTENSION POLLING LOOP •64 MA MAX •64 MA MAX �UP TO 64 DEVICESl87 ZONES •UP TO 64 DEVICES/87 ZONES •NO INDIVIDUAL WIRE RUN ON THIS LOOP CAN BE •NO INDIVIDUAL WIRE RUN ON THIS LOOP CAN BE LONGER THAN THE TABLE LENGTHS. LONGER THAN THE TABLE LENGTHS. •TOTAL LENGTH OF ALL WIRE RUNS,COMBINED, •TOTAL LENGTH OF ALL WIRE RUNS,COMBINED, CANNOT EXCEED 4000 ft.(2000 ft.IF USING CANNOT EXCEED 4000 ft.(2000 ft.IF USING UNSHIELDED WIRE IN CONDUIT OR SHIELDED WIRE). UNSHIELDED WIRE IN CONDUIT OR SHIELDED WIRE). UP TO 87 DEVICESl87 ZONES COMBINED TOTAL LENGTH OF ALL WIRE RUNS ON BOTH LOOPS,COMBINED, CANNOT EXCEED 6400 ft.(3200 ft.IF USING UNSHIELDED WIRE IN CONDUIT OR SHIELDED WIRE). NOTES: •No more than one 4197 may be used •Refer to instructions provided with the 4197 for additional information on mounting,UL considerations,etc. Figure 14. Polling Loop Extender Module Wiring Polling Loop Supervision A short on the polling loop is indicated by a trouble on its supervisory zone (97) and reports as a trouble condition only, even if the system is armed. As such, it should be assigned zone type 05 if annunciation is desired. If a device on the polling loop fails (the panel cannot "see" that device), the partition (or partitions) that use that device will display a trouble condition for all zones associated with that device. If the panel is armed when a device fails, the zones associated with that device will cause an alarm on the corresponding partition(s). � A trouble on Zone 97 will not prevent a partition from being armed, as long as all polling loop zones on that partition are bypassed. —35— Programming Polling Loop Zones 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet (previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. 3. Program data field *24: IGNORE EXPANSION ZONE TAMPER (O=Enable Tamper; 1=lgnore Tamper) 3. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. �ZONE PROG? 'i Press 1 to enter ZONE PROGRAMMING mode. I1=Yes O=No II While in this mode, press � to display the next screen, or press �# to display the previous screen. Enter Zn No. Enter the zone number to be programmed (09 to 87). 00=QUIT 10 Press n to accept entry. C 10 ZT P RC In: L ' A summary screen for that zone will appear. ZT = � 00 1 00 --:N zone type; P=partition to which zone is assigned; RC � = report code for that zone; In:L = input type of zone Press � to continue. f 10 Zone Type � Each zone in a system must be assigned a zone Zone disabled 00 � type, which defines the way in which the system � responds to faults in that zone. Enter the zone Refer to the ZONE response type for each zone. The screen will TYPE DEFINITIONS automatically display the zone type for the number section for definitions of entered. Press Cto accept entry. If a different zone each zone type. response type is desired, enter a different number and press � Zone Types are as follows: 00 Assign For Unused Zones 06 24 Hour Silent Alarm 01 Entry/Exit#1, Burglary 07 24 Hour Audible Alarm 02 Entry/Exit#2, Burglary 08 24 Hour Auxiliary 03 Perimeter, Burglary 09 Fire 04 Interior Follower, Burglary 10 Interior Delay, Burglary 05 Trouble By Day/Alarm By Night 23 No Alarm Response (Used for Relay Activation) I10 Partition + Enter the partition number (1-8) you are assigning � this zone to. Press � to continue. I 10 Report Code 'i Enter the report code for this zone. (Enter the first �� _ � digit and press �. Enter the second digit and press � again. A summary of both digits. will be displayed). Press � to continue. —36— I 10 Input Type Enter the input device type as follows: � 6=serial number polling loop device (SL type); 7=DIP � switch type (left loop) polling loop device (DP type); 8=right loop of DIP switch type device (PS type). � Right loops refer to the use of the right (or secondary) loop on a 4190WH zone expander module and/or 4278 PIR. This loop allows standard contacts to be monitored by the polling loop (N.C. non-supervised devices only--CANNOT be used in UL installations). 10 LOOP NUMBER � If this is a previously"learned" sensor, the loop . number for this zone will appear. Press � to continue. OR �10 LEARN S/N ?� If type 6 was entered, and the sensor's serial I1=YES 0=N0 f number has not been "learned," the serial number can be learned now by entering 1 , or it can be learned later by using the SERIAL NUMBER LEARN menu. Enter 0 if serial number will be learned later. The summary screen will then appear(see summary screen description above). �10 INPUT S/N :L ' If learning the serial number now (entering 1 at the A000-0000:1 last prompt), this prompt appears. Fault the sensor two times. The keypad will beep twice after the first fault and three times upon receiving a matching fault signal. When the serial number has been successfully learned, its number appears in the display. Alternatively, if the serial number is printed on the device, it can be entered in manually. Once entered, press (")to display the next screen. IC 10 PROG AS SL:1 Press u to continue. The summary screen will then A001-3078:1 appear as it did when first entering the zone number to be programmed (see summary screen description above). Press � to display the "ENTER ZN NO?" prompt and program the next zone. After all zones have been programmed, enter 00 at this prompt and press n. The system will prompt "Quit Menu Mode?" Press 1 to quit. This will return you to normal (data field) programming mode. Press*99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. —37— Check-Out Procedure For Polling Loop Zones After installation of all polling loop zones is complete, each partition of the security system should be checked as follows: 1. Make certain that all devices and sensors connected to the polling loop are not in a faulted state. Doors and windows with contacts should be closed, PIRs should be covered (use a cloth to mask them temporarily if necessary). 2. With all hard-wired and polling loop zones intact, the Alpha keypads connected to the system should display: DISARMED READY TO ARM. If the keypad(s) begins beeping and the word "CHECK" is displayed, along with a zone or zone numbers, the system either does not see the displayed zone(s) or the tamper switches on 4190WH units are tripped. Please check your DIP switch settings for the zone(s), your connections, and/or that the covers for the 4190WH units are in place. Once the situation has been corrected, enter the [Security Code] + [OFF] sequence twice to clear the trouble. If the following is displayed, DISARMED Press * to show faults press the [�] key to display the faulted zone(s). Restore any faulted zone(s) as necessary. When the DISARMED...READY TO ARM message is displayed, you can proceed to the next step. 4. Fault and then restore every contact or sensor on each zone individually to ensure that it is being monitored by the system. Each time a zone is faulted, the keypads in the partition to which the zone is assigned should display the number of the faulted zone. When each zone is restored, the READY TO ARM message should appear again. L��, If a zone or zones are not displayed at the correct partition's keypad(s), check both keypad and zone programming to verify the correct partition assignment. 5. When you get the proper displays on the keypad(s), the polling loop zones in the system are functioning properly. 6. Unplug the AC transformer and continue to the next section. U L, �. The 4208 must either be mounted inside the VISTA-50P cabinet or in a separate enclosure which has a tamper supervised cover. 2. The 4190WH right loop must not be used, and the left loop must be EOLR supervised. 3. The 4278 auxiliary sensor loop cannot be used. 4. The 4194 is not UL Listed. 5. The 4197 must be powered from the VISTA-50PUL auxiliary power output or from a UL listed supplementary power supply. —38— Compatible Polling Loop Devices 4208 8-Zone Expander • Accommodates up to 8 zones via the polling loop. • DIP switch programmable. • The first two zones can be either normal or fast response (DIP switch selectable). • All zones are EOLR supervised (first six zones =4.7k ohms, last two zones = 30k ohms), provided with the 4208. 4190WH 2 -Zone Expander • Accommodates up to 2 zones via the polling loop. • DIP switch programmable. • The left zone can be EOLR supervised (required in UL installations), can accept either open or closed circuit sensors, and can be set for fast response. • The right zone is unsupervised and can accept closed circuit sensors only(cannot be used in UL installations).. 4278 Quad PIR • Quad element PIR with built-in RPM (connects directly to the polling loop). • DIP switch programmable. • Includes mirrors for both wide angle and curtain/long range applications. • Features an auxiliary sensor loop that is non-supervised and can accept closed circuit sensors only (cannot be used in UL installations). 4275 Dual PIR • Dual element PIR with built-in RPM (connects directly to the polling loop). • DIP switch programmable. • Includes mirrors for both wide angle and curtain/long range applications and can use the 1875PA Pet Alley mirror. • Built-in selectable pulse count capability. 4194 Surface Mount • Wide gap surface mounted reed contact Reed Contact with built-in RPM (connects directly to (Wide Gap) the polling loop). • DIP switch programmable. with built-in RPM (connects directly to the polling loop). • DIP switch programmable. —39— Compatible Polling Loop Devices 4197 Extender Module • Used to increase the polling loop current (64mA), to extend the polling loop wire run length, and/or to provide individual, electrically isolated loops. • Connects to the polling loop and is powered from panel's auxiliary power or by a separate power supply with battery backup. 4192SD Photoelectric • One piece photoelectric smoke detector with Smoke Detector built-in RPM. • DIP switch programmable. 4192SDT Photoelectric • One piece photoelectric smoke detector with Smoke Detector 135°F (57°C) heat detector, and built-in RPM. w/Heat Detector • DIP switch ro rammable. 4192CP lonization • One piece products of combustion ionization Smoke Detector detector with built-in RPM. • DIP switch ro rammable. 4139SN Serial Number • Compact surface mount magnetic reed Surface Mount contact with built-in RPM. Reed Contact • Serial number ID "learned" by control panel. 4191SN Serial Number • Recessed (1/2"dia.) magnetic reed contact Recessed with built-in RPM. Reed Contact • Serial number ID "learned" by control panel. 4939SN Surface Mount • Surface mount magnetic reed contact with Magnatic Reed built-in RPM. Contact • 5 ft.jacketed cable. • Serial Number ID "learned" by control panel. 4959SN Aluminum • Aluminum overhead door contact Overhead Door • 24-inch armored cable Contact • Serial number ID "learned" by control. 7500 Single Technology • Glass break detector with built-in RPM. Glass Break Detector • DIP switch programable. 9500 Dual Technology • Dual technology glass-break detector with Glass Break Detector built-in RPM. • DIP switch programmable. —40— � � � � � • • This section provides the following information: • Common characteristics of wireless zones • Wireless systems available • Installing the wireless receiver(4281/5881) • Installing the 5800TM Module • Programming the wireless receiver(4281/5881) • Installing the wireless transmitters (5700/5800 series) • Programming the wireless transmitters (5700/5800 series) • Checkout Procedure for wireless zones (test modes) Common Characteristics of Wireless Zones • Supervised by control panel for check-in signals (except certain non- supervised transmitters) • Individually assignable to one of 8 partitions U L Wireless may not be used in UL Commercial Burglary installations. l Wireless Systems Available The VISTA-50P supports wireless zones which may be used exclusively or in addition to hardwire and/or polling loop zones. The system supports two different wireless systems which have many similarities, but notable differences in the programming of the transmitters for each system. The following receivers may be used with this system and each supports the number of zones shown below: 5700 Series Recvr Zones 4281 L u p to 4 4281 M up to 8 4281 H up to 63 5800 Series Recvr Zones 5881 L u p to 8 5881 M up to 16 5881 H up to 86 L � In Canada, 5800 systems must use 5882 series receivers: 5882L/5882H. �// Information in this manual relative to the 5881 receivers applies as well to the � 5882 receivers. 5881 and 5882 receivers can all use the same transmitters. —41 — Wireless System Operation and Supervision • The receiver responds to status and alarm signals from wireless transmitters (@ 345MHz USA; 315MHz (5700 series) and 345 MHz (5800 series) Canada)within a nominal range of 200 feet, and relays this information to the control. • Each supervised transmitter sends a supervisory signal to the receiver every 70-90 minutes. If, after a programmed interval of time (i.e., 12 hrs), the receiver does not hear from a particular transmitter, the word CHECK will appear at the corresponding partition's keypad(s) accompanied by the zone number in question. The trouble will not prevent you from arming the panel, as long as the zone is first bypassed. • If, within a programmed interval of time (i.e., 12 hrs), the receiver does not hear from any of its transmitters, a CHECK message will appear for zones 88 (2nd receiver) or 90 (1st receiver) if zone type 05 is assigned to these supervisory zones. This may be an indication that the wireless receiver is not able to"hear" signals. • The control checks the receiver connections about every 45 seconds. If the panel has lost communication with the receiver, a CHECK message will appear for zones 89 (2nd receiver) or 91 (1st receiver) if type 05 is assigned to these supervisory zones. This may be an indication that the wiring to the receiver is incorrect, or that the DIP switches are not set for the same address the receiver was assigned to in the panel's Device Programming mode. • Two identical receivers can be used to provide either a greater area of coverage, or to provide redundant protection. • Any zone from 1-63 can be used as a 5700 series wireless zone. Any zone from 1-86 can be used as a 5800 series wireless zone, with the exception of zone 64 (reserved for a wireless keypad). Wireless System Installation Advisories 1. Place the receiver in a high, centrally located area for best reception. Do not place receiver on or near metal objects. This will decrease the range and/or block transmissions. Do not mount receivers or transmitters in an attic, where extreme temperatures could prevent proper operation. 2. For maximum range, install the wireless receiver at least 10 feet from the Control panel or any keypads to avoid interference from the microprocessors in these units. 3. If dual receivers are used: A. Both must be at least 10 feet from each other, as well as from the Control panel and remote keypads. B. Each receiver must be set to a different Device Address (01-07). The receiver set to the lower address is considered the 1st wireless receiver for supervisory purposes. C. The house IDs must be the same (applies only to 5700 series or if using a 5827/5827BD wireless keypad). D. Using two Receivers does not increase the number of transmitters the system can support (63 zones using 4281 H; 86 zones using the 5881 H) plus a wireless keypad). L�� 4281 microprocessor must have part number N5334Vx, where x is any number. The microprocessor is located just above the DIP switch on the PC board. —42— Installation and Setup of the 4281/5881 Wireless Receivers 1. Mount the receiver(s). Receivers must be mounted externally to the control and can detect signals from transmitters within a nominal range of 200 feet. Take this into consideration when determining mounting location. 2. Connect the receiver's wire harness to the control's keypad terminals (6, 7, 8, and 9). Plug the connector at the other end of the harness into the receiver (see Figure 1�. 3. Refer to the installation instructions provided with the receiver for further installation procedures regarding antenna mounting, etc. � ANTENNAS " INSERT IN\ RIGHT-HAND TERMINALS YELLOW TO CONTROL'S REMOTE /n` /n1 RED KEYPAD CONNECTION �l 0 -- 0 V BLACK � -POINTS.EACH RECEIVER � GREEN MUST BE ON INDIVIDUAL CIRCUIT `� p�UG HOME RUN. BOARD WIRING � OPENING MOUNTING DIP SWITCH SOCKET HOLES INTERFERENCE KNOCKOUT INDICATOR �- AREAFOR LED->� � SURFACE O O WIRING ONHOFF �5 �q NOTE: DIPSWITCH POSITION#5(PRESENT ONLY ON 5881EH) �3 SWITCH POSITION ON: SETS 5881EH FOR USE IN COMMERCIAL FIRE 5 PRESENT ON APPLICATIONS(SEE THE RECEIVER'S INSTRUCTIONS). �Z 5881EH ONLY. OFF: USE IN NON-COMMERCIAL FIRE INSTALLATIONS. �1 Figure 15: 5881 Wireless Receiver(cover removed) 4. Set the receiver's DIP switches for an address (01-07)which is not being used by another device (i.e., keypads, relay modules, etc.). L� ,� Take note of the address you select for the wireless receiver as this address � must be enabled in the system's Device Programming mode (described later in this section . —43— Installing the 5800TM Module Installation of this module is necessary only if you are using one or more 5827BD Wireless Bi-directional keypads. The 5800TM must be located between one and two feet from the 4281 or 5881 receiver's antennas. The 5800TM must not be installed within the control cabinet. Mount the unit using its accompanying mounting bracket. 5800TM Wiring Connections Connect the 5800TM to the control panel's keypad connection terminals, using the supplied connector with flying leads, as follows: WIRE TERMINAL ON CONTROL RED (+12VDC) Terminal 6 BLACK(Ground) Terminal 7 GREEN (Data to Control) Terminal 8 YELLOW(Data from Control) Terminal 9 BLUE: Not Used Cut the red jumper for address setting 28; cut the white jumper for address 29; cut both jumpers for address 30. ����� This address must be enabled as an alpha keypad in the control's Device Programming mode and then assigned to a partition, as described later in this section. For additional information, refer to the 5800TM's instructions. Programming The Wireless Receiver 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temprarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: Installer Code + 8 0 0 . a. If using a 4281: set data field 1*32 to 1 If using a 5881: set data field 1*32 to 2 b. Set data field 1*30 RF RCVR CHECK-IN INTERVAL (02-15 times 2 hrs.). 3. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. Press 0 (NO) repeatedly until the "DEVICE PROG?" prompt appears. Follow the instructions below. DEVICE PROG? Press 1 to enter DEVICE PROGRAMMING mode. 1=yes 0=no , �DEVICEADDRESS? Enter the 2-digit device address number as set by �0131 � the receiver's DIP switches (01-07). Press � to continue. DEVICE TYPE � Enter device type 03 = RF Expander. . Press n to continue. RF EXPANDER Enter the 2-digit house ID (00-31) as determined by HOUSE ID XX sniffer mode (use an ID not displayed during sniffer mode, as explained later in this section). Applies only to 5700 series systems or if using a wireless keypad (5827/5827BD) with 5800 series systems. Press � to continue. The system will now prompt for the next device address to be programmed. —44� � The system House ID and the Device Address of the receiver are two different things. The House ID allows the system to identify transmitters with a matching House ID. If using 5700 series wireless systems, the DIP switches on the transmitters must match the system House ID programmed into the control. If using a 5827BD wireless keypad, the House ID also applies. Other 5800 series devices do not communicate by House ID, but by transmitting a unique serial number to the control. In this case, programming a House ID would not be necessary. The Device Address allows the system to identify the receiver as opposed to other devices connected to its keypad terminals. Therefore, the DIP switches on the RF Receiver must match the Device Address. 4. At the "DEVICE ADD?" prompt, press 00 � to exit Menu Mode programming and return to Data Field programming. Press *99 to exit programming mode or proceed to the next section. L�� If using a 5800 TM module, it must be programmed for Device Address 28, 29, or 30 (depending on which jumper(s) is cut)as either Device Type 1 or 2. U L For UL Household Fire/Burglary applications, use of 1 or 2 RF RCVRs requires enabling their respective faults (88-91) as applicable (type 5). House ID Sniffer Mode This mode applies only to 5700 series systems, or if you are using a wireless keypad (5827/5827BD) in a 5800 series system. 5700 series receivers respond only to transmitters set to the same House ID (01- 31) that is programmed into the control panel. This prevents system interference from transmitters in other nearby systems. Use the House ID Sniffer Mode to make sure you do not choose a House ID that is in use in a nearby system. To enter this mode, proceed as follows: 1. Enter your"Installer Code" + � +�, 2. The receiver will now "sniff" out any House IDs in the area and display them. Keep the receiver in this mode for about 2 hours to give a good indication of the House IDs being used. Use a House ID that is not displayed. 3. To exit the Sniffer Mode, simply enter your Installer Code + OFF. L�� Since Sniffer Mode effectively disables wireless point reception, Sniffer Mode cannot be entered while any partition is armed. —45— 5700 Series Transmitter Setup Each 5700 series transmitter has DIP switches to set both the transmitter's zone number (Transmitter ID) and the system House ID. The House ID will be the same for all transmitters and must match the House ID programmed into the system (via Device Programming) for the wireless receiver. This can be likened to a family in which everyone has the same last name (House ID), but each person has a different first name (Transmitter ID). The zone number must then be programmed into the system using #93 Menu Mode—Zone Programming Menus. 5700 Series Transmitter Supervision • Each transmitter (except 5701 and 5727) is supervised by a check-in signal that is sent to the receiver at 70-90 minute intervals. If at least one check-in is not received from a transmitter within a certain period of time (Programmed in field 1*31), the keypad will display the zone number and "CHECK." • Each transmitter(including 5701 and 5727) is also supervised for a low battery condition, and will transmit a low battery signal to the receiver when the battery has approximately 30 days of life remaining. The keypad will display the transmitter number and "LO BAT," (or "00" and LO BAT for a wireless keypad). 5700 Series Transmitter Battery Life • Batteries in the wireless transmitters may last about 2 years for 5700 series transmitters, depending on the environment, usage, and the specific wireless device being used. External factors such as humidity, high or low temperatures, as well as large swings in temperature, may reduce the actual battery life in a given installation. The wireless system can identify a true low battery situation, thus allowing the dealer or user of the system time to arrange a change of battery and maintain protection for that given point within the system. • Button type transmitters should be periodically tested by the user for battery life (ex. 5701). • After replacing a low or dead battery, activate the transmitter and enter the Security Code + OFF to clear its memory of the "Low Battery" signal. Installing 5700 Series Transmitters A variety of wireless system transmitters can be used to make up the wireless zones. These include window/door units, smoke detectors, PIRs, and panic buttons. Zone number assignments can be from 1-63. 1. Set the DIP switches on each 5700 series transmitter to the appropriate zone number and House ID. Refer to the Compatible Transmitters Table later in this section for zone numbers and programming information for each particular transmitter. 2. Install each transmitter in accordance with the instructions provided with the transmitter. Before permanently mounting the transmitters, make sure reception of each L�� transmitter's signal at the proposed mounting location is adequate. To do this, perform a Go/No Go test, which is described later in this section. 3. Program the transmitters using the #93 Menu mode Zone Programming option. Refer to PROGRAMMING WIRELESS ZONES later in this section for specific instructions. —46— Wireless Zone Assignments for 5700 Series Transmitters Each wireless zone can be assigned any zone response type, such as Entry/Exit, Interior Follower, Perimeter, etc. (see the ZONE TYPES section for explanations of each zone type). For 5700 series transmitters, each response type uses a certain range of zone numbers. Each range of zone numbers is indicated below: Zone Tvpe Trans/Zone# Entry/Exit Burg ................................. 1 through 47* Perimeter Burg................................. 1 through 47* Interior Burg ..................................... 1 through 47* 32 through 47 * (5775) Fire................................................... 48 through 63 * 48 through 55 ** (5706) 24 Hour Panic.................................. 48 through 63* (silent or audible) ............................. 62 or 63 '`** (5701) Day/Night Burglary........................... 1 through 47 * 24 Hour Auxiliary ............................. 1 through 47* * Note that zones 1-63 can be used, but have the following limitations: 1. Transmitters set for zones 48-55 will transmit once every 12 seconds while the zone is faulted. Transmitters set for zones 56-63 will transmit once every 3 seconds while faulted. These two ranges of zone numbers could adversely affect transmitter battery life. 2. Transmitters set for an ID of 32 through 47 will have a 3 minute lock-out between transmissions. Use this last range of zone ID numbers for sensors protecting frequently used doors or windows to conserve battery life. �` Transmitter IDs 48 through 55 have highest signal priority. *** Transmitter IDs 62 and 63 are unsupervised to allow removal of the 5701 off premises-- signal priority is lower than that of fire, but higher than burglary. —47— Compatible 5700 Series Transmitters Model Product Zone Num Descri tion 5701 Panic Transmitter 62 or 63 • Programmable for either silent or audible 24 hour alarm. 5706 Photoelectric Smoke 48-55 • One piece smoke detector with built Detector in transmitter. • Built-in UL Listed 85 dB piezo electric alarm sounder and audible low batte arnin . 5711 Slimline Door/ 1-63 • Can be used with any closed or open Window Transmitter circuit sensor. 5715WH Universal Transmitter 1 3 • DIP switch selectable for fast response, and open or closed sensor usage. • Has a tam er rotected cover. 5716 Door/Window 1-63 • Can be used with any open or closed 5716WM Transmitter circuit sensor. • Features a built-in reed switch. • 5716WM includes magnet. 5742 Audio Discriminator 1-63 • For use in unoccupied areas to detect the sound of shattering glass when a window is broken. 5743 Dual Technology 1-63 • Detects the sound and shock of Glassbreak Detector breaking glass and requires the presence of both to initiate an alarm condition. 5775 PIR Detector 32-47 • Dual element passive infrared detector with built-in selectable pulse count. Note: There is a 3 minute lock-out between fault transmissions to conserve battery life. 5727 Wireless Keypad House ID • Can be used to turn the burglary protection on and off • Features the same built-in panic functions as wired keypads. • Must be assigned to a partition. • Identified as zone "00" (on wired keypads)when it transmits with a low batte . 5827BD Wireless Keypad House ID •Same features as above plus: • Requires use of 5800TM Module (must be enabled in Device Programming. • Can indicate system status via its 3 LEDs and sounder. • House ID must be set. 5799 Magnets • Package of 8 magnets for use with 5716 transmitters U L The 5711, 5715, and 5716 do not supervise their loop wiring. Therefore, the loop wiring may not exceed 3 feet. —48— 5800 Series Transmitter Setup 5800 series transmitters have built-in serial numbers that must be "learned" by the system using the # 93 Menu mode programming, or input to the control via the downloader. 5800 series transmitters (except 5827 described separately) do not have DIP switches. Each transmitter's zone number is programmed into the system in # 93 mode. Some transmitters, such as the 5816 and 5817, can support more than one "zone" (referred to as loops or inputs). On the 5816 for example, the wire con- nection terminal block is loop 1, the reed contact is loop 2. Each loop must be assigned a different zone number and learned separately. For button transmitters (wireless "keys"), such as the 5803 and 5801 , you must assign a unique zone number to each individual button used on the transmitter. Each button on the transmitter also has a pre-designated loop or input number, which is automatically displayed when learned. 5800 Series Transmitter Supervision Except for some transmitters that may be carried off-premises (5802, 5802CP, 5803, 5827, and 5827BD), each transmitter is supervised by a check-in signal that is sent to the receiver at 70-90 minute intervals. If at least one check-in is not received from each supervised transmitter within a programmed time period (i.e., 12 hrs.), the "missing"transmitter number(s) and "CHECK"will be displayed. The supervision for a particular transmitter that may be carried off the premises (5801 , 5802MN) may be turned off by learning it as a "UR" (Unsupervised RF) type, as described later. 5800 series transmitters have built-in tamper protection and will cause a "CHECK" condition to be annunciated if covers are removed, provided that program field *24 (Disable Expansion Zone Tamper) is set for"0." 5800 Series Transmitter Input Types All of the transmitters described have one or more unique factory assigned loop inputs. Each of the inputs requires its own programming zone (e.g., a 5803's three button inputs require three programming zones). Transmitters can be learned as one of the following types: Type Description "RF" Sends periodic check-in signals, as well as fault, (Supervised RF) restore, and low battery signals. The transmitter must remain within the rec iver's range. "UR" Sends all the signals that the "RF" type does, (Unsupervised RF) but the control does not supervise the check-in signals. The transmitter may therefore be carried off-premises. "BR" These send only fault signals. They do not send (Unsupervised Button low battery signals until they are activated. The RF) transmitter may be carried off-premises. 5800 Series Transmitter Battery Life • Batteries in the wireless transmitters may last from 4-7 years, depending on the environment, usage, and the specific wireless device being used. External factors such as humidity, high or low temperatures, as well as large swings in temperature may all reduce the actual battery life in a given installation. The wireless system can identify a true low battery situation, thus allowing the dealer or user of the system time to arrange a change of battery and maintain protection for that given point within the system. • Some transmitters (e.g., 5802, 5802CP, and 5803) contain long-life but non- replaceable batteries. At the end of their life, the complete unit must be replaced (and a new serial number learned by the control). —49— • Button type transmitters (ex. 5801, 5802, 5802CP & 5803) should be periodically tested by the user for battery life. L� ;� Do not install batteries in wireless transmitters until ready to learn, as will be �� indicated under Programming the Wireless Transmitters later in this section. Though it is not critical to remove batteries after learning, it is recommended in order to avoid interFerence while learning additional transmitters. Compatible 5800 Series Transmitters Model Product Learn As Description In ut T e 5801 Wireless Panic UR or RF • Has four pushbuttons, each with a Transmitter unique input(loop) code. • Programmable responses (e.g., Panic, Arm—Stay, Arm—Away, Disarm, etc. • For arming/disarming functions, button must be assigned to a user code when "addin a user." 5802 Pendant BR Only • Has single pushbutton. (Personal Emergency • Usually be programmed for Transmitter) response type of 24Hr. Audible or 24 Hr. Silent (other zone responses are possible. 5802CP Belt Clip • Contains a non-replaceable (Personal Emergency battery. At the end of the battery's Transmitter) life, the entire unit must be replaced. • If using for arming/disarming, the button must be assigned to a user code when "addin a user." 5802MN Miniature UR or RF • Has single pushbutton. (Personal Emergency • Usually programmed for a Transmitter) response type of 24 Hr. Audible or 24 Hr. Silent (other zone responses are possible. • If using for arming/disarming, the button must be assigned to a user code when "addin a user". 5803 Wireless Key BR Only • Has three pushbuttons, each with Transmitter a unique input (loop)code. • Programmable responses (e.g., Arm—Stay, Arm—Away, Disarm, etc.). • Contains a non-replaceable battery. At the end of the battery's life, the entire unit must be replaced. • If using for arming/disarming, the button must be assigned to a user code when "addin a user." 5806 Wireless RF • One piece smoke detectors with 5807 Photoelectric built in transmitter. Smoke Detectors —50— Model Product Learn As Description In ut T e 5816 Door/Window RF • Has two unique input (loop)codes: Transmitter: one for a wired closed circuit contact loop; the other for a built-in reed switch (used in conjunction with a ma net . 5816 Low Temperature RF • Transmits a fault condition when TEMP Sensor temperature drops below 45 degrees. • Learned into the system by the internal reed switch using a ma net. 5817 Multi-Point Universal RF • Has three unique input (loop) Transmitter codes: one for a "Primary" contact loop with programmable options; the others for two "Auxiliary" closed circuit contact loo s. 5818 Recessed Transmitter RF • Reed switch magnetic contact sensor that is easily concealed in the frame and edge of a door or window. • Has a single unique input(loop) code. 5827 Wireless Keypad House ID • Can be used to turn the burglary protection on and off • Features the same built-in panic functions as wired keypads • The keypad is identified as zone "00" on wired keypads when it transmits with a low batte . 5827BD Wireless House ID (used with 5800TM Module) Bi-directional Keypad Operates the system similarly to wired keypads • Can indicate system status via its 3 LEDs and sounder. • Includes 3 panic keys. • House ID must be set. • Requires 5800TM Transmitter Module (must be enabled in #93 Menu Mode—Device Programming and assi ned to a artition in 1*48 5849 Glass Break Detector RF • Requires both sound and shock of breaking glass to cause alarm to be transmitted. • Has uni ue in ut code. 5890 PIR Detector RF • Dual element passive infrared detector/transmitter with built-in selectable pulse count. • Has unique input code Note: There is a 3 minute lock-out be- tween fault transmissions to conserve batte life. 5899 Magnets Package of 4 magnets for use with 5816 and 5817 transmitters. U L The 5816 and 5817 do not supervise their loop wiring. Therefore, for UL Household Burglary installations, the loop wiring may not exceed 3 feet. —51 — Programming Wireless Transmitters Zone number assignments can be from 01-63 for 5700 series transmitters, and 01-86 for 5800 series transmitters, except for zone 64, which is reserved for a wireless keypad. 1. With at least one alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet (previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: Installer Code + 8 0 0 . 3. Press *94 to enter the second page of data fields and program the following data fields: 1*28 RF TX LOW BATTERY ANNUN (1=immediate; 0=when disarmed)--must be "1"for UL installations. 1*29 RF TX LOW BATTERY REPORT ENABLE (1=yes; 0=no) --must be "1"for UL installations. 1*31 RF TRANSMITTER CHECK-IN INTERVAL (02-15 times 2 hrs)-- max. of"6"for UL installations 1*44 WIRELESS KEYPAD TAMPER DETECT (1=yes; 0=no) 1*48 WIRELESS KEYPAD ASSIGNMENT ( 1*49 SUPPRESS TX SUPERVISION SOUNDING (1=yes; 0=no) --must be "0"for UL installations. If using a wireless button (5801, 5803, etc.), also program the following fields: 1*57 5800RF BUTTON GLOBAL ARM (1=yes; 0=no) 1*58 5800 RF BUTTON FORCE BYPASS (1=yes; 0=no) 4. Press*99 to return to the first page of data fields. 5. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 'ZONE PROG? f Press 1 to enter ZONE PROGRAMMING mode. I1=Yes O=No �I While in this mode, press n to display the next screen, or press �# to display the previous screen. i Enter Zn No. ' Enter the zone number to be programmed (01-86). 00=QUIT 10 � Press � to accept entry. 10 ZT P RC In:L A summary screen for that zone will appear. ZT = � 00 1 00 RF:N zone type; P=partition to which zone is assigned; RC = report code for that zone; In: = input type of zone; L=learned RF input. Press n to continue. —52— �10 Zone Type II Each zone in a system must be assigned a zone IZone disabled 00 � type, which defines the way in which the system responds to faults in that zone. Enter the zone Refer to the ZONE response type for each zone. The screen will TYPE DEFINITIONS automatically display the zone type for the number section for definitions of entered. Press �to accept entry. If a different zone each zone type. response type is desired, enter a different number and press J. Zone Types are as follows: 00 Assign For Unused Zones 08 24 Hour Auxiliary 01 Entry/Exit#1, Burglary 09 Fire 02 Entry/Exit#2, Burglary 10 Interior Delay, Burglary 03 Perimeter, Burglary 20 Arm-Stay (5800 RF only)) 04 Interior Follower, Burglary 21 Arm-Away(5800 RF only) 05 Trouble By Day/Alarm By Night 22 Disarm (5800 RF only) 06 24 Hour Silent Alarm 23 No Alarm Response (Used for 07 24 Hour Audible Alarm Relay Activation) �10 Partition � Enter the partition number (1-8) you are assigning � � this zone to. Press � to continue. 10 Report Code Enter the report code for this zone. (Enter the first . digit and press �. Enter the second digit and press n again. A summary of both digits will be displayed). Press � to continue. I 10 Input Type Enter the Input Device Type as follows: I RF Trans. RF: � 0 = not used; 3=RF (supervised RF transmitter) 4=UR (unsupervised RF transmitter) 5=BR (button type RF transmitter-unsupervised) Press n to continue. ���;, For 5700 series systems, always enter"RF" type. The Summary screen will then be displayed. Press � to display the "ENTER ZN NO?�� prompt for programming the next zone. For 5800 series transmitters, see the Com atible 5800 Series Wireless Transmitter chart earlier in this section for the correct input type entry for each transmitter model. Then continue on to the next prompt. 10 LOOP NUMBER � If this is a previously "learned" sensor, the loop � number for this zone will appear. Press � to continue. OR If the sensor's serial number has not been "learned," i 10 LEARN S/N ? the serial number can be learned now by entering 1 �1=YES 0=N0 (or it can be learned later by using the SERIAL NUMBER LEARN mode). —53— �10 INPUT S/N :L If learning the serial number now (entering 1 at the A000-0000:1 last prompt), this prompt appears. Fault the and restore the transmitter (faulting is accomplished by pressing the appropriate button for button type transmitters, or by opening and closing zone sensors for other transmitters. The keypad will beep twice after the first transmission is received. Fault and restore the transmitter again. The keypad will beep three times to confirm the second transmission and acceptance into the system. The serial number will then be displayed on the keypad. Alternatively, if the serial number is printed on the device, you may enter it through the keypad (see each device's Installation Instructions for the desired "Loop" input for this zone. Then press n. The next screen will be displayed. �10 PROG AS RF:1 � Press * to continue. The summary screen will then � A001-3078:1 appear as it did when first entering the zone number � to be programmed (see summary screen description above). Press � to display the "ENTER ZN NO?" prompt for programming the next zone. After all zones have been programmed, enter 00 at this prompt and press �. The system will prompt "Quit Menu Mode?" Press 1 to quit. This will return you to normal (data field) programming mode. Press *99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. —54— Check-Out Procedure for Wireless Zones Go/No Go Test Mode Before mounting transmitters permanently, conduct Go/No Go tests to verify adequate signal strength and reorient or relocate transmitters if necessary. During this mode, wireless receiver gain is reduced by 50%. Testing in this mode assists in determining good mounting locations for the transmitters and verifies that the RF transmission has sufficient signal amplitude margin for the installed system. 1. Enter the Installer Code and press �5 (TEST). For multi-partition systems, all partitions must be disarmed in order for the RF signal gain to be reduced. The alpha keypad will display"Burg Walk Test, Reduced RF Sens." 2. Once transmitters are placed in their desired locations and the approximate length of wire to be run to sensors is connected to the transmitter's screw terminals, fault each transmitter. Do not conduct this test with your hand wrapped around the transmitter as this will cause inaccurate results. • If a single receiver is used, the keypad will beep three times to indicate signal reception. If two receivers are used, the keypad will beep once if the first receiver received the signal, twice if the second receiver received the signal and three times if both receivers heard the signal (which is desirable for redundant configurations). • If the keypad does not beep, reorient or move the transmitter to another location. Usually a few inches in either direction is all that is required. 3. Mount the transmitter according to the instructions provided with the transmitter. 4. Exit the mode by entering Installer Code + 1� (OFF). Transmitter ID Sniffer Mode When all transmitters have been installed, use the Transmitter Sniffer Mode to test that they have all been properly programmed. 1. Enter Installer Code + # 3. The keypad will display all zone numbers of wireless units programmed into the system. 2. Fault each wireless zone, causing each device to transmit. As the system receives a signal from each of the transmitters, the zone number of that transmitter will disappear from the display. L�� A transmitter not "learned" (5800 series) or dipswitched correctly (5700 series) � will not turn off its zone number. 3. To exit the Transmitter Sniffer mode, enter the Installer Code + � (OFF). —55— • � � 1 • � . ♦ � . � 1 � � � � � This section provides the following information: • Output Device Basics • Wiring the 4204 relay module • Wiring the 4300 transformer • Programming the 4204 relay module • Programming output devices • Programming relay voice descriptors Output Device Basics Relays and Powerline Carrier devices (i.e., X-10 brand devices) are programmable switches that can be used to perform many different functions. They can be used to turn lights on and off, control sounders, or for status indications. In this system, each device must be programmed as to how to act (ACTION), when to activate (START), and when to deactivate (STOP). Each of these is described in Programming Options Defined, later in this section and in the programming procedure (#93 Relay Programming mode) provided at the end of this section. The system supports a total of 16 relays (provided by 4204 Relay modules) and/or Powerline Carrier devices. Each 4204 module provides 4 relays with Form C (normally open and normally closed) contacts. Powerline Carrier devices are controlled by signals sent through the electrical wiring at the premises via a 4300 transformer. Therefore, if using Powerline Carrier devices, a 4300 transformer must be used in place of the regular system transformer. L� � This section is used to program output devices to activate in response to a �� programmed condition. The system can also be programmed to activate these devices at specific times by using the#80 Scheduling Menu Mode—Time Driven Events function. Wiring the 4204 Relay Module 1. Set the 4204 DIP switches for a device address between 01-15 that is not being used by another device (keypads, RF receivers, etc.). If using more than one module, each module must be set to a different address. L��� The relay module will not operate until the device address you have chosen is enabled in the control's Device Programming mode. 2. Connect the 4204 module(s) to the control's keypad terminals (6, 7, 8, and 9). Use the flying lead cable supplied with the relay module when mounting it in the control's cabinet. Use standard 4-conductor twisted cable when mounting the 4204 outside the cabinet. 3. Home run each 4204 back to the panel. The maximum wire run length from the panel to the 4204 must not exceed: Wire Gauqe Maximum Lenqth #22 125 feet #20 200 feet #18 300 feet #16 500 feet —56— 4204 RELAY MODULE SWITCH 4204 ADDRESS SETTINGS OFF��+ON POSITION ("—"means"OFF") ,�� 1 0 I 7 2 3 4 � 5 6 7 8 I 9 70 I 11 72 : 13 14 I 15 N� «. 2 oN I— oN — oN � — oN — oN I — oN � — oN' — oN�— w� p. 3 ON ON — — ON I ON — — ON ON — I — ON ON — I— a� �.. 4 ON ON ON ON — — — — ON ON ON ON — — — — �� 5 oN oN oN oN oN I oN oN oN — — — I — I — I 4204 R�AY � c ��DIPSWITCH TYPICAL ,�. � �� NC FOR SETTING DEVICE ADDRESS (SHOWN"OfF') � � NO AND ENABLING/DISABLING TAMPER RELAY ��;J � COVERTAMPER(REED)SWITCH 3 '/�.i� NC i V NO 1 4-PW KEYPAD PLUG � RELAY O � ❑ (J NC EITHER OR BOTH �� �j NO CAN BE USED y `� RELAY OO� � l TB7 L � � � NC 73 14 (75 �) . � NO YEL DATAIN ��TB2 FROM CONTROL BLK (_)GROUND GRN DATA OUT TO CONTROL RED (+)12V Figure 16: 4204 Relay Module Wiring the 4300 Transformer Powerline Carrier devices (such as X-10, ACT, Leviton) are either plugged into standard AC outlets or wired into the AC electrical system by a licensed electrician, depending on the type of device used. They respond to "on" and "off" commands sent from the panel, through the 4300 transformer, to the receiving devices. Connect the 4300 transformer as follows: 1. Run a 6-conductor cable between the 4300 interface and the panel. Splice this cable to a 4142TR cable as shown in the diagram below. Note that the white and yellow wires of the 4142TR must be spliced together. 2. Set the proper House and Unit Codes for each device following the instructions provided with each device. Note each device's setup, as these codes will be used to program the devices later. 4300 TRANSFORMER/INTERFACE � � 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 JBCONNECTOR � E3rth � Q O ~ � W � W a AC Ground AC Sync Data Com O d' W = W K fL 1 2 3 4 OS 6 > � Y � rL C7 m m m ?� �� 2� 2� � �pJ �h J��pJ�pJ C> O p G C� 4142TR CABLE TB1 TB1 TB1 -1 30 -2 Figure 17. 4300 Transformer Connections —57— Programming the Relay Module 1. With at least one alpha keypad (5137AD/6139 wired and set to a proper address, temporarily power up the system by plugging the transformer into a 120VAC outlet. 2. Enter data field programming mode: (Installer Code + 8 0 0). 3. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 4. Press 0 (NO) to each menu option until the "DEVICE PROG?" prompt appears. �DEVICE PROG? � Press 1 (YES)to enter DEVICE PROGRAMMING mode. I 1=YES 0=N0 � The following prompts will appear. DEVICEADDRESS � The device address identifies the module to the control. 01-31, 00-QUIT � Enter the 2-digit address number as set at the module's DIP switches (01-15). Press � to continue. �DEVICE TYPE I Select the (relay) output device as follows: � 00 =device not used 04= output device Press J to continue. The system will prompt for the next Device Address to be programmed. 4. Repeat the procedure above for each relay module used in the system. 5. When all modules have been programmed, press 00 � at this prompt to exit menu mode programming. 6. Do not exit out of programming at this time, but continue to the next section. Output Programming Options Defined The following will help you understand the programming of OUTPUT DEVICES when using the#93 Relay Programming mode. The options used to start and stop these devices are described below, followed by the actual screen prompts and available entries. The letter(s) in parentheses after each function described below, such as (A) after ACTION, are those that appear in the various summary displays of programmed data during programming. ACTION (A) The "ACTION" of the device is how the device will respond when it is activated by the "START" programming. You may want the device to activate momentarily, to pulse on and off continuously, or to remain activated until some other event occurs to stop it. There are four different choices of actions: • ACTIVATE for 2 SECONDS and then reset. • ACTIVATE and REMAIN ACTIVATED until stopped by some other event. • PULSE ON and OFF until stopped by some other event. • NO RESPONSE when the device is not used. START (STT) The "START" programming determines when and under what conditions the device will be activated. The following START options are available� -58- 1) a. EVENT (EV) is the condition (Alarm, Fault, Trouble) that must occur to a zone or group of zones (zone list) in order to activate the device. These conditions apply onlywhen a zone list is used. The different choices for"EVENT" are listed below and in "Programming Relays & Powerline Carrier devices" in the section that follows. • ALARM Relay action begins upon any alarm in an assigned zone in the zone list. • FAULT Relay action begins upon any opening (or short)of an assigned zone in the zone list. • TROUBLE Relay action begins upon any trouble condition on an assigned zone in the zone list. • NO RESPONSE Relay action is not dependent upon one of the above events. b. ZONE LIST (ZL) is a group of zones to which the "EVENT" applies in order to activate a particular device. Note that there are a total of 8 zone lists that can be programmed. When the selected EVENT (Alarm, Fault or Trouble) occurs in any zone in the selected "Start" ZONE LIST (1-8), activation of the selected device will START. 2) a. ZONE TYPE/SYSTEM OPERATION (ZT). This option may be used instead of using a "ZONE LIST" and "EVENT" to activate the device. If a specific "ZONE TYPE" is chosen, any zone of that re- sponse type going into alarm, trouble, or fault will cause the device to activate as selected in "ACTION." If the same "ZONE TYPE" is also chosen for the STOP programming, any zone of that type that restores will de-activate the device. If a System Operation, such as "DISARMING" or "ANY FIRE ALARM," is to activate the device, the appropriate choice would also be entered under the "ZONE TYPE" option. The selected operation will cause the device to activate as selected in "ACTION." The different choices for "ZONE TYPE" and "SYSTEM OPERATION" are listed in "Programming Relays & Powerline Carrier devices" later in this section, and in the Programming Form. � The"ZONE TYPE" option functions independently of the "EVENT/ZONE LIST" � combination. b. PARTITION No. (P). The device's "Start" ZONE TYPE/SYSTEM OPERATION may be limited to an occurrence on either one partition (1-8)or any partition (0). —59— STOP (STP): The "STOP" programming determines when and under what conditions the device will be de-activated. The following options are available: 1) a. RESTORE ZONE LIST (ZL). If a "ZONE LIST" is used as the "Stop" event, the device will de-activate when all the zones in that list restore from a previous fault, trouble, or alarm condition. This will occur regardless of what is programmed to "START" the device; therefore, a "RESTORE ZONE LIST" would normally only be used when a "ZONE LIST" is used to start the device. 2). a. ZONE TYPE/SYSTEM OPERATION (ZT). Instead of using a "RESTORE ZONE LIST", a specific zone (response) type or system operation action can be selected to de-activate the device. If a specific "ZONE TYPE" is chosen, any zone of that response type that restores from a previous alarm, trouble, or fault condition will cause the device to de-activate. If a "SYSTEM OPERATION" is chosen, that operation will cause the device to de-activate. The different choices for "ZONE TYPE" and "SYSTEM OPERATION" are listed in "Programming Relays & Powerline Carrier devices" later in this section, and in the Programming Form. b. PARTITION No. (P). The device's "Stop" Zone Type/System Operation may be limited to an occurrence on either one partition (1-8) or any partition (0). Programming Output Devices 1. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 2. Press 0 (NO) to each menu option until the "RELAY PROG?" prompt appears. Press 1 (YES). While in this mode, press � to advance to next screen. Press #to backup to the previous screen. I Enter Relay No. ' Enter the relay (output device) identification number "(00=Quit� 01 01-16. This is a reference number only, used for identification purposes. The actual module address and relay number on the module is programmed in the last two prompts. Press n to continue. �01 A EV ZL ZT P I The keypad will display a summary START screen. �STT 0 0 0 00 � Press u to continue. 01 A EV ZL ZT P The keypad will display a summary STOP screen. STOP 0 0 0 00 � Press n to continue. 01 Relay Action The Relay Action is the way in which the relay will No Response I respond when activated by the "start" event. Enter � � the desired action for this relay as follows: 0=not used; 1=closed for 2 secs.; 2=stay closed; 3=pulse on/off —60— 01 Start Event � A relay may be activated either by an Event used in Not used conjunction with a Zone List, or by a Zone Type/System Operation. If using an Event/Zone List combination, enter the event code as follows: 0=not used; 1=alarm; 2=fault; 3=trouble; 4=restore If not using a Zone List to activate the relay, enter 0. Press n to continue. �01 Start: Zn LIST A Zone List is a set of zones that can be used to �No list initiate the start or stop relay action. If a zone list is being used to start this relay action, enter the Zone List number 1-8. If a zone list is not being used, enter 0. Press n to continue. �01 Start: Zn Typ �I A Zone Type/System Operation can be used instead � f of an Event/Zone List combination to start the relay action. If a Zone Type/System Operation is being used, enter the 2-digit code as listed below. Press � to continue. Choices For StartlStop Zone Types: Choices For StartlStop System Operation: 00= No Response(Not Used) 20=Arming-Stay 43=Communication failure 01 = Entry/Exit#1 21 =Arming-Away 44= RF low battery 02= Entry/exit#2 22 = Disarming (Code+Off) 45= polling loop failure 03= Perimeter 31 = End of Exit Time 51 = RF receiver failure 04= Interior Follower 32 = Start of Entry Time 52=kissoff 05=Trouble Day/Alarm Night 33=Any Burglary Alarm 54=fire zone reset 06=24 Hr Silent 34 = Code+#+71 Key Entry 55=disarm + 1 minute 07=24 Hr Audible 35-Code+#+72 Key Entry 56 =XX minutes(enter XX in field 1*74; 08=24 Hr Aux 36=At Bell Timeout�* stop condition only) 09= Fire Alarm or Trouble 37=2 Times Bell Timeout*� 57=YY seconds(enter YY in field 1*75; 10= Interior w/Delay 38=Chime stop condition only) 23= No alarm response 39= Fire Alarm 58=Duress (for output relay activation, such 40=Bypassing 60=Audio Alarm Verification (must be as for access control purposes) 41 =AC Power Fail selected for both START and STOP 42 = System Battery Low operation) �*Or at Disarming,whichever occurs earlier L�� If using options 56 and/or 57 (usually as the STOP Zone Type), data fields 1*74 and 1*75 for the respective relay timeouts for minutes and seconds must b ro rammed. y 01 Start Part If the starting event will be limited to occurring on a � il specific partition, enter the partition number (1-8) in � which the start event will occur. Enter 0 for any partition. Press � to continue. .01 Stop: Zn LIST If a zone list is being used to stop this relay action, No list � enter the zone list number 1-8. The restore of all zone s on the Zone List will stop the relay. If a zone list is not being used, enter 0. Press � to continue. V 01 Stop: Zn Typ ', If a Zone Type/System Operation is being used to � ! stop the relay action, enter the 2-digit code as listed in the start Zone Type/System Operation prompt paragraph. Press � to continue. �01 Stop Part � This is the partition to which the stop condition will be limited. Enter 0 for any partition. Enter 1-8 for specific partition number. Press � to continue. —61 — Relay Group � Relays may be grouped for common activation by time driven events (commands 06-10--see Section 20: SCHEDULING OPTIONS for more information). Enter 0 (no group) or 1-8 for a specific group number. Press � to continue. �Restriction 1 The system may have some devices which are not ��es 0=no f intended to be under end user control, such as relays activating fire doors or machinery. Enter 1 if the end user will be restricted from accessing this relay. Press � to continue. � Relay Type � Enter 1 for 4204 relay outputs. Enter 2 for Powerline � Carrier devices. Press � to continue. ECP ADDRESS ' For relay module (4204) outputs, enter the actual relay module's address (01-15) as set by its DIP switches. �MODULE RELAY# For 4204 relay outputs, enter the specific relay I � number on that module (1-4). Press � to continue. House Code For Powerline Carrier devices, enter the numerical I equivalent of the House Code of the device as ' follows: A=00 E=04 1=08 M=12 B=01 F=05 J=09 N=13 C=02 G=06 K=10 0=14 D=03 H=07 L=11 P=15 � Unit Code � Enter the numberical unit code of the Powerline � I Carrier device (00-15). Press C to continue. The keypad will display the Start and Stop summary screens again. Press � to continue. 5. When all relays have been programmed, enter 00 at the "ENTER RELAY NO." prompt. 6. If defining a Zone List, continue to the next procedure in this section. If not, enter 00 + � at the next two prompts. Then enter *99 to exit programming completely. After exiting, enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. —62— Zone List Programming After all relays have been programmed, upon entering 00 at the "ENTER RELAY NO." prompt, you will be asked to enter a Zone List. If a Zone List number was used to start or stop a relay, you must define the zones belonging to that list as fol lows: `Enter Zone LIST 9 Enter the zone list number 01-08. Enter 00 to quit. �00=QUIT 00 ' �01 Enter Zn Num. l Using two-digit entries, enter each zone to be 00=QUIT 00 ! included in this zone list. Press � after each zone number is entered. When all zones have been entered, enter 00, then press n. �01 Del Zn LIST? � Enter 0 to save the zone list entered. Enter 1 to �O=No 1=Yes J delete that zone list. �01 Delete Zone? � Enter 1 to delete one or more zones in that zone list. �O=No 1=Yes Enter 0 if no changes are necessary. If 1 is entered, the next screen will appear, otherwise the "Enter Zone List" prompt will reappear. I01 Zn to Delete? � Enter each zone number to be deleted from the zone n 00=QUIT 00 list, pressing � after each number. View Zn LIST This will appear if 00 is pressed at the ENTER ZONE 00=QUIT 00 LIST prompt. Enter the zone list number that you wish to view. Press � to continue. XXASSIGNEDZONE Press � to scroll through all zones in that list. Enter 00=QUIT 00 ' 00+� to quit. Press*99 to exit program mode or continue to the next procedure in this section to program Relay Voice Descriptors. Upon exiting program mode, enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. Relay Voice Descriptors If using the 4285 VIP Module, voice descriptors can be programmed for each of the 16 relays/Powerline Carrier devices used in the system. These descriptors will be announced by the voice module when accessing the relays via the # 70 relay access mode via telephone. Each voice descriptor can consist of up to 3 words selected from the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list (found later in this section). L�� The index numbers from this vocabulary list are to be used for relay voice descriptors only. For normal system voice annunciation (eg. alarms, troubles, status), use the highlighted words in the alpha vocabulary list found in the alpha ro rammin section. To enter relay voice descriptors, do the following: 1. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 2. Press 0 (NO)to each menu option until the "RLY VOICE DESCR?" prompt is displayed. Follow the instructions below. While in this mode, press � to advance to next screen. Press I] to backup to previous screen. RLYVOICE DESCR? ' Press 1 to program voice descriptors for relays. 0=no 1 yes —63— ENTER RELAY NO. Enter the 2-digit relay/X-10 module number (01-16) 00=QUIT 01 for the relay desired, or enter 00 to quit relay voice descriptor programming mode. Press �. 01 ENTERDESC d1 � From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter � the 3-digit index number for the first word of the relay descriptor phrase. Press � to accept entry. 01 ENTERDESC d2 From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter � � the 3-digit index number for the second word of the _ � relay descriptor phrase. If second word is not desired, press 000. Press � to accept entry. 01 ENTERDESC d3 From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter the 3-digit index number for the third word of the relay descriptor phrase. If third word is not desired, press 000. Press � to accept entry. The ENTER RELAY NO. prompt will appear. Enter the next relay number to be programmed. When all output devices have been programmed, enter 00 to quit. Enter*99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. Relay Voice Descriptors and Custom Word Substitutes Vocabulary Word Index Word Index Word Index Word Index Word Index Air..................... 116 Daughter's........208 Garage............. 023 Off ....................011 South................ 155 Alarm................255 Den ...................052 Gas.................. 138 Office................ 147 Stairs................006 And ...................067 Detector............128 Glass ............... 139 On ....................058 Station .............. 156 Apartment.........117 Device ..............060 One ..................070 Storage.............157 Appliances ....... 161 Dim ...................163 Hall................... 050 Open ................ 148 Sun................... 154 Area..................118 Dining ...............031 Heat................. 010 Outside.............210 System .............062 Attic ..................119 Door .................016 Down ................008 Inside ............... 209 Panic................013 Temperature..... 158 Baby................. 120 Downstairs........184 Partition ............090 Third .................159 Back................. 121 Driveway...........130 Kitchen............. 022 Patio................. 149 Three................072 Bar ................... 122 Duct..................131 Phone............... 061 Tool ..................213 Basement.........021 Laundry............ 140 Power............... 063 Two ..................071 Bathroom..........051 East..................132 Left................... 027 Pump................ 166 Battery..............053 Eight .................077 Library.............. 141 Up.....................025 Bed ...................092 Eighth ...............221 Light................. 019 Rear ................088 Upper................ 187 Bedroom ..........015 Equipment ........133 Living ............... 030 Right.................028 Upstairs ............183 Blower .............. 123 Exit ...................004 Loading............ 142 Room ............... 018 Utility.................185 Boiler................ 124 Lower............... 094 Bright................ 162 Factory .............134 's ......................007 West .................215 Building ............ 125 Father's ............211 Machine ........... 143 Second .............056 Window ............017 Burglary............039 Fence ...............135 Master.............. 144 Service............. 150 Wing .................216 Fifth...................218 Medical ............ 014 Seven............... 076 Call ...................009 Fire ...................040 Mother's........... 212 Seventh ............220 Zero..................069 Central..............089 First .................136 Motion.............. 145 Shed................. 151 Zone .................002 Chime...............054 Five...................074 Shop................. 152 Closed .............. 126 Floor .................029 Nine ................. 078 Side.................. 153 Computer .........127 Four..................073 Ninth ................ 222 Six ....................075 Console............066 Fourth ...............217 No .................... 165 Sixth .................219 Foyer ................137 North ................ 146 Smoke.............. 024 Front.................087 Not 012 Son's ................223 —64— • 1 , • • - • ' • . ' • � This section provides the following information: • General information about the 4285 VIP module • Mounting and wiring the 4285 VIP module • Programming the control for 4285 VIP module access • Checkout procedure for the 4285 VIP module U L The 4285 VIP Module is not approved for UL installations.• General Information The 4285 VIP Module is an add-on accessory that permits the user to access the security system via a touchtone phone (either from on-premises or by calling the premises from a remote location). L�� Only one VIP Module can be used in a security system and partition assignment is done via#93 Menu Mode—Device Programming. The 4285 VIP Module enables the user to do the following via a Touch-tone telephone: A. Receive synthesized voice messages over the phone regarding the status of the security system. B. Arm and disarm the security system and perform most other commands using the telephone keypad. This usage provides voice annunciation over the phone to confirm any command that is entered. C. Control 4204 relays and/or Powerline Carrier devices using the #70 relay access mode. Facts You Need to Know • The VIP Module can announce many of the same words that would normally be displayed on an Alpha keypad under the same system conditions (see the words in bold in the Alpha Vocabulary list found in Section 19: #93 MENU MODE PROGRAMMING). If the VIP module cannot annunciate a word in a zone descriptor, it will not annunciate the descriptor at all, but will still annunciate the zone number. • Remote access to the VIP Module can be toggled on and off by using the [Security Code] + # 91 command (see VIP Module instruction manual). You must use the master or installer code only. • The VIP Module reports trouble as zone 87 if data communication with the control is lost. • Detailed operating instructions for phone access to the security system are provided with the VIP Module. In addition, a Phone Access User's Guide is supplied with the VIP Module for the user of the system. Mounting the 4285 VIP Module The VIP Module may be mounted in the control cabinet if space is available or, if this is not possible, on the side of the cabinet or adjacent to it. Pry off the VIP Module's cover prior to wiring. 1. When the VIP Module is mounted inside the control cabinet, attach it to the cabinet's interior surface with 2-faced adhesive tape. —65— L� � Do not mount the VIP Module on the cabinet door or attempt to attach it to th >� PC board. 2. When mounting the VIP Module outside the cabinet, use the screw holes at the rear to mount horizontally or vertically (2-faced adhesive tape may be used, if preferred). You can bring wires out from the side or back (a round breakout is also available on the back). 3. Affix the 4285 connections label (supplied separately)to the inside of the VIP Module's cover if the cover is used. Otherwise, affix the label to the inside of the control cabinet's door. Wiring the 4285 VIP Module The 4285 is wired between the control panel and the premises handset(s). It listens for touch tones on the phone line and reports them to the control panel. During on-premises phone access, it powers the premises phones; during off- premises phone access, it seizes the line from the premises phones and any answering machines. Wire as follows: 1. Make 12V (+) and (—) and data in and data out connections from the VIP Module to the control", using the connector cable supplied with the VIP Module (see below). RED 6 (AUX+) BLACK 7 (AUX-) GREEN 8 (DATA IN) YELLOW 9 (DATA OUT) "These are the same connections as for remote keypads. 2. Insert the keyed connector at the other end into the mating header on the VIP Module. 3. Connect terminals 1 through 5 on the VIP Module as shown in Figure 18. L���� You must use an RJ31X jack with a direct-connect cord and make all connections exactly as shown. If the leads on the direct-connect cord are too short to reach their assigned terminals, splice additional wires to them, as required. Terminal Block Connections 4285 Terminal Connects to: 1. Phone In Ti Terminal 26 on control. 2. Phone In Rin Terminal 27 on control. 3. Phone Out Ti BROWN lead from direct-connect cord. 4. Phone Out Rin GRAY lead from direct-connect cord. 5. Ground Earth round terminal 30 on control. 6. Audio Out 1 Future use 7.Audio Out 1 Future use —66— 4285 WIRING NOTES: 1. Wire the 4285 VIP Module exactly as shown, using a direct-connect cord and RJ31Xjack. 2. If Touch-tones are not present following phone access to the security system via an on-premises phone, try reversing the pair of wires connected to terminals 3 & 4 on the 4285, and the pair of wires connected to terminals 26 &27 on the control. 3. Connection to the incoming Telco line via a RJ31X jack and direct-connect cord, as shown in this diagram, is essential, even if the system is not connected to a central station. The 4285 will not function if this is not done. 4. The house phone lines must be connected to the VIP Module terminals only! If they are connected directly to the control panel or to the incoming line, an error tone will be heard when trying to access the VIP Module from an on-premises phone. 5. If the telephone system on the premises includes a Caller ID unit, connect the unit directly to the "HandseY' terminals (26 and 27) on the control. Incoming ° Handset Telco Line o ��� r� � TERMINALS ON CONTROL � �s) �� 28� 29 30�EARTH GROUND � � � � �� � INCOMING TELCO LINE CALLER ID�� O a Q� a Z C9 UNIT p a Z �� �Z z � DIRECT � � IMPORTANT NOTE � �-� W o CONNECT FOR EXISTING V W � � CORD RJ31X TIP INSTALLATIONS: Z z � �♦ �qCK RING EXISTING WIRES z O� U PREMISES CONNECTED TO THE �� �N r ANSWERING "HANDSET"TERMINALS r� �a pLUG MACHWE AND ON CONTROL MUST BE �Z �p PHONES MOVED FROM THERE �O TO TERMINALS 3 AND 4 � ANSWERING I ON THE 4285. � ~ MACHINE � Z > � Q O 4285 �g � m VIP MODULE TO 6ND TERMINAL �e �*� ON CONTROL �° MN � �q r NOTINSTALLER � ADJUSTABLE KEYED � HEADER ar------°-----`---------------� 4285 TERMINAL ASSIGNMENTS UNUSED YELLOW�.TO DATA OUT(term.9) i 1-TIP NO CONNECTION TO CONTROL PANEL;2_RING PHONE INPUT CONNECTOR RED: TO AUX(+)(term.6) TERMINALS USED i WITH FLYING -BLACK: TO AUX.GROUND(-)(term.7) FOR KEYPAD i 3-TIP �pHONE OUTPUT LEADS GREEN: TO DATA IN(term.8) CONNECTIONS ; 5-GIROUND ' 6- }AUDIO OUT 1 i � (FOR FUTURE USE) i `---------------------------� Figure 18. 4285 VIP Module Connections Programming 4285 VIP Module Options 1. With at least one alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, temporarily power up the system by plugging the transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0 and program the following fields: *20 VIP MODULE PHONE CODE *44 RING DETECTION COUNT (cannot be set to 0) *74/*75 ALARM REPORT CODE for VIP module faults (zone 87) 1*09 ZONE RESPONSE TYPE for VIP module (zone 87, type 05) —67— 3. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. Press 0 to each menu option until "DEVICE PROG?" prompt is displayed. DEVICE PROG? A Press 1 to enter DEVICE PROGRAMMING mode. 1= es 0=no ' DEVICEADDRESS 9 The device address identifies the device to the 01-31,OO�UIT control. The VIP module is factory set to address 04. Enter 04. Press �*� to continue. DEVICE TYPE ' Enter device type 05 = voice module . Press � to continue. MODULE PART. 'i Enter the partition number 1-8 in which the voice module is located. Press � to continue The screen will prompt for the next device number to be programmed. 4. Press 00 at this prompt to return to the main menu. Press 0 until ALPHA DESCRIPTORS prompt appears. Press 1 (YES). 5. Program alpha zone descriptors according to the procedure explained in Section 19: #93 MENU MODE PROGR,4MMING. Alpha descriptors must be programmed if you want the VIP Module to annunciate a description of the zone(s) in alarm, trouble, etc. If not, the VIP Module will annunciate zone numbers only. If you are using output relays, you can program relay voice descriptors. Refer to Section 9x : RELAY OUTPUTS AND POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES . Custom Word Substitutes for VIP Module Annunciation A substitute word can be programmed for each of the 20 custom words used in your alpha zone descriptions. This substitute word will be announced by the VIP module in place of the custom word that is displayed on the alpha keypad. For example, an alarm display of "John's Bedroom" could be announced as "Son's Bedroom," since there is no annunciation for the custom word "John." Note that if a substitute word is not assigned, the VIP module will not annunciate the zone descriptor at all, but will only annunciate the zone number. To enter custom words substitutes, do the following: 1. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 2. Press 0 (NO) to each menu option until the "CUSTOM INDEX ?" prompt is displayed. CUSTOM INDEX? Enter 1 at this prompt. 0=no 1- s CUSTOMW�ORDNO. Enter the custom word number (01--20) for which a �00=QUIT � voice substitute is desired. Enter 00 to quit this programming mode. Press u to accept entry. 01 ENTERINDEX# � Enter the 3-digit substitute word index number from the relay voice descriptor and custom word substitutes vocabulary list found in the Relay Voice Descriptors section. Press � to accept entry. The "CUSTOM WORD NO." prompt will be displayed. Enter the next custom word number to be substituted or enter 00 to quit. -68- • � � � � � � � � � � � This section provides the following information: • General information about the AAV option • AAV operation • Connecting an Eagle AAV Module • AAV programming requirements General Information An Audio Alarm Verification (AAV) module (also known as two-way voice), such as the Eagle 1241, is an add-on accessory that permits voice dialog between an operator at a central station and a person at the alarm installation, for the purpose of alarm verification. This feature is supported only if alarm reports are programmed to be sent to the primary phone number. The AAV module connects from module terminals 7 & 8 to the control's zone 5 terminals 16 & 17. The purpose of this connection is to silence and restore the sounders at the premises. It is also used to postpone non-critical dialer reports while the AAV session is in progress. Note that zone 5 is then no longer available as a protection zone. When using the AAV, zone 5 must be assigned a zone response type (e.g. response type 10), and option 1*60 must be selected as 1 to silence sounders on the premises. If 1*60 is not enabled, conversation with the premises will be difficult (too much noise on the premises). AAV Module Operation After all messages have been sent during a reporting session to the primary phone number, the control will trigger the AAV if at least one of the messages was an alarm report. If Contact ID format is selected for the primary phone number, and the cancel report field *81 is programmed as non-zero, the control will send a "listen-in to follow" message (event code 606), which signals the 685(rev. 4.6 or higher)to hold the phone connection for 1 minute. Once triggering occurs, the control will give-up the phone line to the AAV module, without breaking connection with the central station. During the time the AAV is active, all sirens and all continuous keypad sounds in all partitions will be shut off if field 1*60 is enabled. When the AAV indicates that the audio alarm verification session is completed, all keypad sounds will be restored. Sirens will be restored if the alarm timeout period has not expired. As part of its fail-safe software, the control will limit all audio alarm verification sessions to 15 minutes (this is because once the session begins, the AAV module controls the duration). If a new fire alarm should occur during a session, the control will break phone connection and send the new fire alarm report, then re-trigger AAV mode. All other dialer messages triggered during on-going conversation will be held until either the AAV module signals that it is inactive, or the 15 minute timeout occurs. One way to trigger the AAV module is by selecting option 3 in field 1*46 and make connections as shown in the VOLTAGE TRIGGER diagram. Field 1'`46 can be used to set ground start, remote console sounding, or long range radio open/close trigger. If any one of these functions are absolutely necessary in a given installation, the alternative AAV trigger method is via the use of a 4204 relay as shown in the RELAY TRIGGER diagram. If this method is selected, the start and stop conditions for that relay must be set to choice 60 = "Audio Alarm Verification" during relay programming, via#93 menu mode. —69— Some AAV modules allow remote triggering by ring detection at the alarm installation. Please be advised that if this option is selected, it may defeat modem download and 4285 VIP module remote access capability. The DIP switch settings shown on the triggering diagrams disable remote AAV module trigger option. The control also requires that the AAV module trigger type is falling edge, which is set in DIP switch settings shown. L� � 1. 685 Receiver software must be rev. 4.6 or higher. Earlier versions will not hold �,// the phone line connection. � 2. Contact ID code for "listen-in to follow" is "606." Contact ID is the only reporting format that will send a "listen-in-to-follow." Audio Alarm Verification Module Connections Connect the Audio Alarm Verification module's falling edge trigger input (terminal 5 on Eagle model 1241) to J7 connector trigger output, or to a 4204 relay module, as shown in the various diagrams in Figure 19. L� �l If also using a 4285 VIP Module, be sure to follow the corresponding diagram �� when making connections. Programming Audio Alarm Verification Module Options 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad wired and set to a proper address, temporarily power up the system by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: 1*46 AUXILIARY OUTPUT ENABLE: Set for 3 (unless using 4204 relay module). 1*60 ZONE 5/AUDIO ALARM VERIFICATION: Set for 1. *81 CANCEL REPORT: Set for non-zero digit. *45 PRIMARY DIALER FORMAT: Set for 1 (Contact ID). ����� If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING. 3. Zone 5 must be programmed for response type 10 and the EOLR must be removed. Zone 5 is no longer available as a protection zone. 4. If using a 4204 relay instead of the J7 trigger, program the relay to trip on Zone Type/Sys. Op. 60--Audio Alarm Verification (see SECTION 7: RELAY OUTPUTS AND POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES. 5. Press *99 to exit program mode. 6. Enter[Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. —70— INCOMING TELCO LINE Z o W W W � � c� Notes: RJ31X CALLER 1.Remove any EOL JACK ID UNIT resistor from control panel on zone 5 Q � if any present. � ° m 8-CONDUCTOR DOUBLE PLUG CORD(SUPPLIEDI—► JACK PREMISES CONTROL ANSWERING MACHINE AND PHONES ANSWERIN MACHINE All switches shouid oN be"off°except -► t BBBBBB `� � switCh 5,whiCh 1 2 3 4 5 6 � � should be"on." ° °°° REFER TO � � ° AAV MODULE INSTRUCTIONS � � FOR CONNECTIONS � � TO AUDIO SPEAKERS o � To AND MICROPHONE � � CONTROL 0 � °J ZONE5 _i � ZONE5 a _ _ � � U W (n u� � GRAY --►a w BROWN —�M � 4204 RELAY J o� N MODULE �� � 13 V+ �� 0 14 � 15 GND 16 RELAY 1,SHOWN "OFF" � NO NC C 1 2 3 Figure 19: Audio Alarm Verification Module Connections -71 - • � � � � • • This section provides the following information: • General information about the voltage triggers • Ground Start trigger setup • Open/Close trigger setup • Keyswitch setup • Remote keypad sounder setup • Long Range Radio setup General Information Connector J7, located on the right hand side of the main PCB, provides 4 trigger outputs. These outputs may be configured in a number of ways, depending upon the requirements of the installation. They may be used for: • Operating the 675 Ground Start Module • Operating the 4146 Keyswitch LEDs • Operating a remote piezo sounder that imitates the keypad sounder • Triggering auxiliary alarm signaling equipment (such as the 7720 and 7920SE LORRA Subscriber Radios) • Operating an Audio Alarm Verification (AAV) module (see previous section on AUDIO ALARM VERIF/CATION. L�� These output triggers can be enabled by partition via programming field 2*20. The pin assignments of this connector are shown in Figure 20. Use only the 4142TR 9-wire cable (available as an option) for making connections to this connector. Output 1: Operates, by default, as a trigger for the 675 ground start module. This output may optionally be programmed to operate as an open/close trigger, a remote keypad sounder output, or an AAV module output (programmed in data field 1*46). Only one of these options may be used at a time. Output 1 Rating: When Activated: 10 - 13.8 VDC through 4K ohms When De-activated: 100 ohms to ground Outputs 2 &4: Operates, by default, as Fire and Silent Panic/Duress triggers, respectively. These triggers may optionally be programmed to act as Arm and Ready status indicators when it is desired to use the 4146 keyswitch (programmed in data field *15). Output 2 &4 Rating: When Activated: 10 - 13.8 VDC through 5K ohms When De-activated: 1 k ohms to ground Output 3: Operates as a Burglary/Audible Panic trigger. There are no other options for this output. Output 3 Rating: When Activated: 10-13VDC through 5K ohms When De-activated: 1 k ohms to ground —72— 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 J7 CONNECTOR O N/U z z } � ~ W � � a x J O W O � � � � � m m m 0 0 0 0 J= � J� N J= M J= <r � J � J � J � J C� O C� O C� O C� O 4142TR CABLE OUT 1:GROUND START OR OPEN/CLOSE OUT 2: FIRE OR KEYSWITCH ARMED LED OUT 3:BURGLARY/AUDIBLE PANIC/AUXILIARY OUT 4:SILENT PANIC/DURESS OR KEYSWITCH READY LED Figure 20: J7 Connector For Voltage Triggers -73- Ground Start Trigger Setup U L Not intended for use in UL Listed applications.• Output 1 may be used to trigger an optional 675 Ground Start module for installations having telephone lines which require ground start instead of loop start operation to obtain dial tone from the telco central office. When the panel has a message to transmit to the central station, it will seize the line, go off hook, and then trigger the 675 module to connect the "RING" side of the telephone line to earth ground. The panel will cause the module to break the connection between "RING" and earth ground when it obtains a dial tone. Ground Start Module Connections 1. Connect the 675 Ground Start Module to the panel's J7 connector trigger output 1, to auxiliary power, and to the "RING" side of the telephone line as shown in the diagram below. 2. Use the following procedure to determine which side of the telephone line is the "RING" side: a. Connect the "+" lead of a DC voltmeter to earth ground, and the "-" lead to one side of the telephone line. b. The wire which reads +50VDC is the "RING" side. 4142TR CABLE J7 CONNECTOR ?O� c GROUND START CR�UND GRAY TRIGGER pV N r YELLOW GROUND BLUE � W START GR�UND WHITE MODULE TO AUX.POWER A (CUT ORANGE gLACK TERM.7 �Ur? RED JUMPER) � TO AUX.POWER cR�UNO GREEN TERM.6 � VIOLET �50mA CURRENT DRAW �UT 3 BROWN BROWN GREEN � cR�UNO BLUE TO TELCO TO EARTH IF USED. ao RING GROUND � OUT 1 IS NO LONGER OVT4 USABLE FOR OPEN/CLOSE BLACK (SEE FIELD 1*46). co 2.OUT 2,3,4 CAN STILL BE USED TO PROVIDE ALARM STATUS INDICATIONS OR TO OPERATE A KEYSWITCH (SEE FIELD'15). 3.THE 675 IS NOT UL LISTED. Figure 21. Ground Start Module Connections Programming For The Ground Start Module 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data field: 1*46 AUXILIARY OUTPUT ENABLE: Set to"0" (factory default) 3. Press*99 to exit program mode. L� � 1. If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see �� Section 4: THE MECHAN/CS OF PROGRAMMING. 2. You cannot use Output 1 for an Ground Start if using it for a Remote Keypad Sounder, Open/Close trigger, or an AAV module. —74— Open/Close Trigger Setup Output 1 may alternately be programmed to change states when the system is armed in the away mode and then disarmed. If field 1*46 is set to 1, the output will be set high when the system is in the "disarmed" state, and will switch to "0" volts when the system is armed in the "away" mode. This trigger will not change state unless all partitions are armed, and will change state again as soon as one partition is disarmed. Programming the Open/Close Trigger 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data field: 1*46 AUXILIARY OUTPUT ENABLE: Set for 1. 1. If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see G���� Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMM/NG. 2. You cannot use Output 1 for an Open/Close trigger if using it for a Remote Keypad Sounder, Ground Start module, or AAV module. Remote Keypad Sounder Output 1 may alternately be programmed for a remote keypad sounder. You may use an Amseco PAL 328N for installations where you want the sounds produced by the keypad's built-in piezo sounder to be duplicated in another location for one partition. The panel will send all sounds remotely (i.e. alarm, trouble, chime, entry/exit, etc.) except for the short clicks associated with keypad key depression. One application of this feature might be to produce chime sounds in a location which is distant from the panel's keypads. You can also accomplish this by using relay outputs (see SECTION 7: RELAY OUTPUTS AND POWERLINE CARRIER DEVICES). Remote Keypad Sounder Connections • Connect the Amseco piezo between the panel's auxiliary power and the J7 connector trigger output as shown below. IF USED. 4142TR CABLE J7 CONNECTOR 1.OUT 1 IS NO LONGER USABLE FOR OPEN/CLOSE Z O� OR GROUND START(SEE � FIELD 1*46). GR�U�VD GRAY 2.OUT 2,3,4 CAN STILL BE USED TO PROVIDE ALARM N STATUS INDICATIONS OR �UT� YELLOW TO OPERATE A KEYSWITCH BLACK (SEE FIELD*15). W GR��ND WHITE A AMSECO PAL-328N �uT 2 RED PIEZO SOUNDER cr, + GR��ND GREEN rn TO AUX POWER+ O�T 3 TERMINAL 6 RED BROwN (10mA CURRENT DRAW) G J R��ND BLUE � OVT4 BLACK � Figure 22. Remote Keypad Sounding Connections —75— Programming Remote Keypad Sounding Options 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: 1*46 AUXILIARY OUTPUT ENABLE: Set for 2. *15 KEYSWITCH ASSIGNMENT,: Enter the partition whose keypad sounds are to be dupliocated at the remote sounder. 3. Press*99 to exit program mode. The system automatically assigns Zone Type 10 to Zone 7, whether or not a keyswitch is actually used. Therefore, Zone 7 is no longer available as a protection zone, but is assigned as a keyswitch zone. L� � 1. If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see �� Section 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING. 2. You cannot use Output 1 for a Remote Keypad Sounder if using it for an Open/Close trigger, Ground Start module, or AAV module. Keyswitch Setup If using an optional Remote Keyswitch for remote arming and disarming of the system, its switch must be connected to Zone 7 and its Ready and Armed status LEDs must be connected to the trigger outputs and programmed in order to become operational. L� ,� Note that a keyswitch may be used in one partition only. � Keyswitch Operation The keyswitch must be connected to Zone 7, which is then no longer available as a protection zone. A momentary short across this zone will arm the partition in the "AWAY" mode. If the short is held for more than 3 seconds, the partition will arm in the "STAY" mode. After the partition has been armed, the next time Zone 7 is shorted, the partition will disarm. Keyswitch Connections 1. Connect the 4146 keyswitch's normally open momentary switch to Zone 7 2. Connect a 2k EOL resistor across the switch regardless of whether or not zones 2-8 are selected to use EOL resistors. See diagram below. —76— TO AUX POWER�.... ...............Q...................Q (TERMINAL 6) NOTE: The tamper switch need not be YELLOW WHITE used for UL Household Fire or RED GREEN Burglary installations. The (ARMED) � (READY) � tamper switch must be connected to an EOLR supervised zone programmed s2oonms a2oonms for trouble by day/alarm by RED BLACK night(type 05)response as shown for UL Commercial TOJ7/OUT2 ��••• •••••••••••�••••� : Burglaryinstallations. TOJ7/OUT4 ����� ���������������������������������������� When the keyswitch is 2K EOLR removed from the wall,the TOZONE6(+) ����� ����������������������/�/�����������: tamperswitchwill open causing (TERMINAL 18) TAMPER SWITCH (CONTACTS CLOSE WHEN a fault(trouble or alarm)on SWITCH DEPRESSED.SEE NOTE) : ZOIl2 6 811d C2USIIlg th2 p8n21 � � to disable keyswitch operation TOZONE6(-)/ZONE7(-) �•�•••�•�•••••�•�p �b (TERMINAL 19) BROWN sROwN: until the partition is disarmed LOCK SWITCH from a console. (NORMALLY OPEN) TO ZONE 7(+) �.... .......... B�� B�O (TERMINAL 20) • ^nn ..........V V V " .........: 2K EOLR BROKEN LINES REPRESENT INSTALLER WIRING CONNECTIONS Figure 23. Remote Keyswitch Wiring 3. Connect the keyswitch Armed and Ready LEDs to the trigger connector as shown in Figure 23. Programming The Remote Keyswitch 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet (previously wired to the control). 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: *15 KEYSWITCH ASSIGNMENT for the partition in which the keyswitch is used. *40 OPEN/CLOSE REPORTING FOR KEYSWITCH as desired. The keyswitch reports as user"0." L� The system automatically assigns Zone Type 10 to Zone 7 if a keyswitch is enabled. 3. Press*99 to exit program mode.. L�� If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section � 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING. LED indications are defined as follows: Green Red Meanin Off Off Disarmed & Not Read On Off Disarmed & Read Off On Stead Armed Awa Off Slow Flash Armed Sta Off Rapid Flash Alarm Memory —77— Auxiliary Alarm Signaling Equipment (Long Range Radio) The J7 header provides triggers for fire alarm, burglary/audible panic alarm, silent/duress alarm.. These triggers are programmed as the defaults for Outputs, 2, 3, and 4. These may be used to trip auxiliary alarm signaling equipment such as Ademco's 7720 and 7920SE Long Range Radios. L���� The triggers for Fire (Output 2) and Silent Panic/Duress (Outpu*4) may be used to operate keyswitch armed and ready LEDs instead when field 15 is enabled. When used as alarm triggers, these outputs are normally low, and go high when the corresponding alarm condition occurs. These triggers remain high until the security code + OFF is entered at the keypad, with the exception of the Silent Panic/Duress trigger, which is a 2-second pulse. The diagrams that follow show how to make connections to the 7720 and 7920SE radios. Refer to the UL Installation Requirements found in the REGULATORY AGENCY REQUIREMENTS section for a description of the specific connections and programming options required for each of the various UL Listings. When a Long Range Radio is installed, configure the sense select for zones 1 and 2 in the Long Range Radio to activate on +5V (positive trigger). This is necessary to prevent false alarms from occurring. Refer to the installation instructions provided with your radio for instructions on setting the zone 1 and 2 levels. 1]20RADI0 SEE77201NST.INSTRFOR INSTRUCTIONS ON POWERING UNIT �► FAULT 1 2 3 4 5 6 ] 8 9 10 wsrn-soaoavisrn-saPU� 66A6 66A66 7720WIRING (USEVISTA-50Pl1LFORl1LLISTE� q�q2TRCA8LE COMMERCIALBl1RGLARYINSTALLATI0N5) � cNO icanv� Bl1RG�PlI�IBLEPANIC (HROWN�REQUIRE� SILENTPANICI�URE55 BLACK OPTIONAL �� • FlRE (RE� OPTIONAL 28 29 30 TO C-COM SEE NOTE 2 �010 FAULT OUTPUT —AUX PWR IPROCRnM FOa sHORT ON FaU�T) NoTES�. — (35mA DRAW) FOR UL�ISTE�COMMERCIFL BURGLARY INSTALLATIONS�. ] BLACK 1.MOt1NT THE]�20 WITHIN 3 fEET OF THE 659EN LINE FAULT MONITOR C-COM.Rl1N WIRING FROM C-COM T07720 —{fi REO W CON�IIIT ORANGE *�ZV GNO � 2.CONNECTRADIOFAULTOUTPl1TTOGCOM EOLRSUPERVISEDZONE�ZONE2-BONLY). VELLOW FAl1LT USE2KEOLR. GREEN 1 2 3 4 5 6 ] 8 3.SEEULINSTALLATIONRE�UIREMENTSONA USAGEIS REQU REDERMME WHEN 659EN eAA 4.GONNEGTTO GCOA4 EOLR SUPERVISE� ZONE jZONE 2-8 ONLY)WHEN�ESIRE�TO PNONE LINE MONITOR HAVEPANELLOGALLVANNUNGIATEPNONE SEE PHONELINEMONITOR �OPENSONfAl1LT) LMEFAl1LTS. NOTE4 (+12VONFAUL� REQUIRED OPTIONAL INCOMINGPHONELINE 192aSE RAOIO SEE 1920SE INST INSTR.FOR CONNECT EARTHGROUND INSTRUCTIONSONPOWERINGUNIT TOC-COM CABINETGROUNO �scRewRasoj TB1 AA6AAAA666 , z s a s s � a s�o 1 2 3 4 5 6 ] 8 9 10 VISTA-SOORVISTA-SOUL TB2 AAAeAAeAAA 7920SEWIRING �USEVISTA-SOULFORULLISTEO qiq2TftCABLE COMMERCIALBl1RGLARYINSTNLLATI0N5) � GND(GRAV) FIRE (RE�J OPTIONAL' SILENTPANICi�URE55 (BLACK)OPTIONAL �� •��'��• BURG;Fl1�IBLEPANIC (BROWN�REQUIRE� 28 29 30 4]K(NOT SUPPLIE�) TO GCOM RA010 OK OUTPl1T r AUX PWR sEE NOiE 2 NOTES'. -z A �35mA�RAW) NowoNFnu�T� FOR UL LISTED COMMERCIAL BURGLARY INSTALLATIONS'. ] BLAGK 1.MOUNTTHE]9205EWITHIN3FEEfOFTHE �6 REO 659ENLINEFAULTMONITOR GGOM.Rl1N WIRING FROM C-COM TO ]9205EINCONOUIi OR4NGE '�ZVGND � 2.CONNECTRA�IOOKOU7Pl1TTOCCOM EOLRSUPERVISE�ZONE�ZONE2-70NLV�. VELLOW FAl1LT USE 2K EOLR. 3.SEEl1LINSTALLATIONREQUIREMENT50NA GREEN 1 2 3 4 5 6 ] 8 USAGEIS REQUIREDERMME WHEN fi59EN AAA 4.CONNECTTO C-COM EOLR SUPERVISED ZONE�ZONE 2-8 ONLY)WHEN DESIRE�TO PHONE LINE MONITOR HAVEPANELLOCALLYANNUNGIATEPHONE SEE PHONELINEMONITOR (OPENSONFAULT) LINE FAULTS. NOTE4 (t12V ON FAULTJ FEQUIFE� OPTIONAL INGOMINGPHONELINE Figure 24: Auxiliary Alarm Signalling Equipment —78— • ' � • � ' This section provides the following information: • General information about external sounders • Connecting external sounders for UL and non-UL applications • Programming options for external sounders • Compatible sounders General Information The Control provides one bell relay output used to power external alarm sounders. This output is rated at 10-13.8VDC, 2.8A maximum (including auxiliary current draw)., Exceeding the prescribed current limits will overload the power supply or may � possibly trip the bell output circuit protector. Wiring 1. Make connections to terminals 4 (positive output)and 5 (negative return). 000+9 �_000 ALARM SOUNDER OUTPUT 10VDC-13.8 VDC 2.8A maximum BELL + SIREN Figure 25. External Sounder Connections UL985 Household Fire Installations For installations which must provide UL Listed protection, the total current drawn from this output and the auxiliary power output, combined, must not exceed 750mA in order to comply with the battery independence requirements in UL985. If two System Sensor PA400 piezo alarm sounders, wired in parallel, are used (24mA total), then (750mA—24mA=) 726mA is available for auxiliary output use. —79— UL1023 Household & UL609 Commercial Burglary Installations For installations which must provide only UL Listed burglary protection, the total current drawn from this output must not exceed 2.8 amps. A battery must be installed since current in excess of 750mA is supplied by the battery. Use any UL Listed sounding device for UL Household Burglary installations. Use the Ademco AB12 Grade A bell in box for UL Commercial Burglary installations. The AB12 bell should be wired as shown in Figure 26. AB12 WIRING NOTES: •Program the zone which moni- tors AB12 tamper for day irou- A812 BELUBOX WIRING ble/night alarm(type OS)or 24 hour audible alarm(type 07) response.A 24 hr.alarm m� ^'�o 0 o response must be used in mul- �?� �D o o tiple partition systems. �m �� m m Zk EOLR .Wire the VISTA 50-UL door ZN rn tamper switch in series with �W n� � � the A612 tamper zone. m m + i A� •Program bell output for 16 or more minute timeout and for � , confrmation of arming ding. j j •All wiring from AB12 to panel �1 2 3 4 5 6 i must be run in conduit. i i i i � � AB12 OUTER BOX i TAMPER i i � SWITCHES � INNER LINER i i i BEl i i q i L J Figure 26: AB 12 Bell Box Wiring Non-UL Installations For non-UL installations, the total current drawn from this output can be up to 2.8 amps. A battery must be installed since current in excess of 750mA is supplied by the battery. Up to two 702 sirens can be used, wired in series. Up to two 719 sirens can be used wired in parallel. Programming External Sounders 1. With at least one two-line alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, temporarily power up the system by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet.. 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: *13 ALARM SOUNDER DURATION (partition-specific; can vary from one partition to another) *18 UL AC LOSS SIREN (1=yes; 0=no) *21 PREVENT FIRE TIMEOUT (1=no timeout; 0=fire timeout) *23 MULTIPLE ALARMS (partition-specific) 1*47 CHIME ON EXTERNAL SIREN (partition-specific) 3. Press *99 to exit program mode. Then enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. L� /�,- If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section � 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING. —80— Compatible Sounders U L Use only UL Listed sounding devices for UL installations. 702 Outdoor Siren Self-contained siren (driver built-in) and (not UL Listed) weatherproof for outdoor use. Can be wired for either a steady or yelp sound and is rated at 120 dB @ 10 feet. This siren can also be tamper protected, or can be mounted in a metal cabinet (716), which can be tamper protected. 719 Compact Outdoor Compact, self-contained siren (driver Siren (not UL Listed) built-in), and weatherproof for outdoor use. Can be wired for either a steady or yelp sound, and is rated at 90 dB @ 10 feet. A 708BE cabinet is available, which can be tamper protected if necessary. 740 High Intensity Compact high intensity sounder rated at Sounder 123 dB @ 10 feet. This sounder emits an 'ear piercing", high frequency sound. This sounder can be mounted indoors (bracket included) or outdoors (in 708BE cabinet). 747 Indoor Siren Attractive, self-contained indoor siren (driver built-in), provides steady or warble tones and is rated at 95dB @ 10 feet. ABB1031 Motor Bell 8� Box AMSECO motor bell & box, rated at 81 dB @ 10 feet. PA400B Indoor Piezo Sounder System Sensor indoor piezo sounder. (beige) PA400R (red) (red or beige), rated at 90 dB @ 10 feet. AB12 Grade A Bell For UL Commercial Burglary installations. —81 — • � • • ' • This section provides the following information: • General information about the Event Log • Event Log printer connections • Programming Event Log options • Displaying/Printing the Event Log General Information This system has the ability to record up to 224 events of various types in a history log (224 event capacity). Each event is recorded in one of five categories with the time and date of its occurrence (if real-time clock is set). These categories are: • Alarm • Supervisory/check • Bypass • Open/close • System conditions The log may be viewed (Display Mode) on an alpha keypad, or can be printed (Print Mode) on a serial printer (connected to the system via a 4100SM serial interface module. Event Log Printer Connections • Connector J8, located above connector J7 on the right side of the main PC board, is intended to be connected to a local serial printer via the 4100SM serial interface module, in applications where you want to print the event log on a local printer. U L A UL Listed EDP printer must be used for UL installations. • Mount the 4100SM using its clip bracket to attach it to the side wall of the control cabinet. Make connections between J8, the 4100SM module and the serial printer as shown in Figure 27. Refer to the event logging commands paragraph for a description of the commands which initiate event log printing. �� �� 3 4 5 6 8 9 O O O O O O O O O �$CONNECTOR N� 0 0 3 �J=o J= �' m J2o J=o Sp�O 2 �P� O O �Q' �Q'� 4142TR CABLE(SUPPLIEO WITH 4100SM) 4100SM SERIAL MODULE To TB6 Aux.Power(+) O�pWR (25mA current tlraw) To TB]Aux.Power(-) 1 -(GND) 6 RXD Onotused Onotused Onotusetl Onotusetl O OTR 41005M JUMPERS 6 d 6 (CUTTO SET RESPECTIVE SIGNAL FLOATING) REO BLUE WHITE COLOR FUNCTION PIN# RED C� 8 BLUE CTS 5 WHITE DSR 6 USE GENDER CHANGER 3M SUPPLIED WITH 41005M Cable IF PRINTER HAS DB25 Supplled with MALECONNECTOR 41005M SERIAL PRINTER SET FOR'.8 OATA BRS NO PARITI'1 STOP BIT onzao snuo HnaowaaEHnnosHnKE usw�ora sicNn� Figure 27. Event Log Printer Connections NOTES —82— 1. Printer must be configured as follows: • 8 data bits, no parity, 1 stop bit • 300 or 1200 baud (1200 preferred) • Hardware handshaking using DTR signal 2 The 4100SM module package includes a 10 foot RS232 cable. You can use a longer cable or an extension cable if the Control and serial printer are separated by more than 10 feet. The total cable length should be less than 50 feet. 3. Most printers either ignore the CTS, DSR and CD signals, or require them to be high (i.e. 3-15VDC as measured on RS232 DB25 connector pins 5, 6 & 8 respectively with respect to ground pin 7). The 4100SM module sets these pins high. If the printer being used will not operate with these pins high, then clip the blue (CTS), white (DSR) or red (CD)jumpers on the 4100SM module to set the corresponding signal floating. Important pins on the RS232C cable are pin 3 (data out), pin 7 (ground) and pin 20 (DTR- ready). 4. The DTR signal, as measured at 4100SM TB1, should be high (9.5-14VDC) when the printer is powered, properly connected, on-line and ready to print. This signal will be low (0-1.5VDC)when the printer is not powered, not properly connected, off-line or out of paper. The Control will not send data to the printer unless the DTR signal is high. Programming Event Log Options 1. With at least one alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and set to a proper address, power up the system temporarily by plugging the AC transformer into a 120VAC outlet(previously wired to the control. 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: 1*70 EVENT LOG TYPES (1=enable; 0=disable for each type) 1*71 12/24 HOUR TIME STAMP FORMAT (0=12hr; 1=24hr) 1*72 EVENT LOG PRINTER ON-LINE (0=disable; 1=enable) 1*73 PRINTER BAUD RATE (1=300; 0=1200) 1*40 and 1*41 REPORT CODES FOR EVENT LOG 3. Exit program mode by pressing *99. L� /�j, If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section �� 4: THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMM/NG. Event Logging Procedures L� ,� In order for proper time and date stamping to occur, the system's real-time clock � must be set. Refer to the SETTING THE REAL TIME CLOCK section. If you have selected the printer to be "on-line" (field 1*72), events will print automatically, as they occur. To display or print on demand, the following commands apply: Commands Display Mode: installer or master code + [#] + [6] + [0] Print Mode: installer or master code + [#] + [6] + [1] Clear Event Log: installer or master code+ [#] + [6] + [2] To EXIT Event Log: Press � at any time. —83— Display/Printing: After entering either the Display or Print mode, the following will be displayed: �EMERO=REC�M" The Event Log holds up to 224 events, and can display �_ppNp�� � or print all events in a category (complete), or only those events in a category occurring since the last Clear Event Log command (recent). Note that once the Event Log is full, the oldest event will be erased upon the logging of any new event. Press the desired display mode key, 0 or 1. �SCAN LOG BY PART The system allows viewing of any partition's event �o-NO 1-8-PART# log. Enter the partition number for the partition - whose events are to be displayed. Entering 0 (NO) will display all events that occurred in the system regardless of partition. Events are displayed in chronological order, from most recent to oldest. For display and printing purposes, events are stored on a partition by partition basis (except system events), and are grouped into five categories as fol lows. Use the [3] 8� [1] keys to scroll to the next and previous screens respectively: �ALARM EVENT LOG Displays time/date for zones that have either caused TYPECCC UUU � an alarm or have been restored in selected partition. �CHECK EVENT LOG � Displays time/date for zones that have caused a TYPECCC UUU !� trouble or supervisory condition in selected partition. �BYPASS EVENT LOG Displays time/date for zones that have been TYPECCC UUU � bypassed in selected partition. OP/CL EVENT LOG �, Displays time, date and user number for each TYPECCC UUU j arming and disarming of the system for the partition ` selected. SYSTEMEVENTLOG Displays time/date for system problems, such as AC �ypE�� I Loss, communication failure, etc., regardless of partition. IIALL EVENT LOG I Displays all categories of events in chronological �TYPECCC UUU ' order, from most recent to oldest. To display the events in a particular category, press [8] at the desired category screen. If in Display Mode, the most recent event is displayed. Press [1] to display older events, press [3] to go forward in time. If in Print Mode, the first press of[8]will cause the printer to print all events in that category, with each event automatically scrolled on the display keypad. The following is a typical display: �P8 01/01 12:02AM�'i Shows burglary alarm occurred in zone 3 of partition �BURGLARY CO3_' $, at 12:02AM on January 1. After the last event in the selected category has been displayed (using either the [1] or[3] keys), the following will appear for a few seconds: END OF EVENT LOG TYPECCC UUU -84- �CLEAR EVENT LOG � Press [1] if Event Log is to be cleared from memory. 0-NO 1-YES All events in the log will still be displayed if the COMPLETE option is selected. Only those events occurring from the time of the CLEAR command will be displayed if RECENT display option is selected. Press [0] if event log is not to be cleared at this time. If[1] is pressed, the following will appear: �ARE YOU SURE? I Press [1] if it is desired to clear the event log. Press �0-NO 1-YES I [0] if event log is not to be cleared. SCREEN DEFINITIONS RECENT Events since last CLEAR COMPLETE Displays all events TYPE Type of event (Burg., Fire, etc.) CCC Zone (contact) number UUU User number -85- • � ' • ' ' " • � ' This section provides the following information: • Earth ground considerations • Connecting the AC transformer • Connecting the backup battery • Programming power and AC options • Auxiliary and Polling Loop Current Draw Worksheets General Information • You can power the control from the supplied 1361 transformer(1361 CN in Canada), rated 16.5VAC, 40VA, which plugs directly into a 24 hour, 120VAC, 60 Hz outlet. • If using power line carrier devices, you must use the 4300 transformer instead. U L Use 1361 CN Transformer in Canadian installations. Earth Ground Considerations In order for the lightning transient protective devices in this product to be effective, the designated earth ground terminal (terminal 30), must be terminated in a good earth ground. We recommend using #16 AWG copper wire run at a maximum length of 25 ft. The following are examples of good earth grounds available at most installations: • Metal Cold Water Pipe: Use a non-corrosive metal strap (copper is recommended) firmly secured to the pipe to which the ground lead is electrically connected and secured. • AC Power Outlet Ground: Available from 3-prong, 120VAC, power outlets only. To test the integrity of the ground terminal, use a three-wire circuit tester with neon lamp indicators, such as the UL-Listed Ideal Model 61-035, or equivalent, available at most electrical supply stores. Connecting the Transformer 1. Use the Polling Loop Current Draw and Auxiliary Device Current Draw Worksheets found later in this section to make sure that the currents drawn from the devices connected to the system do not exceed the system's respective ratings. Failure to observe the polling loop current rating will cause polling loop � malfunction. Failure to observe the auxiliary output current rating will result in a • battery which does not charge properly or possibly a tripped circuit breaker. 2. Connect all installed devices to the control. 3. Wire the 1361 transformer (1361 CN in Canada) to the panel (before connecting the battery) as shown in Figure 28, or wire the 4300 transformer as shown in Figure 29(if using Powerline Carrier devices). 4. Plug the transformer into a 24 hour, uninterrupted, 120VAC, 60Hz outlet. After a few seconds, the keypad display will appear. —86— PRIMARY POWER BATTERY Supplied by 1361` TABS + Plug-In Connect ro ❑ � Transformer which 12VDC,4AH � or 12VDC,7AH is rated at (� (2� n 16.5VAC,4OVA. GEL CELL �� �- �- �- BATTERY Caution must be � —� CHARGING m taken when wiring VOLTAGE this transformer to �3.7 VDC _ the panel to guard Replace 2 h�n120VAC, � against blowing the 3eyears 60 Hz Outlet � fuse inside the z z transformer(non- o replaceable). TRaNSFORnnER o 16.5VAC,40VA ADEMCO No.136� (IN CANADA USE No.1361CN) or 4300 IF X-�0 OEVICES WILL BE USED ��� NOTE: WHEN POWERING UP THE PANEL,PWG THE TRANSFORMER IN BEFORE CONNECTING THE BATTERY. Figure 28. 1321 Transformer and Batfery Connections 4300 TRANSFORMER/INTERFACE � � 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 JBCONNECTOR O Earth w Q O ~ O W O � Q AC Ground AC Sync Data Com O � w = w � K 1 2 3 4 O5 6 > � > � � � m m m O O O J`� h c J`� J� 2 �' o % ? �� OJ oJ.l��O��0 4142TR CABLE 7B1 761 7B1 1 30 2 Figure 29: 4300 Transformer Connections -87- Programming Power and AC Options 1. With at least one alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) wired and properly addressed, power up the system. 2. Enter data field programming mode: [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Program the following data fields: *17 AC POWER LOSS KEYPAD SOUNDING (1=yes; 0=no) *18 AC POWER LOSS EXTERNAL ALARM (1=yes; 0=no) *19 AC RANDOMIZE (1=randomize; 0=no) *28 POWER UP IN PREVIOUS STATE (1=yes; 0=no) 3. Exit program mode by entering *99. L� � If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section_ �,// 4: THE MECHAN/CS OF PROGRAMMING. � Polling Loop Current Draw Worksheet DEVICE CURRENT #UNITS TOTAL CURRENT STANDBY ALARM 4194 Contact 1 mA 4191 SN 1 mA 4193SN 1.5mA 4939SN 1 mA 4959SN 1 mA 4192SD Photo Smoke 0.4 mA 4192SDT Smoke w/Heat 0.4 mA 4192CP lon Smoke 0.4 mA 4275 Dual PIR 1 mA 4278 Quad PIR 1 mA 4190 2-Zone RPM 1 mA(LOW) 2 mA(HIGH) 4208 8-Zone RPM 16 mA TOTAL** �` If the total current draw exceeds 64 mA, a 4197 Loop Extender module must be used. Auxiliary Device Current Draw Worksheet DEVICE CURRENT #UNITS TOTAL CURRENT STANDBY ALARM 4137AD Keypad 60mA 5137AD Keypad 90 mA 6128 Keypad 30 mA 6137 Keypad 85mA 6139 Keypad 100mA 675 Ground Start Module 50 mA Built-in Polling Loop (total poll loop worksht) 4281 RF Receiver 35mA 5881 RF Receiver 50mA 4197 Poll Loop Extender 80 mAt 4204 Relay Module 15mA standby 40mA per active relay TOTAL * If using hard-wire devices such as PIRs, refer to the specifications for that particular unit's current draw. Alarm Output Current Draw Worksheet DEVICE CURRENT #UNITS TOTAL ALARM CURRENT TOTAL** —88— Combined Auxiliary Power, Alarm Output and Polling Loop Total Current Standby Alarm Auxiliary Power Alarm Output Polling Loop TOTAL Battery Calculation Worksheet Capacity Formula Calculated Value Standby Capacity total standby load X 24 or 60 hours X 1.1 contingency factor(use total standby load from previous worksheet) Alarm Capacity total alarm load X 0.067 hours(4 minutes) (use total alarm load from previous worksheet) Total Capacity Add standby and alarm capacities BATTERY SELECTION TABLE 4 AH Yuasa NP4-12 7 AH Yuasa NP7-12 12 AH Yuasa NP12-12 BATTERY STANDBY TABLE AUX. STANDBY CURRENT DRAW AMP-HRS. 200mA 400mA 600mA 750mA 4.0 6 hrs. 4 hrs. 3 hrs. 2.5 hrs. 6.0-7.0 11 hrs. 7 hrs. 5.5 hrs. 4 hrs. NOTE: These figures are approximate, and may vary depending upon the age, quality, and capacity of the battery at the time of the AC loss. Connecting The Battery In the event of an AC power loss, the Control panel will still operate for a period of time (time period varies depending on size of battery used) because the control has a back-up, rechargeable gel type (sealed) lead acid battery. YUASA NP4-12 (12V, 4AH) and NP7-12 (12V, 7AH) batteries are recommended. DO NOT use Gates batteries (sealed lead-acid type). These batteries require a � different charging voltage than is supplied by the panel. . \ The standby battery is automatically tested every 24 hours, beginning 24 hours after exiting programming mode. In addition, entry into the test mode will cause a battery test to be initiated. 1. Use the Battery Standby Table to select the appropriate battery for the installation. U L The VISTA-50UL must operate for at least 4 hours following an AC power loss in certificated burglary installations. Select a battery size from the table below that will support the auxiliary power output current draw for 4 or more hours. 2. Connect the battery as shown in Figure 28. Do not connect the battery until all devices have been wired to the control. —89— • � � � � . . � � � . This section provides the following information: • General information about false alarms • Exit Error Logic and related reports • Exit Delay Reset • Cross-Zoning • Call Waiting Defeat General Information This control supports features which help minimize false alarms from occurring. Most false alarms occur either upon exiting the premises, or because of a zone which tends to go into alarm either due to environmental factors, or because the zone's resistance to the control may be on the edge of acceptability. We call this condition a "swinger." Features which prevent false alarms due to these circumstances are: • Exit Error Logic and related reports • Exit Delay Reset • Cross-Zoning Exit Error Logic This feature is intended to reduce the incidence of false alarms due to exit doors that are left open after the exit delay has expired. If this feature is enabled in program field 1*20, the following will occur: At the end of the exit delay, if the door is left open, the system will sound the bell(s),siren(s) and the console sounder(s) for 10 seconds. It will then start the entry delay period. This gives the user time to re-enter the premises and disarm the system before an alarm occurs. If the user does not re-enter the premises and disarm the system, the system will bypass the faulted entry/exit zone(s). The rest of the system will be armed. In addition, the following dialer reports will be sent to the central station if programmed: • Exit Error by User • Exit Error by Zone • Bypass reports Another report, designed to notify the central station that an alarm has occurred within five minutes of arming, is called the Recent Close report. This report, as well as the Exit Error reports, are programmed in data fields 1*40 and 1*41. Exit Delay Reset This feature is designed to allow an operator to re-exit the premises to retrieve a forgotten item without triggering an alarm. This feature is enabled in program field 1*21, and works in the following way: When the panel is armed, the normal exit delay begins. After the user exits, and the door closes, the exit delay time is reset to 60 seconds. If, within this 60 second period, the entry door is re-opened, the panel will restart the exit delay sequence again using the programmed exit delay time. This feature will only be activated once after arming. —90— Cross-Zoning The Cross-Zoning feature is designed so that a combination of two zones must be faulted within a five minute period to cause an alarm on either zone. This prevents momentary faults from causing an alarm condition. You can select four "sets" of cross zones, keeping in mind the following: • Both must protect the same area • Both must be in the same partition • A Fire zone must only be crossed to another fire zone protecting the same physical area (see note below) The four sets of cross-zones are programmed in data fields 1*22, 1*23, 1*24, and 1*25. DO NOT cross-zone a fire zone with a burglary zone under any circumstance. A � fire zone must only be crossed to another fire zone and BOTH must be protecting • the same physical area (no walls or partitions separating them). Consult NFPA 72 standard for exact spacing requirements. As a guideline, we recommend that spacing between fire cross-zones be no further than 30 ft. Conditions That Affect Cross-Zone Operation 1. In the event of a continuous fault on one of the paired zones that lasts longer than five minutes, a fault on the second zone will cause an alarm immediately. 2. If one of the zones in a pair is bypassed or has a zone response type set to 0, the cross-zoning feature will not apply, 3. If an Entry/Exit zone is paired with an Interior Follower zone, be sure to enter the Entry/Exit zone as the first zone of the pair. This will ensure that the entry delay time is started before the follower zone is processed. 4 a. If a relay is programmed to activate on a fault of one of the zones, the relay will activate without the other zone being faulted. b. If a relay is programmed to activate on either an alarm or trouble, both zones must trip before the relay will activate, and both zones must restore for the relay to deactivate (if relay is programmed to deactivate on a Zone List Restore). Call Waiting Defeat Logic Although this option does not directly prevent false alarms, it may prevent the central station from taking action on a potential false alarm. After the panel's initial call to report the alarm, if the panel attempts to make an additional call, perhaps for a cancel or a zone restoral, an operator at the central station attempting to contact the premises to verify whether or not the alarm is valid will hear the phone ringing indefinitely and will have to dispatch on the call. This option, enabled in program field 1*42, will attempt to defeat call waiting on the first out-going call attempt to both the primary and secondary numbers. It does this by dialing a special sequence preceding the phone number (but after the PABX number). The panel will dial *70 if using touchtone and 1170 if using rotary. L� � The panel does not attempt to defeat call waiting on each call attempt, since the � phone company may not complete the call if the sequence is dialed on a phone line that does not have call waitin . —91 — • • ' � • This section provides the following information: • Zone number designations • Zone Type Definitions The VISTA 50 supports up to 86 zones of hard-wire, polling loop and/or wireless protection, distributed among up to 8 partitions. The following table lists the zone numbers and the types of sensors that can be used with each in this system: Zone Sensors 1 2-wire smoke detectors (if used) 7 keyswitch (if used) 8 latching type glass break detectors (if used) 1-9 traditional hard-wired zones 1-63 5700 series wireless devices 1-86 5800 series wireless devices 10-86 polling loop devices 95 */1 panic 96 #/3 panic 99 */#panic Each zone must be assigned a zone type, which defines the way in which the system responds to faults in that zone. In addition, there are three keypad activated zones (PANIC keys, see note) for each partition, a polling loop supervision zone, and four RF supervisory zones, two for each RF Receiver installed. Zone types are defined below. Type 00: Zone Not Used Type 03: Perimeter Burglary. Program a zone with this zone type if the zone is not This zone type gives an instant alarm if the zone is used. faulted when the panel is armed in the Away, Stay, Instant or Maximum modes. This zone type is usually Type 01: Entry/Exit#1 Burglary. assigned to all sensors or contacts on exterior doors This zone type provides entry delay whenever the and windows. zone is faulted if the control is armed in the Away or Stay modes. When the panel is armed in the Instant or Type 04: Interior, Follower. Maximum modes, no entry delay is provided. Exit delay This zone type gives a delayed alarm (using the begins whenever the control is armed, regardless of programmed Entry /Exit time) if the Entry/Exit zone is the arming mode selected. These delays are faulted first. Otherwise this zone type gives an instant programmable. This zone type is usually assigned to alarm. This zone type is active when the panel is sensors or contacts on doors through which primary armed in the Away or Maximum modes. Maximum entry and exit will take place. mode eliminates the entry delay. This zone type is bypassed automatically when the panel is armed in Type 02: Entry/Exit#2 Burglary. the Stay or Instant modes. This zone type is usually This zone type provides a secondary entry delay assigned to a zone covering an area such as a foyer, whenever the zone is faulted if the panel is armed in lobby, or hallway through which one must pass upon the Away and Stay modes. When the panel is armed in entry or exit(After faulting the entry/exit zone to reach the Instant or Maximum modes, no entry delay is the keypad to disarm the system.) Since this zone provided. Secondary exit delay begins whenever the type is designed to provide an instant alarm if the control is armed, regardless of the arming mode entry/exit zone is not violated first, it will protect an selected. These delays are programmable. This zone area in the event an intruder hides on the premises type is usually assigned to sensors or contacts on prior to the system being armed, or gains access to the doors through which more time is needed to get to and premises through an unprotected area. from the keypad. Delay times for this zone type must be greater than Zone Type 01. (Ex.: a garage, loading dock, or basement door) —92— Type 05: Trouble by Day/Alarm by Night. Type 10 : Interior w/Delay. This zone type will give an instant alarm if faulted when This zone type gives entry and exit delays (using the armed in the Away, Stay, Instant or Maximum (night) programmed entry/exit time), if tripped when the panel modes. During the disarmed state (day), the system will is armed in the Away mode. This zone type is also provide a latched trouble sounding from the keypad active during Maximum mode, but no entry delay is (and a central station report, if desired). This zone type provided (alarms occur immediately if zone is tripped). is usually assigned to a zone which contains a foil- This zone type is bypassed when the panel is armed protected door or window (such as in a store), or to a in the Stay or Instant modes. Delay begins whenever zone covering a "sensitive" area such as a stock room, sensors in this zone are violated, regardless of whether drug supply room, etc. This zone type can also be used or not an entry/exit delay zone was tripped first. on a sensor or contact in an area where immediate notification of an entry is desired. Type 20: Arm-Stay* This is a special purpose zone type used with 5800 Type 06: 24-hour Silent Alarm. series wireless pushbutton or contact closure or This zone type sends a report to the Central Station but opening, and which will result in arming the system in provides no keypad display or sounding. This zone type the STAY mode when the zone is activated. is usually assigned to a zone containing an Emergency button. Type 21: Arm-Away* This is a special purpose zone type used with 5800 Type 07: 24-hour Audible Alarm. series wireless pushbutton or contact closure or This zone type sends a report to the Central Station, opening, and which will result in arming the system in and provides an alarm sound at the keypad, and an the AWAY mode when the zone is activated. audible external alarm. This zone type is usually assigned to a zone that has an Emergency button. Type 22: Disarm* This is a special purpose zone type used with 5800 Type 08: 24-hour Auxiliary Alarm. series wireless pushbutton or contact closure or This zone type sends a report to Central Station and opening, and which will result in disarming the system provides an alarm sound at the keypad. (No bell output when the zone is activated. is provided). This zone type is usually assigned to a zone containing a button for use in personal Type 23: No Alarm Response emergencies, or to a zone containing monitoring This zone type can be used on a zone when an output devices such as water sensors, temperature sensors, relay action is desired, but with no accompanying alarm etc. (ex. lobby door access). Type 09: Supervised Fire. (No Verification) * Note that these zone types are for use by 5800 series This zone type provides a fire alarm on short circuit and devices only.�. a trouble condition on open circuit. The bell output will pulse when this zone type is shorted. This zone type is NOTE FOR PANIC KEYS: Keypad panic zones share always active and cannot be bypassed. This zone type the same zone response type for all 8 partitions, but can be assigned to any wired zone except zone 9, panics may be individually enabled for each partition. and can be assigned to certain wireless systems zones. IMPORTANT! FAULT ANNUNCIATION Polling loop and RF troubles (zones 88-91 & 97) will report as trouble conditions only, and as such, should be assigned zone type 05 if annunciation is desired. See SUPERVISION notes in POLLING LOOP and WIRELESS EXPANSION sections for more information. —93— • : � � � � � � ' � The following is a description of all data fields provided by this control. If you have followed earlier instructions during the installation of the various devices, many of these fields will already have been programmed. If you need more information about actual programming procedures, see Section 4: THE MECHAN/CS OF PROGRAMMING. *00 INSTALLER CODE I I I The Installer's Code is a 4-digit code reserved for installation company use. This is the only code that can be used to enter the Program mode from the keypad. This code cannot be used to disarm the system if not used to arm the system. This code cannot reenter programming mode if exited by the *98 command. *02-05 ZONE RESPONSE TYPES FOR ZONES 1-27, 95-99 These fields are programmed using#93 Menu Mode—Zone Programming. *09 ENTRY DELAY#1 (partition-specific) u Entry delay defines the delay time which allows users to reenter the premises through a door that has been programmed as an entry delay door and disarm the system without sounding an alarm. The system must be disarmed within this period or an alarm will occur. Enter the entry delay time (01-15 times 15 seconds or 00 for no delay), up to a maximum delay of 225 seconds (entry 15 times 15 seconds), for zones assigned to Zone Type 01. *10 EXIT DELAY#1 (partition-specific) � Exit delay defines the delay period that allows users to leave the premises through a door that has been programmed as an entry/exit delay door after arming the system without setting off the alarm. Enter the exit delay time (01-15 times 15 seconds or 00 for no delay), up to a maximum delay of 225 seconds, for zones assigned to Zone Type 01. *11 ENTRY DELAY#2 (partition-specific) n Entry Delay 2 is used for the zone assigned to Entry Delay#2 zone type. Note that this delay must be longer than Entry Delay#1. *12 EXIT DELAY#2 (partition-specific) � Exit delay 2 is used for the zone assigned to Exit Delay#2. Note that this delay must be longer than Exit Delay#1. *13 ALARM SOUNDER DURATION (partition-specific) � Defines the length of time an external sounder and the keypad's sounder will sound for all audible alarms (multiply entry 01-15 by 2 minutes for actual duration). This duration can be overridden by the Fire Timeout Disable option (field *21)for fire alarms. Minimum 4 minutes for UL installations. *14 ZONE 9 RESPONSE TIME � Enter 1 to set fast response mode (10msec) for appropriate devices wired to zone 9. Enter 0 for normal response, 350msec. Must be 0 for UL. —94— *15 KEYSWITCH ASSIGNMENT u Enter the partition number 1-8 in which the keyswitch is being used; otherwise, enter 0. Requires the use of zone 7 wired loop (zone 7 no longer available as protection zone when used for keyswitch operation). If the keyswitch is used, the fire and panic alarm voltage triggers automatically become ARMING and READY status outputs for support of the Keyswitch LEDs. Note: Zone type 10 is automatically assigned to zone 7 if a keyswitch is used. Reports openings/closing by user"0" if reporting is enabled in field *40. *16 CONFIRMATION OF ARMING DING (partition-specific) � Enter 1 to enable 1/2 second external alarm sounding ("ding") at the end of exit delay (or after kisoff from the central station, if sending closing reports.) Otherwise enter 0. *17 AC LOSS KEYPAD SOUNDING u Enter 1 to enable sounding at the keypad (rapid beeping) when AC power is lost (sounding occurs about 2 minutes after actual AC loss). Enter 0 if no AC power loss keypad sounding is desired. *18 AC LOSS SIREN � Enter 1 to enable the external alarm sound after AC power has been out for 4 hours; Otherwise enter 0 (no alarm). (Must be "1"for UL) *19 RANDOMIZE AC LOSS REPORT [� Selecting this option helps prevent an overload of AC loss messages at the central station during a community blackout. Enter 1 to randomize AC loss reporting between 10-40 min. after an actual AC loss. Enter 0 for normal AC loss reporting (about 2 minutes after actual AC loss). *20 VIP MODULE PHONE CODE � If a 4285 voice module is being used, enter the 2-digit phone code used to access the system. Enter 01-09 for first digit, and enter 11 (for*) or 12 (for#)for second digit. To disable the voice module, enter 00 for the 1st digit and enter 11 for the 2nd digit of the code (disable code = 00,11). *21 PREVENT FIRE TIME-OUT � Enter 1 to disable (no timeout) the alarm sounder duration for any zone designated as a fire zone, regardless of partition, so that fire sounding continues until the system is reset. Enter 0 if the normal burglary alarm sounder duration (programmed in partition-specific field *13)should apply to fire alarms. *22 KEYPAD PANIC ENABLES (partition-specific) I I Enter 1 to enable the appropriate keypad panics used 95 96 99 in this partition. Otherwise enter 0. —95— *23 MULTIPLE ALARMS (partition-specific) � Determines whether or not more than one alarm can be sounded in a given zone during an armed period. Note that multiple alarm soundings will not occur more frequently than allowed by the programmed alarm sounder duration. This selection applies to local sounding and has no impact on the number of communication messages transmitted. Refer to Swinger Suppression for limiting communication messages. Enter 1 if this feature is desired. Enter 0 if not desired. *24 IGNORE EXPANSION ZONE TAMPER I] Only applicable to certain polling loop sensors with tamper switches or 5800 series transmitters. This option is used to disable tamper detection on these devices. Enter 1 to disable (ignore)tamper. Enter 0 if tamper detection is desired. *25 BURG. TRIGGER FOR RESPONSE TYPE 8 � Enter 1 to allow optional triggering of the voltage output on pin 7 of the J7 header to include zone response type 8 (24hr. auxiliary). Enter 0 if only burglary and audible panic alarms (zone type 7)will trigger pin 7. *26 INTELLIGENT TEST REPORTING � Enter 1 if it is desired that no test report be sent if any other type of report was sent since the last test report. Enter 0 if test reports are to be sent at the set intervals, regardless of whether or not other reports have been sent. Must be 0 for UL applications. *27 TEST REPORT INTERVAL I I Enter the test reporting interval in hours, 001-999. Enter 000 if no test reporting is desired. If a test report is desired, enter a test code in fields *81 &*82, location 7. Set first test report time in field *83. Max. 024 for UL. *28 POWER UP IN PREVIOUS STATE � Enter 1 if upon power-up, after a prolonged power loss which caused the system's battery to discharge, the system will assume the system status prior to the power loss. Enter 0 if it is desired that the system will always power up in a disarmed state. When the system powers up armed, an alarm will occur 3 minutes after arming if a zone is faulted. When so armed, reports closing as User #0 if open/close reporting for installer was enabled in field *39. Note that if the previous state was armed AWAY or STAY, the system may not respond to sensor changes for a small period of time (1-3 min.), which allows sensors such as PIRs to stabilize. Must be 1 for UL applications. Note that authority levels 0 or 5 cannot be used to disarm the system if control powers up armed. —96— *29 QUICK ARM (partition-specific) n Enter 1 to enable arming of the burglary system in AWAY, STAY, INSTANT or MAXIMUM modes by using the# key instead of the security code. When armed, reports closing as User 0 if open/close reporting for User#2 (typically a master level user) was enabled for a given partition. Enter 0 if Quick Arm is not desired. (The security code must always be used to disarm the system.) Note that if quick arm is used, the installer code and authority level 5 code cannot disarm the system. *30 TOUCH-TONE OR ROTARY DIAL � Enter 1 if TouchTone service is being used. Enter 0 if rotary phone service is used. i If selecting touch-tone, make sure the subscriber has requested and is paying for L�� touch-tone service. Note that whether or not touch-tone dialing for call placement is permitted, communication by the use of DTMF signaling (Ademco High Speed) will still take place. See field 1*33 for Touch-Tone w/Rotary backup. *31 PABX ACCESS CODE I I I I This field is used to enter up to four 2-digit numbers 00-09; B-F (11-15). If not required, enter nothing and proceed to next address; otherwise, enter prefix needed to obtain an outside Telco line. *32 PRIMARY SUBSCRIBER ACCT# � � � � (partition-specific) Enter 00-09;B-F(11-15) Enter a 3 or 4 digit (depending on report format) primary subscriber account number 00-09; B-F (11-15). Each number requires a 2-digit entry so as to allow entry of hexadecimal digits (B-F). If a 3 digit account number is to be used, only enter data in the first 3 locations, leaving the last one unfilled, by entering a *. *33 PRIMARY PHONE NUMBER I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I This field is used to enter the primary central station phone number, up to 17 digits, 0-9; enter#11 for *, #12 for#, and #13 for a 2 sec. pause. This is the phone number the control will use to transmit alarm and status messages to the central station. Do not fill unused spaces. Note that back-up reporting is automatic only if a secondary phone number is entered (8 calls are made to the secondary phone number if no acknowledgment is received after 8 attempts to the primary number). *34 SECONDARY PHONE NUMBER I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I This field is used to enter the secondary phone number, up to 17 digits, 0-9; enter #11 for *, #12 for #, and #13 for a 2 sec. pause. This number. It is used if communication on the primary number is unsuccessful, or if split/dual reporting is desired. Do not fill unused spaces. If this field is programmed, a secondary subscriber account number (field "90) must also be programmed (can be the same as the primary account number). —97— *35 DOWNLOAD PHONE NO. I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I This field is applicable only if downloading will be utilized. Enter the downloading phone number, up to 12 digits, 0-9; enter#11 for *, #12 for#, and #13 for a 2 sec. pause. Do not fill unused spaces. *36 DOWNLOAD ID NO.� � � � � � � � Enter eight digits, 00-09; A-F (10-15). Only applicable if downloading will be utilized. Make entries as 2-digit numbers as follows: 00=0 02=2 04=4 06=6 08=8 10=A 12=C 14=E 01=1 03=3 05=5 07=7 09=9 11=B 13=D 15=F *37 DOWNLOAD COMMAND ENABLES ❑ ❑ � n ❑ ❑ n n Dialer System Not Remote Remote Remote Upload Download Shutdwn Shutdwn Used Bypass Disarm Arm Program Program Each of the various remote functions can either be enabled or disabled through VLink or Compass downloading software. Disabling a function means that you will not be able to perform that function with respect to this system. Enter 1 to enable a function, and 0 to disable a function. See field 1*53 to disable the download callback option. For UL installations, all entries must be 0. *38 PREVENT ZONE XX BYPASS (partition-specific) � Entering a zone number(01-86) prevents that zone from being bypassed by the user. Enter 00 if this feature is not desired (all zones can be bypassed). This selection does not affect fire zones, which the system prevents from being bypassed. *39 ENABLE OPEN/CLOSE REPORT FOR INSTALLER CODE (partition-specific) � Enter 1 if open/close reporting for the installer is desired. Otherwise enter 0. *40 OPEN/CLOSE REPORTING FOR KEYSWITCH � Enter 1 to enable open/close reporting for the keyswitch. Enter 0 if reporting is not desired. *41 NORMALLY CLOSED OR EOLR (ZONES 2-8) n Enter 0 if end-of-line resistors are to be used. Enter 1 if end-of-line resistors are not to be used, in which case only normally closed devices must be used. Must be 0 for UL. *42 DIAL TONE PAUSE � This field sets the time the system will wait for dial tone before dialing. Applies if true dial tone is not selected in field *43. Enter the desired wait time for dial tone detection as follows: Enter single digit, 0 = 5 seconds; 1 = 11 seconds; or 2 = 30 seconds. Must be 0 for UL. —98— *43 DIAL TONE DETECTION � Determines whether the control will wait for a true dial tone before dialing, or if it will wait for a predetermined delay before dialing (delay is programmed in Dial Tone Pause field "42). The latter may be necessary in high-noise environment Telco networks where noise can be confused with dial tone, resulting in premature dialing. Enter 1 for true dial tone wait. If no dial tone is detected, will dial at end of pause programmed in field *42. Enter 0 to pause for seconds entered in field *42, then dial. *44 RING DETECTION COUNT n Only applicable if using a 4285 VIP Module and/or if station initiated downloading will be used. Enter 00 to disable ring detection. Enter 01-14 for ring counts of 1-14. Enter 15 to select answering machine defeat mode, which allows the system to receive calls even when a telephone answering machine is connected to the same phone line. In the answering machine mode, the caller should let the phone ring once, then hang up, and call again within 30 seconds. The system, upon hearing one ring followed by nothing, will not answer the first call, but will ready itself to pick up on the first ring of the next incoming call that is received within 30 seconds (the downloader calling again). *45 PRIMARY FORMAT �, This field selects the reporting format for use on the primary telephone number. Enter the appropriate number for the primary format as follows: O=Low Speed; 1=Contact ID; 2=Ademco High Speed; 3=Ademco Express *46 LOW SPEED FORMAT (PRIMARY) � Enter the appropriate value: O=Ademco Low Speed; 1=Sescoa/Radionics *47 SECONDARY FORMAT � This field selects the reporting format for the secondary telephone number Enter the appropriate number for the secondary format as follows: O=Low Speed; 1=Contact ID; 2=Ademco High Speed; 3=Ademco Express *48 LOW SPEED FORMAT (SECONDARY) n Enter the appropriate value: O=Ademco Low Speed; 1=Sescoa/Radionics *49 CHECKSUM VERIFICATION � Enter 1 for either or both primary/secondary formats to send a verification digit to validate the message at the receiver without having to send two message rounds. Selection is valid for 3+1, 4+1, and 4+2 reports. Enter 0 if not desired. —99— *50 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT � Enter 0 if Radionics format is to be used with hexadecimal 0-9, B-F reporting. Enter 1 if SESCOA format is to be used with only numeric reporting (0-9). Note that selection applies to both primary and secondary phone numbers. *51 DUAL REPORTING ] This field allows all reports to be sent to both primary and secondary phone numbers. Enter 1 if all reports are to be sent to both primary and secondary phone numbers. If used with Split Reporting option 1 (1*34), alarms go to both primary & secondary numbers, while all other reports go to secondary only. If used with Split Reporting option 2, alarms go to both lines, open/close and test messages go to secondary only, while all other reports go to primary. *52 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT PRIMARY � Enter 0 for standard or 1 for expanded reporting for the primary phone number Note: Expanded overrides 4+2 format. *53 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT SECONDARY � Enter 0 for standard or 1 for expanded reporting for the secondary phone number. Note: Expanded overrides 4+2 format. *54-78 REPORT CODES FOR ZONES 01-64, 81-91, 95-99) Enter the report codes for each zone used in the system. Each digit is a two-digit entry to allow for hex codes. Enter 01-09; A-F (10-15). Can also be entered using the#93 Zone Programming mode. *79 ZONE TYPE RESTORES FOR ZONE TYPES 1-8 � uu � u � u � 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Enter 1 to enable restore reporting for individual zone types. Enter 0 if no restore report is desired for a zone type. *80 ZONE TYPE RESTORES FOR TYPES 9/10 � � 9 10 Enter 1 to enable restore reporting for individual zone types. Enter 0 if no restore report is desired for a zone type. *81- NON-ALARM REPORT CODES (FIRST DIGIT) Enter the first digit of each report code for the conditions indicated on the programming form. *82 NON-ALARM REPORT CODES (SECOND DIGIT) Enter the second digit of each report code for the conditions indicated on the programming form. —100 — *83 FIRST TEST REPORT TIME � � n Enter the day (00-07) and time (00-23 hours/00-59 min.) that the first test report shall be transmitted. 00 entry in all locations signifies immediately upon exiting. 00 entry in the day location will cause the report to be sent at the next occurrence of the time that is set. Note that day 01=Monday. See fields *81 & *82 for assigning the Test Report code. *84 SWINGER SUPPRESSION (partition-specific) � This option limits the number of inessages (Alarms or Troubles) sent for a specific channel in an armed period (Swinger Suppression). Enter 01- 15. If 00 is selected, all Alarm or Trouble codes are reported. Must be 00 (disabled)for UL installations. *85 ENABLE DIALER REPORTS � � � � FOR PANICS 8� DURESS (partition-specific) 95 96 99 Duress Enter 1 for each panic/duress for which reporting is desired. *87 ENTRY WARNING (partition-specific) ] Enter 0 for 3 short beeps, or 1 for slow beeps that continue for the entire entry delay period. *88 BURG. ALARM COMM. DELAY (partition-specific) �I 1 Enter 0 for no delay on burglary alarm communication. Enter 1 for 16- second delay (no delay on 24-hour reports). *89 RESTORE REPORT TIMING � Enter 0 for instant restore report as zone restores. Enter 1 for reporting after bell timeout if zone restored. Enter 2 for restore report when system is subsequently disarmed *90 SECONDARY SUBSCRIBER ACCT# � n � � (partition-specific) Enter 00-09;B-F(11-15) Enter the 3 or 4 digit number (depending on report format) for the secondary subscriber account, 00-09; B-F (11-15). Each number requires a 2-digit entry so as to allow entry of hexadecimal digits (B-F). If a 3-digit number is to be used, only enter data in the first 6 locations, leaving the last two unfilled. Default=15 15 15 15. Erase the field by entering *90*. NOTE: This field must be programmed if a secondary phone number is used (field *34). This account number can be the same as the primary account number. 1*01- RESPONSE TYPES FOR ZONES 28-91 1*09 These fields are programmed via#93 Menu Mode—Zone Programming. 1*17 LOBBY PARTITION � Enter the common lobby partition (1-8). Enter 0 if none. 1*18 AFFECTS LOBBY (partition-specific) � Enter 1 if this partition affects the common lobby. Will cause lobby to disarm when this partition disarms. Enter 0 if it does not. —101 — 1*19 ARMS LOBBY (partition-specific) � Enter 1 if arming this partition causes the system to attempt to arm the common lobby partition automatically. Can only arm lobby if all other affecting partitions are armed. To enable this field, field 1*18 must also be enabled. (partition-specific) Enter 0 if arming this partition will not attempt to arm the common lobby partition. 1*20 EXIT ERROR LOGIC � Enter 1 to enable Exit Error Logic (entry/exit doors will be bypassed if left open). Enter 0 if Exit Error Logic is not desired. 1*21 EXIT DELAY RESET � Enter 1 to reset Exit Delay to 60 seconds after door is closed. Enter 0 if Exit Delay not to be reset. 1*22 CROSS ZONING PAIR ONE � � Enter the first pair of zones which must both be faulted within a five minute period to cause an alarm. Enter 00,00 to disable. 1*23 CROSS ZONING PAIR TWO � � Enter the second pair of zones which must both be faulted within a five minute period to cause an alarm. Enter 00,00 to disable. 1*24 CROSS ZONING PAIR THREE � � Enter the third pair of zones which must both be faulted within a five minute period to cause an alarm. Enter 00,00 to disable. 1*25 CROSS ZONING PAIR FOUR � � Enter the fourth pair of zones which must both be faulted within a five minute period to cause an alarm. Enter 00,00 to disable. 1*28 RF TX LOW BATTERY SOUND � Enter 0 if audible beep and display annunciation upon RF transmitter low battery condition is desired only in disarmed state. Enter 1 if audible beep and display is desired in both armed and disarmed states. Must be 1 for UL. 1*29 RF TX LOW BATTERY REPORT ENABLE � Enter 1 if a trouble message for RF transmitter low battery conditions is to be sent to the central station. Enter 0 if no report for transmitter low battery is desired. Note that a trouble message will be sent for a transmitter supervision failure independent of this selection. Must be 1 for UL. —102 — 1*30 RF RCVR SUPERVISION CHECK-IN INTERVAL � Enter the check-in monitoring interval in 2-hour increments. Enter 02-15 times 2 hours (4-30 hours). Failure of a receiver to receive any RF signal within the time entered will result in activation of the response type programmed for zone 90 for the first receiver and zone 88 for the second receiver and their related communication reports. Enter 00 to disable receiver supervision. Max. "6" (12 hr)for UL. 1*31 RF TRANSMITTER CHECK-IN INTERVAL n Enter the check-in monitoring interval in 2-hour increments; Enter 02-15 times 2 hours (4-30 hours). Failure of an individual transmitter to send a supervision signal within the time entered will result in a trouble response and related communication report. Entry 00 disables transmitter supervision. Max. "6" (12 hr)for UL. 1*32 RECEIVER TYPE � Enter 1 if using 4281 series receivers. Enter 2 if using 5881 series receivers. Important: the 4281 microprocessor must have part number N5334Vx, where x is any number. 1*33 TOUCH-TONE W/ROTARY BACKUP u Enter 1 to enable Rotary back-up dialing if communicator is not successful on dialing using touch-tone DTMF on first attempt. Enter 0 if this option is not desired. 1*34 COMM. SPLIT REPORT SELECTION � This field allows certain reports to be directed to either the primary or secondary phone number. Enter 0, 1, or 2, in accordance with the following: 0 = split reporting disabled; 1 = alarm, alarm restore & cancel reports sent to primary Telco number, all others to secondary Telco number; 2 = open/close &test reports sent to secondary Telco number and all other reports to primary. See *51 for split/dual reporting comments. 1*35- REPORT CODES FOR ZONES 65-80 1*39 Enter the report codes for each zone used in the system. Each digit is a two-digit entry to allow for hex codes. Enter 01-09; A-F (10-15). Can also be entered using the#93 Zone Programming mode. 1*40 EVENT LOGGING REPORT CODES 1*41 Enter the appropriate code as shown on the programming form. 1*42 CALL WAITING DEFEAT I� Enter 1 for the panel to defeat call waiting on the first attempt (DO NOT enable unless call waiting is being used. Otherwise, enter 0. —103 — 1*43 PERMANENT KEYPAD DISPLAY BACKLIGHTING n (partition-specific) Enter 1 if it is desired that backlighting for the keypad display remain on at all times. Enter 0 if the display should remain unlit unless a key is pressed. The backlighting then turns off again after a period of keypad inactivity. Note that when a key is pressed, display backlighting turns on for all keypads in that partition. 1*44 WIRELESS KEYPAD TAMPER DETECT � Enter 1 to enable tamper detection on wireless keypad. Enter 0 if tamper detection is not desired. If this feature is enabled, any attempt to tamper by means of many trial entries at a wireless keypad will be blocked by the control panel. If more than 40 key depressions are received without a valid sequence (arm, disarm, etc.), the Control panel will disable the wireless keypad. The inhibit is removed once a valid key sequence is received from a wired keypad. 1*45 EXIT DELAY SOUNDING (partition-specific) � Enter 1 if beeps from the keypads during exit delay is desired. Enter 0 for no keypad sound during exit delay. 1*46 AUXILIARY OUTPUT MODE �J Enter 0 if ground start output is required (not for UL applications); Enter 1 if the auxiliary output will be used to produce an open/close trigger(produced only if all partitions are armed); Enter 2 if the auxiliary output will be used to produce keypad-like sounding at an auxiliary sounder(ex. 706-12)This option applies only to the partition set in field *15. NOTE: Only one of the above options can be active within a system. Enter 3 if AAV module is being used. 1*47 CHIME ON EXTERNAL SIREN (partition-specific) � Enter 1 for chime annunciation using the external alarm sounder. If not desired, enter 0. 1*48 WIRELESS KEYPAD ASSIGNMENT ] Enter the partition in which RF keypad is used, 1-8. Enter 0 if no RF keypad is used. 1*49 SUPPRESS TX SUPERVISION SOUND � Enter 1 to disable trouble sounding for transmitter check-in failure. Enter 0 if audible trouble sounding is desired. Must be "0"for UL. 1*52 SEND CANCEL IF ALARM + OFF (partition-specific) � Enter 1 if cancel reports to be sent when the system is disarmed after an alarm, regardless of how much time has gone by. Enter 0 if cancel reports are to be sent within Bell Timeout period only. 1*53 DISABLE DOWNLOAD CALLBACK � Enter 1 to disable the callback requirement for downloading. Enter 0 to require a callback. Must be 0 for UL installations. —104 — 1*57 ENABLE 5800 RF BUTTON GLOBAL ARM � Enter 1 to have the system arm/disarm in accordance with the button's user's global arming settings. Enter 0 if the button is not to be used to global arm the system (however, home partition arming will still occur). 1*58 ENABLE 5800 RF BUTTON FORCE BYPASS I� Enter 1 to allow the RF Button user to force bypass all faulted zones. When attempting to arm the system, the keypad will beep once after pressing the button if any faulted zones are present. If this feature is enabled, the user should then press the button again within 4 seconds to force bypass those zones and arm the system. Enter 0 if RF button forced bypassing is not desired. 1*60 ZONE 5 AUDIO ALARM VERIFICATION � Enter 1 if 2-Way Audio (AAV) is being used. Enter 0 if AAV is not being used. 1*70 EVENT LOG TYPES CI � n C n Alm Chck Byps O/C Systm Enter 1 for each type of event for which event logging is desired. Otherwise enter 0. 1*71 12/24 HOUR TIME STAMP FORMAT � Select the type of time stamping desired: 0=standard 12 hour; 1= 24 hour format. 1*72 EVENT LOG PRINTER ON-LINE � Enter 1 to have the printer print events as they occur Enter 0 to enable the printer such that the logs are only printed upon request. 1*73 PRINTER BAUD RATE � Enter 0 if printer is set for 1200 baud (preferred). Enter 1 if printer is set for 300 baud. 1*74 RELAY TIMEOUT XX MINUTES I I Enter the relay timeout, 000-127 in multiples of 2 minutes, desired for #80 Menu Mode time driven event relay command numbers "04/09" and #93 Menu Mode Relay Programming output command "56" (refer to#93 and #80 Menu Mode sections in this manual). 1*75 RELAY TIMEOUT YY SECONDS I I Enter the relay timeout, 000-127 seconds, desired for#80 Menu Mode time driven event relay command numbers "05/10" and #93 Menu Mode Relay Programming command "57" (refer to#93 and #80 Menu Mode sections in this manual. 1*76 ACCESS CONTROL RELAY (partition-specific) � The system can be programmed to provide user activated access control. If enabled, the assigned relay will pulse for 2 seconds when the user enters his code and presses "0". Enter the relay number(00-16)for the relay that will be used for access control. Enter 00 if not used in this partition. —105 — 2*00 NUMBER OF PARTITIONS � Enter the number of partitions (1-8) to be used in the system. 2*01 DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME �� START/END MONTH Enter the months 00-12 in which daylight savings time starts and ends. Enter 00, 00 if daylight savings time does not apply to the user's region. Standard setting for U.S. is 04,10. 2*02 DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME �� START/END WEEKEND Enter the start and end weekends for daylight savings time as follows: 01=first; 02=second; 03=third; 04=fourth; 05=1ast; 06=next to last; 07=third from last. Standard setting for U.S. is 01,05. 2*05 AUTO-ARM DELAY (partition-specific) � Enter the time between the end of the arming window and the start of auto arm warning time in values of 01-14 times 4 minutes. Enter 00 if no delay is desired. Enter 15 if auto arming is not desired. 2*06 AUTO-ARM WARNING PERIOD (partition-specific) � Enter the time 01-15 in one minute increments during which the user is warned by a keypad sounding and display to exit the premises prior to auto arming of the system. 2*07 AUTO-DISARM DELAY (partition-specific) � Enter the time between the end of the disarming window and the start of auto disarming of the system in values of 01-14 times 4 minutes. Enter 00 if no delay is desired. Enter 15 if auto disarming is not desired. 2*08 ENABLE FORCE ARM FOR AUTO-ARM u (partition-specific) Enter 1 if the system should automatically bypass any faulted zones when it attempts to auto arm. Otherwise enter 0. 2*09 OPEN/CLOSE REPORTS BY EXCEPTION � (partition-specific) Enter 1 if it is desired that open/close reports be sent only if the openings/closings occur outside the arm and disarm windows. Open reports will also be suppressed during the closing window in order to prevent false alarms if the user arms the system, then reenters the premises to retrieve a forgotten item. Note that openings and closings are still recorded in the event log. Enter 0 if exception reporting is not desired. Note: This field must be set to 1 if late/early opening, late/early closing, and no opening/closing reports are to be sent (2*13, 2*14). 2*10 ALLOW DISARMING ONLY DURING ARM/DISARM � WINDOWS (partition-specific) Enter 1 if disarming of the system should be allowed only during the arming/disarming windows, or if the system is in alarm (if 2"11 is set to "1"). Note that this applies only to operator level users. Installer, Master and manager level users can disarm the system at any time. Enter 0 if disarming can occur at any time. 0=disable for displayed partition; 1=enable for displayed partition —106 — 2*11 ALLOW DISARM OUTSIDE WINDOW IF n ALARM OCCURS Used only if field 2*10 (partition-specific field) is set to 1. Enter 1 to allow the system to be disarmed outside the programmed disarm (opening)window if an alarm has occurred. Enter 0 to allow disarming only during the disarm window, regardless of system status. If field 2*10 is set to 0 for a partition, this field (2*11) has no effect for that partition. 2*13- SCHEDULING RELATED DIALER REPORTS 2*14 Enter the report codes for the scheduling related events as shown on the programming form. 2*18 ENABLE GOTO FOR THIS PARTITION � (partition-specific) Enter 1 if this partition is to be accessed from another partition's keypad using the GOTO command. Otherwise enter 0. 2*19 USE PARTITION DESCRIPTORS � Enter 1 if partition descriptors will be programmed. If enabled, the normal keypad display will include a partition number and four-digit descriptor). Enter 0 to cause the keypads to display a non-partitioned system type of display (no partition number will appear). 2*20 ENABLE J7 TRIGGERS BY PARTITION � (partition-specific) 2*21 SUPERVISION PULSES FOR LORRA I I TRIGGER OUTPUTS F B S Used for supervised connection to 7920SE. Enter 1 to enable pulses for each type of LORRA trigger (burglary, fire, silent panic). This option causes the control to send periodic short pulses on he J7 radio triggers These pulses are used by the 7920SE to determine that its connection to the control is still intact. Enter 0 if not desired. —107 — • � • � � � ' ' � � � This section provides the following information: • #93 Menu Mode main menu options • Zone Programming • Serial Number Programming • Alpha Programming • Device Programming • Relay Programming • Relay Voice Descriptors • Custom Index Programming (VIP Module substitute words) #93 Main Menu Options ,, The following fields should be programmed before beginning: 2*00: Number of Partitions; 1*32: RF receiver type. After programming all system related programming fields in the usual way, press #93 while still in programming mode to display the first choice of the menu driven programming options, which are as follows: ZONE PROG? For programming the following: IO=No 1=Yes � • Zone Number • Zone Response Type • Partition Number for Zone • Dialer report code for zone • Input Device Type for zone (whether RF, polling loop, etc.) • Learning serial numbers of 5800 series transmitters & serial polling loop devices into the system (all other zone characteristics must be pre-programmed). (ALPHA PROG? ` For entering alpha descriptors for the following: �0=no 1=yes � • Zone Descriptors • Installer's Message • Custom Words • Partition Descriptors • Relay Descriptors iDEVICE PROG? For defining the following device characteristics for ,0=no 1=yes addressable devices, including keypads, RF receivers (4281/5881), 4204 output relay modules, and 4285 VIP Module: •Device Address •Device Type •Keypad Options (incl. partition assignment) •RF House ID RELAY PROG? � For defining output relay functions. This prompt is 0=no 1= es fully explained in the 4204 RELAY MODULE section. RLY VOICE DESCR? For entering voice descriptors for relays/Power Line `0=no 1=yes Carrier devices to be used with the 4285 VIP Module This prompt is fully explained in the RELAY OUTPUTS/POWER LINE CARRIER DEVICES section. CUSTOM INDEX#? � For creating custom word substitutes for VIP Module 0=no 1=yes annunciation. This prompt is fully explained in the 4285 VIP MODULE section. —108 — Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES) in response to the displayed menu selection. Pressing 0 will display the next choice in sequence. Refer to the ZONE PROGRAMMING section for instructions on how to program zone characteristics, the DEVICE PROGRAMM/NG section for instructions on how to program addressable devices, and the ALPHA PROGRAMMING section for programming alpha descriptors. The following is a list of commands used while in the menu mode. #93 Menu Mode Ke Commands #93 Enters Menu mode * Serves as ENTER ke . Press to have ke ad acce t entr . # Backs u to revious screen. 0 Press to answer NO 1 Press to answer YES 00 Escapes from menu mode, back into data field programming mode, if entered at the first prompt of each main menu option. Zone Programming Enter Programming mode [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. The following fields should be programmed before beginning: 2*00: Number of Partitions; 1*32: RF Receiver Type. Also, before programming wireless zones, the RF receiver must be enabled in Device Programming Mode (later in Device Programming section). Then press#93 to display"ZONE PROG?". ZONE PROG? Press 1 to enter ZONE PROGRAMMING mode. The �1=Yes O=No following screens will appear. Press u to display the next screen. Press # to display a previous screen. Enter Zn No. I Enter the zone number to be programmed (01-86, �00=QUIT 20 � 88-g1, 92 (duress), 95, 96, 97 or 99). Press � to accept entry. 20 ZT P RC In:L � A summary screen for that zone will appear. 00 1 00 RF:N ZT=Zone Type, P=Partition, RC=Report Code, � � In:=the input type of device, and L=the device's loop number to which the sensor is connected (some devices can support more than one zone by means of individual loops (ex. 5801, 5803, 5816, 5817, etc.) 20 Zone Type A P Zone disabled 00 Each zone in a system must be assigned a zone type, which defines the way in which the system responds to faults in that zone. Refer to Section 17: ZONE TYPE DEFIN/TIDNS for detailed definitions of each zone type. Enter the zone response type for this zone. The screen will automatically display the zone type for the number entered. Press �to accept entry. —109 — Zone Types are as follows: 00 Assign for unused zones 01 Entry/Exit#1, burglary 02 Entry/exit#2, 03 Perimeter, burglary 04 Interior, follower, burglary 05 Trouble by day/Alarm by night, burglary 06 24 hour silent alarm 07 24 hour audible alarm 08 24 hour auxiliary 09 Fire 10 Interior, delay, burglary 20 Arm-stay (for 5800 RF only) 21 Arm-away (for 5800 RF only) 22 Disarm (for 5800 RF only) 23 No alarm response (ex. relay action) For UL applications, use of 1 or 2 RF RCVRs requires enabling their respective faults (88-91) as applicable (zone type 5). (20 Partition � Enter the partition number (1-8) that this zone is � � located in. �20 Report Code J Enter the report code for this zone. � `20 Input Type � Enter the input device type as follows: 0 = not used; �RF Trans. RF: � 1=hardwired; 3=supervised RF transmitter(RF type); Note that input types 4 4=unsupervised RF transmitter (UR type); 5=RF & 5 are valid for certain button type transmitter (BR type); 6=serial number 5800 series transmitters polling loop device (SL type); 7=DIP switch type only (ex. 5801, 5802, polling loop device; 8=right loop of DIP switch type 5802CP & 5803). When device. using 5700 series Right loops refer to the use of the right loop on a transmitters, always set 4190WH zone expander module and/or 4278 PIR, the input type to 3 (RF). which allow hard-wired devices to be monitored by The zone number of the the polling loop. transmitter identifies If hardwired, dipswitch polling loop, or 5700 series whether or not devices are being programmed, after completing this supervision is required (ex. 5700 wireless zone entry, the summary display appears. Press � to number 63 is not continue. The display will now return to the "Enter supervised). Zone Number" prompt for programming the next zone into the system. If all zones are programmed, enter 0 0 and press (*) to exit back to normal programming mode. If either 5800 series RF or polling loop serial number devices are being programmed, continue to the next prompt. 920 LOOP NUMBER If this is a previously "learned" sensor, the loop I . number for this zone will appear. Press � to OR continue. �20 LEARN S/N ? II If the sensor's serial number has not been "learned," 1=YES 0=N0 the serial number can be learned now by entering 1, or it can be learned later by using the SERIAL NUMBER LEARN mode (see next section). —110 — �20 INPUT S/N :L ' If learning the serial number now (entering 1 at the � A000-0000:1 last prompt), this prompt appears. Fault and restore the transmitter or polling loop device twice. The keypad will beep twice when it hears the first transmission, and three times when it hears the second. If the serial number is printed on the wireless device, it may be entered manually rather than learned. The loop number you want to use for this zone must also be entered. �20 PROG AS RF:1 A summary screen will appear if the serial number � A001-3078:1 was successfully learned. Press � to continue. Press n to continue. The summary screen will then appear (see summary screen description above). Press � to return to the "Enter Zone Number" prompt for programming the next zone into the system. When all zones are programmed, enter 00 and press (*). The system will prompt"Quit?" Enter 1 to exit back to normal programming mode. Enter 0 to stay in menu mode. Learning Serial Numbers Usually, serial numbers are learned during zone programming. But if not, use #93 menu mode to learn serial numbers (for example, if all other programming was done via downloading). 1. Enter data field programming mode: installer code + 8 0 0. 2. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 3. Press 0 (NO) repeatedly until the "SERIAL# PROG?" prompt appears. f SERIAL#PROG? � To learn or delete a device's serial number, enter 1 �0=no 1=yes I (yes). Enter 0 to move to the Alpha Programming � menu. Enter Zone No. Enter the zone number of the device to be learned or 00=QUIT deleted. Press � to move to the next prompt. Enter 00 to quit Serial Number programming. If that zone number was programmed as a non- applicable input type (i.e., Hardwird) in the Zone Programming mode, a prompt indicating such will appear. Press � to return to the "Enter Zone No." prompt. �10 PROG AS RF:2 f If a serial number has already been learned for that A000-5372:2 A device, a summary prompt will appear displaying the type of device and its serial number. Press � to continue to the Delete S/N prompt. DELETE S/N? � Enter 1 to delete the displayed serial numbered O=No, 1=Yes � device. Enter 0 if this device should not be deleted. —111 — Input type ' If a serial number for that device has not been Input= 0 or 3-6 learned yet, and if the device assigned to that zone number has been programmed as a serial number input device in the Zone Programming menus, this prompt will appear. Enter the device input type as follows: 0=none, 3= supervised RF transmitter (RF type), 4= unsupervised RF transmitter (UR), 5= RF button type (BR type), 6= serial polling loop device (SL type). Press � to con tinue. Learn S/N? �O=No, 1=Yes " If adding a new serial number device to the system, this prompt will appear after entering the input type. Enter 1 to learn the device's serial number into the system. Press � to continue. ,Input S/N:L V If 1 was entered at the Learn S/N? prompt, this Axxx - xxxx:L� screen will appear. The device's serial number can be automatically learned by faulting the device at least twice (two consecutive transmissions must be received by the panel). The keypad will beep twice after the first transmission, and three times after the second. If the serial number is printed on the wireless device, it may be entered manually rather than learned. The loop number you want to use for this zone must also be entered. �10 PROG AS RF:2 � A summary screen will appear if the serial number u A000-5372:2 I was successfully learned. Press � to continue. iZN ZT P RC IN:L � A summary screen for the zone will appear showing �10 03 1 3 1 RF:2 ' the zone number, zone type (ZT), partition assignment (P), report code (RC), and input device type (IN:L). Press � to continue. The "Enter Zone No". prompt will appear again. —112 — Programming Alpha Descriptors General Information • If using a 5137AD or 6139 alpha keypad in the system, you can program a user friendly English language description/location for all protection zones, relays, keypad panics, polling loop short, and RF receiver supervision troubles. • Each description can be composed of a combination of words (up to a maximum of 3) that are selected from a vocabulary of 244 words stored in memory, and any word can have an "s" or" 's " added to it. • In addition, up to 20 installer-defined words can be added to those already in memory. Thus, when an alarm or trouble occurs in a zone, an appropriate description for the location of that zone will be displayed at the keypad. • A custom installer's message can be programmed for each partition which will be displayed when the system is "Ready" (ex. THE PETERSON's). 1. To program alpha descriptors, enter Programming mode, then press #93 to display"ZONE PROG?" 2. Press 0 (NO)twice to display"ALPHA PROG?". 3. Press 1 to enter ALPHA PROGRAMMING mode. There are 6 sub-menu selections that will be displayed one at a time. Press 1 to select the mode desired. Press 0 to display the next mode available. The alpha menu selections are: �ONE DESCRIP.?I for entering zone descriptors. �EFAULT SCREEN?� for creating custom message; displayed when system ready. �STOM WORD� for creating custom words for use in descriptors. PART DESCRIP?I for creating 4-character partition names. RELAY DESCRIP? for creating descriptors for relays. EXIT EDIT MODE?� Press 1 to exit back to#93 Menu Mode. 4. Refer to the sections that follow for procedures for adding alpha descriptors. Zone Descriptors 1. Select ZONE DESCRIPTOR mode. The keypad keys perform the following functions: [3] Scrolls both alphabet and actual words in ascending alphabetical order. [1] Scrolls both alphabet and actual words in descending alphabetical order. [2] Adds or removes an "s" or" 's " to a vocabulary word. [6] Switches between alphabet and actual word list; used to accept entries. [8] Saves the zone description in the system's memory. [#] #plus zone number displays the description for that zone. 2. Enter the zone number to which you want to assign a descriptor. Ex.. Key*01 to begin entering the description for zone 1, (key*02 for zone 2, *03 for zone 3 etc.). The following will be displayed: *ZN 01 A Note that the first letter of the alphabet appears after the zone number, and that the zone number is automatically included with the description. 3. Enter the descriptor for that zone. Use one of two methods as follows: (assume, for example that the desired description for zone 1 is BACK DOOR) —113 — a) Press [#] followed by the 3 digit number of the first word from the fixed dictionary shown later in this section (e.g., [0][1][3] for BACK). Press [6] in order to accept the word and proceed, or press [8] to store the complete descriptor and exit, or... b) Select the first letter of the desired description (note that "A" is already displayed). Use the [3] key to advance through the alphabet and the [1] key to go backward. Press the [3] key repeatedly until "B" appears (press [1] to go backwards if you happen to pass it), then press key [6] to display the first available word beginning with B. Press the [3] key repeatedly to advance through the available words until the word BACK is displayed. , To add an "s" or" 's," if you need to, press the [2] key. The first depression adds L�� an "s," the second depression adds an �� �s, " the third depression displays no character(to erase the character), the fourth depression adds an "s,"etc. 4. Accept the word. To accept the word, press the [6] key, which switches back to alphabet list for the next word, or press [8]to store the complete descriptor and exit. 5. Select the next word. For selection of the next word (DOOR), repeat step 3a (word #057) or 3b, but selecting the word "DOOR". To accept the word, press the [6] key, which again switches back to alphabet list. 6. Store the descriptor. When all desired words have been entered, press key [8] to store the description in memory. 7. To review the zone descriptors, key [#] plus zone number(e.g., #01). To edit zone descriptors, key [*] plus zone number(e.g., *01) 8. Exit zone description mode: enter 00. Custom Words • Up to 20 installer-defined words can be added to the built-in vocabulary. Each of the 20 "words" can actually consist of several words, but bear in mind that a maximum of 10 characters can be used for each word string. 1. Select CUSTOM WORD mode. The keys perform the following functions: [3] Advances through alphabet in ascending order. [1] Advances through alphabet in descending order. [6] Selects desired letter; moves the cursor 1 space right. [4] Moves the cursor one space to the left. [7] Inserts a space at the cursor location, erasing any character at that location. [8] Saves the new word in the system's memory. [*] Returns to description entry mode. 2. Enter the custom word number 01-20 you want to create. For example, if you are creating the first word (or word string), enter 01; when creating the second word, enter 02, and so on. A cursor will now appear at the beginning of the second line. 3. Type the word using one of two methods as follows: a) Press the [#] key, followed by the two digit entry for the first letter you would like to display(e.g., [6][5]for"A"), —114 — When the desired character appears, press the [6] key to select it. The cursor will then move to the right, in position for the next character. Press [#] plus the two digit entry for the next letter of the word. OR... b) Use the [3] key to advance through the list of symbols, numbers, and letters. Use the [1] key to move back through the list. When you have reached the desired character, press the [6] key to select it. The cursor will then move to the right, in position for the next character. 5. Repeat step 3 to create the desired custom word (or words). Use the [4] key to move the cursor to the left if necessary, Use the [7] key to enter a blank (or to erase an existing character). Each word or word string cannot exceed 10 characters. 6. Save the word by pressing the [8] key. This will return you to the CUSTOM WORD? display. The custom word (or string of words) will be automatically added to the built-in vocabulary at the end of the group of words beginning with the same letter. Custom words are retrieved as word numbers 250 to 269 for words 1 to 20 respectively, when using method 3a to enter alpha descriptors. When using method 3b to enter alpha descriptors, each word will be found at the end of the group of words that begin with the same letter as it does. 7. Repeat steps 2 through 6 to create up to 19 additional custom words (or word strings). 8. Exit Custom Word Mode by entering 00 at the custom word prompt. Partition Descriptors 1. Select "Part DESCRIPT." mode. The system will ask for the partition number desired. Enter the number as a single key entry 1-8. 2. Follow the same procedure as for CUSTOM WORDS, except that partition descriptors are limited to four(4) characters (ex. WHSE for warehouse). Relay Descriptors The descriptor for each relay is limited to a maximum of ten (10) characters. The keys perForm the same functions as in the CUSTOM WORD entry. 1. Select "RELAY DESCRIPT." mode. The system will ask for the relay number desired. Enter the number as a double key entry 01-16. A cursor will now appear at the beginning of the second line. 2. Type the word using the following method: Use the [3] key to advance through the list of sym bols, numbers, and letters. Use the [1] key to move back through the list. When you have reached the desired character, press the [6] key to select it. The cursor will then move to the right, in position for the next character. 3. Repeat step 2 to create the desired word (or words). 4. Save the word by pressing the [8] key. This will return you to the RELAY DESCRIPT ? display. 5. Repeat steps 1 through 4 for each relay. 6. Exit Relay Descriptor Mode by entering 00 at the RELAY DESCRIPT ? prompt. NOTE: Relay descriptors will appear on an alpha keypad when turning a relay on or off using the Code +#70 Relay Menu mode. —115 — Custom Message Display (Installer's Message) Normally, when the system is in the disarmed state, the following display is present on the keypad. ****DISARMED**** READY TO ARM Part or all of the above message can be modified to create a custom installer message for each partition. For example, **'`*DISARMED**** on the first line or READY TO ARM on the second line could be replaced by the installation company name or phone number for service. Note that there are only 16 character spaces on each of the two lines. To create a custom display message, proceed as follows: 1. Select DEFAULT SCREEN mode. The keypad will ask for the partition number for this message. Enter the partition number. Press [*] to accept entry. The following will appear: ****DISARMED**** READY TO ARM A cursor will be present at the extreme left of the first line (over the first "star"). The [6] key is used to move the cursor to the right and the [4] key to move the cursor to the left. Key [7] may be used to insert spaces or erase existing characters. 2. Create the message. For example, to replace READY TO ARM with the message SERVICE: 424- 0177, proceed as follows: Press the [6] key to move the cursor to the right, and continue until the cursor is positioned over the first location on the second line. Press the [3] key to advance through the alphabet to the first desired character (in this case, "S"). Use the [1] key to go backward, when necessary. When the desired character is reached, press [6]. The cursor will then move to the next position, ready for entry of the next character (in this example, "E"). When the cursor reaches a position over an existing character, pressing the [3] or [1] key will advance or back up from that character in the alphabet. Proceed in this manner until all characters in the message have been entered. 3. Save the message. Store the new display message in memory by pressing the [8] key. 4. The system will ask for a new partition number. Enter 0 to quit or 1-8 for a new partition number. —116 — ALPHA DESCRIPTOR VOCABULARY (For Entering Alpha Descriptors. To select a word, press [#]followed by the word's 3-digit number.) NOTE: This vocabulary is not to be used for relay voice descriptors. See the RELAY VOICE DESCRIPTORS section when programming relay voice descriptors. 000 (WordSpace) • 052 DETECTOR ]02 INTERIOR 151 POLICE 202 TRANSMITTER • 001 AIR • 053 DINING 103 INTRUSION 152 POOL 203 TRAP • 002 ALARM 054 DISCRIMINATOR • 153 POWER 003 ALCOVE O55 DISPLAY 104 JEWELRY 204 ULTRA 004 ALLEY 056 DOCK • 105 KITCHEN 154 QUAD • 205 UP 005 AMBUSH • 057 DOOR • 206 UPPER • 006 AREA 058 DORMER • 106 LAUNDRY 155 RADIO • 207 UPSTAIRS • 007 APARTMENT • 059 DOWN • 107 LEFI' • 156 REAR • 208 UTILITY 008 ART • 060 DOWNSTAIRS 108 LEVEL 157 RECREATION 209 VALVE • 009 ATTIC 061 DRAWER • 109 LIBRARY 158 REFRIG 210 VAULT O10 AUDIO • 062 DRIVEWAY • 110 LIGHT 159 REFRIGERATION 211 VIBRATION O11 AUXILIARY 063 DRUG lll LINE 160 RF 212 VOLTAGE • 064 DUCT 112 LIQUOR • 161 RIGHT • 012 BABY • 113 I.IVING • 162 ROOM 2l3 WALL • 013 BACK • 065 EAST • 114 LOADING 163 ROOF 214 WAREHOUSE • 014 BAR 066 ELECTRIC 1]5 I,OCK 215 WASH O15 BARN 067 EMERGENCY 116 LOOP 164 SAFE • 216 WEST • 016 BASEMENT 068 ENTRY 117 LOW 165 SCREEN • 217 WINDOW • 017 BATHROOM • 069 EQUIPMENT • ll8 LOWER 166 SENSOR 218 WINE • 018 BED 070 EXECUTIVE • 167 SERVICE • 219 WING • 019 BEDROOM • 071 EXIT • ll9 MACHINE • 168 SHED 220 WIRELESS 020 BELL 072 EXTERIOR 120 MAGNETIC 169 SHOCK 221 WORK • 021 BLOWER 121 MAIDS • 170 SHOP • 022 BOILER • 073 FACTORY 122 MAIN 171 SHORT 222 XMITTER 023 BOTTOM 074 FAILURE • 123 MASTER 172 SHOW 024 BOX 075 FAMILY 124 MAT • 173 5IDE 223 YARD 025 BREAK • 076 FATHERS • 125 MEDICAL 174 SKYLIGHT • 026 BUILDING • 077 FENCE 126 MEDICINE 175 SLIDING 224 ZONE (No J 027 BURNER 078 FILE 127 MICROWAVE • 176 SMOKE • 225 ZONE • 079 FIRE 128 MONEY 177 SONIC 028 CABINET • O80 FLOOR 129 MONITOR • 178 SONS 226 0 • 029 CALL 081 FLOW • 130 MOTHERS • 179 SOUTH 227 1 030 CAMERA 082 FOIL • 131 MOTION 180 SPRINKLER 228 IST 031 CAR • 083 FOYER 132 MOTOR 181 STAMP 229 2 032 CASE 084 FREEZER 133 MUD • 182 STATION 230 2ND 033 CASH • 085 FRONT 183 STEREO 231 3 034 CCTV 086 FUR • 134 NORTH 184 STORE 232 3RD 035 CE[LING 087 FURNACE 135 NURSERY • 185 STORAGE 233 4 036 CELLAR 186 STORY 234 4TH • 037 CENTRAL 088 GALLERY • 136 OFFICE 187 STRESS 235 5 038 CIRCUIT • 089 GARAGE 137 O1L 188 STRIKE 236 STH 039 CLIP • 090 GAS • 138 OPEN 189 SUMP 237 6 • 040 CLOSED 091 GATE 139 OPENING 190 SUPERVISED 238 6TH 041 COIN • 092 GLASS • 140 OUTSIDE 191 SUPERVISION 239 7 042 COLD 093 GUEST 141 OVERFLOW 192 SWIMMING 240 7TH 043 COATROOM 094 GUN 142 OVERHEAD 193 SWITCH 241 8 044 COLLECTION 242 8TH 045 COMBUSTION • 095 HALL 143 PAINTING 194 TAMPER 243 9 • 046 COMPUTER • 096 HEAT • 144 PANIC 195 TAPE 244 9TH 047 CONTACT 097 HIGH 145 PASSIVE 196 TELCO 250 Custom Word 1 098 HOLDUP • 146 PATIO 197 TELEPHONE to • 048 DAUGHTERS 099 HOUSE 147 PERIMETER 198 1'ELLER 269 Custom Word 20 049 DELAYED • 148 PHONE • 199 TEMPERATURE • O50 DEN 100 INFRARED 149 PHOTO 200 THERMOSTAT O51 DESK • 101 INSIDE 150 POINT • 201 TOOL CHARACTER (ASCII) CHART (For Adding Custom Words) 32 (space) 42 * 52 4 62 > 72 H 82 R 33 ! 43 + 53 5 63 ? 73 I 83 S 34 " 44 , 54 6 64 @ 74 J 84 T 35 # 45 - 55 7 65 A 75 K 85 U 36 $ 46 . 56 8 66 B 76 L 86 V 37 % 47 / 57 9 67 C 77 M 87 W 38 & 48 0 58 . 68 D 78 N 88 X 39 ' 49 1 59 , 69 E 79 O 89 Y 40 ( 50 2 60 < 70 F 80 P 90 Z 41 ) 51 3 61 = 71 G 81 Q *Notes: This factory-provided vocabulary of words is subject to change. Bulleted words in bold face type are those that are also available for use by the 4285 VIP module. If using a VIP module, and words other than these are selected for alpha descriptors, the voice module will not provide annunciation of those words. —117 — Device Programming This menu is used to program keypads, receivers and relay modules. From Data Field Programming mode, press #93 to display "ZONE PROG?". Press 0 repeatedly to display"DEVICE PROG?". DEV��f��I�E PRZ��� Press 1 to enter DEVICE PROGRAMMING mode. 1=YES 0=N0 �DEVICE ADDRES�� The device address identifies the device to the �01-31, 00=QUIT ' control. Enter the 2-digit device address number to match the device's physical address setting (01-30). Press � to accept entry. Note: Device Address 04 must be used for the 4285 Voice Module, if one is utilized. If not, it can be used for another device type. ������I��E�TY� � Select the type of addressable device as follows: � 00 = device not used 01 = alpha keypad (5137AD/6139) 02 =fixed word keypad (4137AD/6137/6128) 03 = RF receiver(4281/5881) 04 = output relay module (4204) 05 = voice (VIP) module (4285) Press � to accept entry. �C�N� LE PART. fl If device type 01 or 02 was selected, this prompt will � appear. Enter the addressable device's default partition number (01 to maximum number of partitions programmed for system in field 2*00). This is the primary partition for which the device is intended to be used. Enter"9" to make this keypad a "Master" keypad for the system. Press � to accept entry. RF EXPANLLDEuR ', If device type 03 is selected, this prompt will appear. HOUSE ID XX j' Enter the 2-digit House ID (00-31). This is required � for 5700 series systems only, or if using a wireless keypad (5827/5827BD)with a 5800 series system. MODULE PART. I If device type 05, voice (VIP) module, was selected, enter the partition number 1-8 in which the voice module is located. Press � to accept entry. —118 — �SOUND OPTION Addressable keypads can be individually programmed to suppress arm/disarm beeps, entry/exit beeps and chime mode beeps. This helps prevent unwanted sounds from disturbing users in other areas of the premises. Enter a number 00-03 for the keypad sounding suppression options desired for the keypad as fol lows: 00 = no suppression. 01 = suppress arm/disarm & entry/exit beeps. 02 =suppress chime mode beeps only. 03 = suppress arm/disarm, entry/exit and chime mode beeps. The screen will display the next device number to be programmed. Press 00 + � to exit Menu Mode. Press "99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. L� � Device Address 00 is always set as an alpha keypad assigned to Partition 1 with �,// no sounder suppression options. �� Relay Voice Descriptors If using the 4285 VIP Module, voice descriptors can be programmed for each of the 16 relays/Powerline Carrier devices used in the system. These descriptors will be announced by the voice module when accessing the relays via the # 70 relay access mode via telephone. Each voice descriptor can consist of up to 3 words selected from the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list(found later in this section). L�� The index numbers from this vocabulary list are to be used for relay voice descriptors only. For normal system voice annunciation (eg. alarms, troubles, status), use the highlighted words in the alpha vocabulary list found in the alpha ro rammin section. To enter relay voice descriptors, do the following: 1. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 2. Press 0 (NO)to each menu option until the "RLY VOICE DESCR?" prompt is displayed. Follow the instructions below. While in this mode, press � to advance to next screen. Press � to backup to previous screen. �RLY VOICE DESCR? 0 Press 1 to program voice descriptors for relays. �0=no 1=yes ENTER RELAY NO. Enter the 2-digit relay/X-10 module number(01-16)for 00=QUIT 01 , the relay desired, or enter 00 to quit relay voice descriptor programming mode. Press �. —119 — From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter �01 ENTERDESC d1 � the 3-digit index number for the first word of the relay � � descriptor phrase. Press u to accept entry. 01 ENTERDESC d2 From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter � the 3-digit index number for the second word of the � relay descriptor phrase. If second word is not desired, press 000. Press � to accept entry. I01 ENTERDESC d3 From the relay voice descriptor vocabulary list, enter � � the 3-digit index number for the third word of the � relay descriptor phrase. If third word is not desired, press 000. Press u to accept entry. The ENTER RELAY NO. prompt will appear. Enter the next relay number to be programmed. When all output devices have been programmed, enter 00 to quit. Enter*99 to exit program mode. Enter the [Installer Code] + OFF to cancel the system's settling delay. Relay Voice Descriptors and Custom Word Substitutes Vocabulary Word Index Word Index Word Index Word Index Word Index Air..................... 116 Daughter's........208 Garage............. 023 Off ....................011 South................ 155 Alarm................255 Den ...................052 Gas.................. 138 Office................ 147 Stairs................006 And ...................067 Detector............128 Glass ............... 139 On ....................058 Station .............. 156 Apartment.........117 Device ..............060 One ..................070 Storage.............157 Appliances ....... 161 Dim ...................163 Hall................... 050 Open ................ 148 Sun................... 154 Area..................118 Dining ...............031 Heat................. 010 Outside.............210 System .............062 Attic ..................119 Door .................016 Down ................008 Inside ............... 209 Panic................013 Temperature..... 158 Baby................. 120 Downstairs........184 Partition ............090 Third .................159 Back................. 121 Driveway...........130 Kitchen............. 022 Patio................. 149 Three................072 Bar ................... 122 Duct..................131 Phone............... 061 Tool ..................213 Basement.........021 Laundry............ 140 Power............... 063 Two ..................071 Bathroom..........051 East..................132 Left................... 027 Pump................ 166 Battery..............053 Eight .................077 Library.............. 141 Up.....................025 Bed ...................092 Eighth ...............221 Light................. 019 Rear ................088 Upper................ 187 Bedroom ..........015 Equipment ........133 Living ............... 030 Right.................028 Upstairs ............183 Blower .............. 123 Exit ...................004 Loading............ 142 Room ............... 018 Utility.................185 Boiler................ 124 Lower............... 094 Bright................ 162 Factory .............134 's ......................007 West .................215 Building ............ 125 Father's ............211 Machine ........... 143 Second .............056 Window ............017 Burglary............039 Fence ...............135 Master.............. 144 Service............. 150 Wing .................216 Fifth...................218 Medical ............ 014 Seven............... 076 Call ...................009 Fire ...................040 Mother's........... 212 Seventh ............220 Zero..................069 Central..............089 First .................136 Motion.............. 145 Shed................. 151 Zone .................002 Chime...............054 Five...................074 Shop................. 152 Closed .............. 126 Floor .................029 Nine ................. 078 Side.................. 153 Computer .........127 Four..................073 Ninth ................ 222 Six ....................075 Console............066 Fourth ...............217 No .................... 165 Sixth .................219 Foyer ................137 North ................ 146 Smoke.............. 024 Front.................087 Not ................... 012 Son's ................223 —120 — Custom Word Substitutes for VIP Module Annunciation A substitute word can be programmed for each of the 20 custom words used in your alpha zone descriptions. This substitute word will be announced by the VIP module in place of the custom word that is displayed on the alpha keypad. For example, an alarm display of "John's Bedroom" could be announced as "Son's Bedroom," since there is no annunciation for the custom word "John." Note that if a substitute word is not assigned, the VIP module will not annunciate the zone descriptor at all, but will only annunciate the zone number. To enter custom words substitutes, do the following: 1. From data field programming mode, press #93 to display the "ZONE PROG?" prompt. 2. Press 0 (NO) to each menu option until the "CUSTOM INDEX ?" prompt is displayed. 6 CUSTOM INDEX? 1 Enter 1 at this prompt. '0=no �s f CUSTOMWC�RDNO. Enter the custom word number (01--20) for which a 00=QUIT I voice substitute is desired. Enter 00 to quit this programming mode. Press � to accept entry. 01 ENTERINDEX# Enter the 3-digit substitute word index number from � the relay voice descriptor and custom word substitutes vocabulary list found in the Relay Voice Descriptors section. Press � to accept entry. The "CUSTOM WORD NO." prompt will be displayed. Enter the next custom word number to be substituted or enter 00 to quit. —121 — • 1 � • ' • This section provides the following information: • Main features of scheduling • Time Window Definitions • Open/Close Schedule Definitions • Programming in the#80 Scheduling menu mode • Programming: Time Windows Open/Close Schedules Holiday Schedules Time Driven Events Access Schedules Introduction To Scheduling This section describes the scheduling features provided with this control panel. U L 1. You must program bypass and auto-arm fail reports (fields 2*13 & 2'`14) for UL installations. •2. Auto-disarming is not for use in UL installations. General • The scheduling features of this control allow certain operations to be automated, such as auto-arming, auto-disarming, auto- bypassing and un-bypassing of zones, and activating relay outputs (using powerline carrier devices or 4204 modules). • The system uses time windows for defining open/close schedules, holiday schedules and user defined temporary schedules. Scheduled events are programmed by user-friendly menu modes of programming (#80, #81 & #83 modes), explained in detail in this section. These menus take you step b ste throu h the o tions. Auto Arming • The system can automatically arm (AWAY mode) itself at the end of a pre-determined closing (arming) time window, if the system has not been armed manually. Auto arming can be delayed three ways: by use of the auto arm delay, the auto arm warning, or by manually extending the closing (arming) time window with a keypad command. The system can also automaticall b ass an o en zones when auto armin . Auto-Arm Delay • Auto-arm delay provides a delay (grace period) before auto arming. It starts at the end of the closing window. The delay is set in 4 minute increments, up to 56 minutes in partition-specific program field 2*05. The expiration of this delay causes the auto-arm warnin to start. Auto-Arm • The auto-arm warning causes the keypad sounder to warn Warning the user of an impending auto-arm. The warning can be set to start 01 to 15 minutes prior to arming in partition-specific program field 2*06. During this period the keypad will beep every 15 seconds and display "AUTO ARM ALERT" ("AA" on non-alpha keypads). The beeps may be silenced by hitting any key on a keypad. When the remaining time drops below 60 seconds, the keypads will begin to beep every 5 seconds. The panel will arm at the conclusion of the auto-arm warning period. —122 — Extend Closing • A user can manually extend the arm (closing)time window Window by 1 or 2 hours. This is done by entering a keypad command (security code + #82), which then prompts the user to enter the desired extension time of 1 or 2 hours (refer to the SYSTEM OPERATION section of the Installation Instructions). This feature is useful if a user must stay on the premises later than usual. Force Arm • The Enable Force Arm option causes the panel to attempt to bypass any faulted zones prior to auto-arming (panel will perform a force-arm). This option is set in partition-specific ro ram field 2*08. Auto Disarming • The system can automatically disarm at the end of a pre- determined time window, if the system has not been disarmed manually. The disarming time can be delayed by using the auto disarm delay feature. In addition, the system can restrict disarmin to a re-determined time. Disarm Delay • Auto-disarm delay provides a delay before Auto disarming. This delay is added to the end of the disarm window. The delay is set in 4 minute increments, up to 56 minutes, in partition-specific ro ram field 2*07. Restrict • This option, set in partition-specific field 2*10, allows Disarming disarming by operator level users only during the disarm time window, the arming window (in case user needs to reenter remises after armin , or when the s stem is in alarm. Exception Reports • This option allows a means of reporting openings and closings by exception (sent only if event occurs outside of the predetermined opening/closing time windows). • The system sends early opening/closing reports if done earlier than the corresponding window • The system sends late opening/closing reports if done later than the corresponding window • The system sends missed open/close reports if no o enin /closin occurs b the end of the corres ondin window. Time Driven • By using time windows, the system can automatically Events activate and de-activate relays and/or power line carrier (X-10) devices at pre-detemined times to turn lights or other devices on and off.: • The system can perform the same actions on a daily basis, or can be made to perform an action only once (i.e., turn on the porch light this Wednesday at 8:OOpm). • The system also provides up to 20 "timers" available to the end user for the purpose of activating output devices at preset times and on reset da s. Limitation of • A user's access can be limited to a certain time period, during Access By Time which he can perform system functions. Outside this time, that user's code will be inactive. The system provides up to 8 Access Schedules, each consisting of two Time Windows (one for opening, one for closing)for each day of the week and two time windows for holidays. The access schedules are programmed via #80 Menu Mode, and enabled for a given user when that user is added to the system. If a user tries to operate the system outside of the schedule, the alpha keypad will display "Access Denied." —123— Time Windows Definitions Time Windows • Scheduled events are based on time windows, which are simply periods of time during which an event may take place. Time windows are defined by a start time and stop time. The system supports up to 20 Time Windows. The windows are shared by the 8 partitions, and the windows are used for open/close schedules as well as for time driven event control. Example • To understand time windows and scheduling, take for example a store that has the following hours: Monday to Thursday: 9am to 6pm Friday 9am to 9pm Saturday 10am to 4pm Sunday Closed Holidays Closed Assume the owner desires the following time windows to allow time for employees to arm or disarm the system: Monday to Thursday: Open (disarm) 8am to 9am Close (arm) 6pm to 6:30pm Friday Open (disarm) 8am to 9am Close (arm) 9pm to 9:30pm Saturday Open (disarm) 9am to 10am Close (arm) 4pm to 4:30pm Sunday& Holidays Closed • To provide these schedules, the following five time windows need to be programmed: Window Start Sto Pur ose 1 8am 9am Monday-Friday open window 2 9am 10am Saturday open window 3 4pm 4:30pm Saturday close window 4 6pm 6:30pm Monday-Thurs. close window 5 9pm 9:30pm Friday close window • Using the #80 Menu Mode (described in a later section), the installer can program open/close schedules by assigning each time window to a day of the week (windows are entered as 2- digit entries): Mon Tue Wed Thu Fri Sat Sun Hol O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I O p/C I 01/04 01/04 01/04 01/04 01/05 02/03 00/00 00/00 Note: 00 is entered for those days on which the store is closed. When programmed, employees can arm and disarm the system within the open and close time windows respectively without causing a report to be sent to the central station (reporting by exception). At the end of these windows, the system can be programmed to automatically arm/disarm if an employee fails to arm/disarm manually (auto arm/auto disarm). Time driven events can be activated at different times using a window as follows: • At the beginning of a time window • At the end of a time window • During a time window active period only (on at beginning of window, off at end) • At both the beginning and end of the time window (Ex: to sound a buzzer at the beginning and end of a coffee break) —124 — Open/Close Schedule Definitions General • The Open/Close scheduling is controlled by one of three individual schedules. Each schedule consists of one time window for openings and one time window for closings. There are three types of schedules available: Daily, Holiday, and Tem orar . Daily schedule • Each partition can have one daily schedule consisting of one o enin window and one closin window er da . Holiday schedule • A holiday schedule will override the regular daily schedule on selected holidays throughout the year. Temporary • The temporary schedule provides a method for the end user schedule to override the daily and holiday schedules. It consists of one opening window and one closing window for each day of the week. The schedule automatically takes effect for up to one week, after which it is deactivated. This schedule is programmed using the #81 Temporary Schedule Menu Mode. Refer to that section for procedures. Additional • Additional opening and closing schedules can be programmed Schedules using the time-driven event programming options. For example, a schedule for normal store opening/closing can be programmed with open/close schedules, and another open/close schedule for beginning and ending lunch hour can be programmed using the time driven event schedule programming. Refer to the Time Driven Events paragraph later in this section for detailed information. Open/Close • The system can help reduce communication traffic to the Reports by central station by using the exception reporting feature, set Exception in partition-specific program field 2*09. The Open/Close by exception option suppresses these reports from being sent to central station if an arm or disarm is done within the expected time window. Reports are only sent if the open/close occurs outside the assigned time window. The system keeps a record of all openings/closings in its event log. • In the event an opening occurs immediately following a closing during the closing window (a person who arms the system forgets something and has to reenter), the opening report (although outside of the opening window) will not be sent. (as long as the reentering occurs within the closing window); otherwise a report will be sent). This feature is designed to prevent false alarms to central station. • The following diagram gives an example of how the open/close by exception reporting works. Exam le of O en/Close Exce tion Re ortin �Schedulin 6:01 PM 5:59AM 6AM 9AM 9:01AM 3:59PM 4PM 6PM 6:01 PM 5:59AM "Early opening"reports Opening Window� Auto-disarm delay begins . Closing Window Auto-arm delay begins will be sent if system No reports sent Auto-disarm occurs after delay. No reports sent Auto-arm warning begins. is disarmed before if system disarmed (if auto-disarm is enabled) if system armed* Auto-arm occurs after opening window begins. during this time during this time warning expires. window. "Missed opening" reports will window. (if auto arm is enabled) be sent if user disarming has not �or disarmed if occurred at expiration of user reenters "Missed closing"reports opening window. premises. will be sent if user arming has not "Late opening"reports will be occurred at expiration sent if disarm occurs after of closing window. the opening window expires "Late closing"reports "Early closing"reports will be will be sent if system sent if user arming occurs is armed after the before the closing window closing window begins. expires. —125— Programming with #80 Scheduling Menu Mode The#80 Scheduling Menu Mode is used to program most of the scheduling and timed event options. To enter this mode, the system must first be in normal operating mode. Enter [Installer Code] +# + 80. The following can be programmed while in this mode: • Define time windows •Assign open/close schedules to each partition •Assign holiday schedules • Program time-driven events (for system functions and relay activation) •Assign access control schedules Some scheduling features are programmed in data field programming mode (installer code +800). The general programming mode scheduling fields are listed below. System Wide Fields: 1*74-1*75 Relay timeout values 2*01-2*02 Daylight savings time options 2*11 Allow Disarming outside window if alarm occurs 2*13-2*14 Scheduling related report codes Partition specific fields: 1*76 Access control relay for this partition 2*05 Auto-arm delay value 2*06 Auto-arm warning time 2*07 Auto-disarm delay value 2*08 Force arm enable 2*09 Open/close reporting by exception 2*10 Restrict disarm only during windows Event driven relay activation options are programmed using the #93 Menu Mode, Relay Programming. These actions are in response to a programmed action. However, relay activation can also be time driven, and thus be used to initiate a desired action. Time driven relay activation options are programmed using the #80 Scheduling Menu Mode. Refer to the Time Driven Event Programming section for procedures. Steps To Programming Scheduling Options To use#80 Scheduling Menu Mode, do the following: Using the worksheets: Define time windows (up to 20) Define the daily open/close schedules (one schedule per day, per partition) Define the holidays to be used by the system (up to 16) Define the holiday schedules (up to 8, one per partition) Define temporary schedules Define limitation of access times (up to 8 schedules) Define the time driven events (up to 20) Using#80 Scheduling Menu Mode: Program the time windows Program the open/close schedules Program the time driven events Program the access schedules —126 — Basic Scheduling Menu Structure To program schedules, enter Scheduling program mode: [Installer Code] +# + 80. There are 5 sets of scheduling menus as shown below. Entering "1" at a displayed main menu prompt will select that menu set. Prompts for programming that scheduling feature will then appear. Enter "0" to skip a menu screen and display the next menu option. Time Window ? Upon entering Schedule Menu Mode, this prompt will �1 Yes 0 = No 0 � appear. Enter 1 to program time windows. Refer to the � Programming Time Windows section for detailed procedures. Enter 0 to move to the Open/Close Schedules prompt. I O/C Schedules ? � Enter 1 to program opening and closing schedules. �1 Yes 0 = No 0 � Refer to the Programming Open/Close Schedules section for detailed procedures. Enter 0 to move to the Holidays prompt. I Holidays ? ,� Enter 1 to program holiday schedules. Refer to the �1 Yes 0 = No 0 � Holiday Programming section for detailed procedures. � Enter 0 to move to the Timed Events prompt. Timed Events ? Enter 1 to program timed events for relay outputs, power 1 Yes 0 = No 0 V line carrier devices, additional schedules or other system � functions. Refer to the Programming Timed Events section for detailed procedures. Enter 0 to move to the Access Schedule prompt. Access Sched. ? � Enter 1 to program access schedules. Refer to the 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � Programming Access Schedules section for detailed � procedures. Enter 0 to move to the "Quit?" prompt. Quit ? � Enter 1 to quit#80 Scheduling Menu Mode and return to 1 Yes 0 = No 0 normal operating mode. Enter 0 to make any changes or review the scheduling programming options. If 0 is pressed, the TIME WINDOW menus are displayed. —127 — Time Windows Definitions Worksheet The system provides 20 time windows that are defined with start and stop times. These windows are used for various open/close and access schedules, as well as for output controls, and are the basis of the scheduling system. These windows are shared among all 8 partitions. The following worksheets will help you define time windows and scheduling aspects of this system before programming the time window definitions for this installation. Note that time windows can span midnight. Time Window Start Time Stop Time Number HH:MM HH:MM 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 (Keep this worksheet handy, as you will be asked for a given time window number later in this section) Time windows are defined by a start and a stop time using the Time Windows programming menu. —128 — Programming Time Windows Enter Scheduling Mode by entering the installer code + # + 80. The keypad will display the Time Window programming prompt. �Time Window ? � Enter 1 at this main menu prompt to program time I 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � windows. [Time Window#? Enter the 2-digit time window number to be programmed. 01-20, 00 = Quit 01 Press *to accept the entry. Enter 00 then * at the "TIME WINDOW#" prompt to quit Time Window programming and display the Quit? prompt. Enter 0 at the Quit? prompt to �Quit? � return to the main menu choices �1 =YES 0 = NO 0 � and continue programming. Enter 1 to quit Scheduling Menu Mode. I 01 TIME WINDOW � If a time window number was entered, the cursor will be �OO:OOAM OO:OOAM � positioned on the tens of hours digit of the start of window entry. Enter the desired start of window hour and press*. The cursor moves to the minutes. Enter the desired minutes and press*. Toggle the AM/PM indication by pressing any key 0-9 while the cursor is under the letter A/P position. Repeat for the end of window time entry . When the entry is completed, the "TIME WINDOW#" prompt is displayed again. Enter the next time window number to be programmed and repeat the procedure. When all time windows have been programmed, enter 00 at the TIME WINDOW # prompt to quit Time Window menus. Since the time windows are shared among all partitions, it is important to make L�� sure that changing a time window does not adversely affect desired actions in other artitions. Daily Open/Close Worksheet Write in the o en &close time window numbers for each artition. Part Monday Tuesday ednesday hursday Friday Saturday Sunday Holiday Op CI Op CI Op CI Op CI Op CI Op CI Op CI Op CI 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 —129 — Programming Open/Close Schedules Each partition can be assigned one daily open/close schedule, plus a holiday open/close schedule. Temporary schedules are programmed separately, using the #81 Temporary Schedule Menu Mode. To program additional open/close schedules, see the Time Driven Events section. After entering Scheduling Menu Mode, press 0 until the O/C Schedules prompt appears. `O/C Schedules ? , Enter 1 to program opening and closing schedules. 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � I Partition#? � Enter the appropriate partition number to which the 01-08, 00 = Quit 01 I following open/close schedules will apply. Enter 00 then * at the "PARTITION #" prompt to quit O/C Schedules programming and display the Quit? prompt. Enter 0 at the Quit? prompt to Quit? return to the main menu choices �1 =YES 0 = NO 0 and continue programming. Enter 1 to quit Scheduling Menu Mode. �Mon P1 OP WIND.? ,� For each day in which an opening or closing schedule is 00:00 00:00 00 � desired, beginning with Monday, enter a time window number(01-20)for the displayed day's opening schedule. Enter 00 if no schedule is desired for a particular day. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for that window will be displayed as a programming aid. Press the * key to accept the entry. I Mon P1 CL WIND.? � Enter the time window number for the displayed day's �00:00 00:00 00 J closing schedule. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press the " key to accept the entry. Tue P1 OP WIND.?� The keypad will now prompt for Tuesday's open/close �00:00 00:00 00 J schedule, etc. Follow the procedure for Mondays prompts. When the last day of the week has been programmed, the holiday opening and closing window prompts are displayed. Hol P1 OP WIND.? Enter the holiday opening time window number. Press 00:00 00:00 00 , the* key to accept the entry. Hol P1 CL WIND.? � Enter the holiday closing time window number. Press the �00:00 00:00 00_ � * key to accept the entry. When the entries are completed, the PARTITION # prompt is displayed again. Repeat this procedure for each partition in the system. When all partitions have been programmed, enter 00 at the PARTITION # prompt to quit open/close schedules. —130 — Holiday Definitions &Schedule Worksheet The system provides up to 16 holidays that can be assigned for the system. Each holiday can be assigned to any combination of partitions. List the desired holidays on the following worksheet. Check the partitions for which these holida s a I . Hol. Partition Mon/Day 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 / 9 / 10 / 11 / 12 / 13 / 14 / 15 / 16 / Programming Holiday Schedules Up to 16 holidays can be defined for the system. After entering Scheduling Menu Mode, press 0 until the Holidays ? prompt appears. Holidays ? � Enter 1 to program holiday schedules. 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � �HOLIDAY NUMBER? � Enter the 2-digit holiday number to be programmed and �01-16, 00=Quit 01 J press*to accept entry. Enter 00 then * at the Holiday Number prompt to quit the Holiday menus and display the Quit? prompt. Enter 0 at the Quit . prompt to Quit . � � return to the main menu choices �1 =YES 0 = NO 0 and continue programming. Enter 1 to quit Scheduling Menu Mode. I01 ENTER DATE � The cursor will be positioned on the tens of months digit. � 00/00 � Enter the appropriate month, then press * to proceed to the day field. Enter the appropriate day for the holiday and press*to accept the entry. Part? 12345678 Holidays can be set for any partition as follows. Press 0 � Hit 0-8 x x Q to turn all partitions on or off, or else use keys 1-8 to toggle the letter x under the partition to which this holiday will apply. Press the * key when all desired partitions have been assigned. The Holiday Number prompt will be displayed again. Repeat the procedure for each holiday to be programmed. When all holidays have been programmed, enter 00 at the HOLIDAY NUMBER prompt to quit the holiday menus. —131 — Time-Driven Event Worksheet These are the schedules used to activate outputs, bypass zones, etc. based on a time schedule. There are 20 of these events that may be programmed for the system, with each event governed by the previously defined time windows. The actions that can be programmed to automatically activate at set times are relay commands, arm/disarm and zone bypassing commands, and open/close access conditions. To fill out the worksheet: 1) First enter the schedule number (01-20) and time window number (01- 20), and note the day of the week the action is desired. 2) Enter the code for the desired action and action specifier. The action codes are the events that are to take place when the scheduled time is reached. Each action also requires an action specifier, which defines what the action will affect (relay, relay group, partition, zone list, user group). The action specifier varies, depending on the type of action selected. The following is a list of the "Action" codes (desired actions) used when programming time driven events. Note that these codes are independent of the "relay codes" programmed during the #93 Menu Mode—Relay Programming mode. Relay commands Action Code Action Specifier 01 Relay On Relay# 02 Relay Off Relay# 03 Relay Pulse Relay# 04 Relay Pulse XX minutes (set in field 1*74) Relay# 05 Relay Pulse YY seconds (set in field 1*75) Relay# 06 Relay Group On Relay Group# 07 Relay Group Off Relay Group# 08 Relay Group Pulse Relay Group# 09 Relay Group Pulse XX minutes (set in field 1*74) Relay Group# 10 Relay Group Pulse YY seconds (set in field 1*75) Relay Group# Arm/Disarm commands Activation times 1 (Beginning), 2 (End), 3 (During) are the only valid choices for automatic arming and disarming functions. "During" can be used to arm or disarm the control for specific time only. For example, if"during" is selected with arm-stay, the system will arm-stay at the beginning of the window and disarm at the end of the window. Action Code Action Specifier 20 Arm-Stay Partition(s) 21 Arm Away Partition(s) 22 Disarm Partition(s) 23 Force Arm Stay (Auto-bypass faulted zns) Partition(s) 24 Force Arm Away (Auto-bypass faulted zns) Partition(s) The auto-arm warning and auto-arm/disarm delay times (fields 2*05 - 2*07) ��� aPp�Y� Bypass commands Activation times 1 (Beginning), 2 (End), 3 (During) are the only valid choices for bypass commands. If 3 (During) is selected for auto-bypassing, the system will bypass the zone(s) specified on a particular Zone List at the beginning of the window and unbypass the zone(s) at the end of the window. If it is selected for auto unbypassing, the system will remove the bypass of the zone(s) at the beginning of the window and will restore the bypass of the zone(s)at the end of the window. —132 — Action Code Action Specifier 30 Auto bypass-Zone list Zone list# 31 Auto unbypass-Zone list Zone list# Open/Close Windows Activation time 3 (During) is the only valid choice for these commands. Action Code Action Specifier 40 Enable Opening Window by partition Partition(s) 41 Enable Closing Window by partition Partition(s) 42 Enable Access Window for Access group Access Group 3) Enter the desired Activation time, which refers to when the action is to take place relative to the time window. Select from: Activation Time Descri tion 1 Be innin of time window 2 End of time window 3 During time window active period only (On at beginning of window, off at end). This can be used in conjunction with the arm, disarm or bypass commands to control a part of the system during the window. For example, if bypass is selected to activate during the window, the zones in the zone list will be bypassed at the beginning of the window and unbypassed at the end of the window. 4 Beginning and end of time window (ex. -Coffee break buzzer). In this example, if relay pulse was selected, the relay would pulse for 2 seconds at the beginning of the window, signaling the beginning of the coffee break. At the end of the window it would ulse a ain, si nalin the end of coffee break. Time Driven Events Worksheet Sched. Time Da (s) Action Action Activation Num. Window M T W T F S S H Desired S ecifier Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 —133 — Time-Driven Event Programming The following schedules can be used to activate outputs, bypass zones, arm/disarm the system, etc. based on a time schedule. Up to 20 events can be programmed for the system. Time windows must first be defined in order to be used to trigger events. If using Time Driven Events to control relays and/or Powerline Carrier devices, the following menu items must first be programmed using #93 Menu Mode - Relay Programming: • Enter Relay No. (reference identification number) • Relay Group (if applicable) • Restriction • Relay Type (4204 or X-10) • House code and �Unit code if X-10 devices • ECP address and specific Relay No. if 4204 relays After entering Scheduling Menu Mode, press 0 until the Timed Events ? prompt appears. 'Timed Events ? � Enter 1 to program timed events using relay outputs or 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � X-10 devices. �TIMED EVENT #? � Enter the timed event number to be programmed (01-20) �01-20, 00=Quit 01 � and press the � key. The system will then prompt the user to enter the desired action to be taken. Enter 00 at the TIMED EVENT prompt to quit the timed event menus and display the Quit? prompt. Enter 0 at the Quit? prompt to �Quit? �� return to the main menu choices 1 =YES 0 = NO 0 and continue programming. Enter 1 to quit Scheduling Menu Mode. �01 ACTION ? � Enter the action code for the desired action for this event �none 00 u number from the list at the left. This could be an output command, an arming command, or any other time-driven event. Press � to accept the entry and display the appropriate action specifier prompt as follows on the next page. Action Codes: 01=relayon Actions 01-05 01 RELAY#? 02=Relay Off 03=Relay Pulse Enter the relay number and press � 00 � 04=Relay Pulse XX minutes 05=Relay Pulse YY seconds � to accept entry. The Time Window? prompt appears. 06=Relay Group On Actions 06-10 01 RELAY GRP#? � 07=Relay Group Off 08=Relay Group Pulse Enter the relay group number and 00 09=Relay Group Pulse XX minutes 10=Relay Group Pulse YY seconds press � to accept entry. The Time Window ? prompt appears. 20=Arm-Stay Actions 21-24 and 40-41 �PART? 12345678 ' 21=Arm Away Enter the partition to which the HIT 0-8 X X 22=Disarm 23=Force Arm Stay ° 24=Force Arm Away action applies. Enter 0 to select 40=Enable Open Window by part all partitions. Enter a partition 41=Enable Close Window by part number again to deselect it. Press uto accept entry. The Time Window? prompt appears. —134 — 30=Auto bypass-Zone list Actions 30-31 �01 ZONE LIST? � 31=Auto unbypass-Zone list Enter the zone list number which ENTER 1-8 1 contains the zones to be bypassed or unbypassed. Press � to accept entry. The Time Window ? prompt appears. Action 42 GROUP? 12345678 42=Enable Access Window for Access Enter the group number to which HIT 0-8 X group(s) the time window will apply. Press �* to accept entry. The Time Window ? prompt appears. �01 Time Window? 9 Enter the time window number (01-20) for which this 00:00 00:00 01 timed event is to occur. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press the � to continue. 01 Active time ? Enter the activation code number from 1-4 (listed below). 0 As the number is keyed in, the activation time will be displayed. The choices are: 1: Trigger at the start of the window 2: Trigger at the end of the window 3: Take effect only for the duration of the window 4: Trigger at both the start and the end of the window. Example-coffee break buzzer. Press the u key when the desired choice is showing. Days ? MTWTFSSH 4 The system will then ask for which days the event is Hit 0-8 x x to be activated. Press 0 to toggle all days on or off or else press keys 1-8 to toggle the letter x under the day on or off(Monday = 1, Holiday = H = 8 ). When all entries have been made, the TIMED EVENT # prompt is displayed again. Repeat the procedure for each timed event required by the installation. When all timed events have been programmed, enter 00 at the TIMED EVENT prompt to quit this set of inenus. —135 — Limitation of Access by Time Worksheet Limitation of Access is a means by which a user's access code is limited to working during a certain period of time.. The system provides 8 Access Schedules, each of which consists of two time windows for each day of the week and two time windows for holidays (typically one for an opening time window and the second for a closing time window). If an Access Schedule has been programmed, a user required to follow that schedule would be assigned to an Access Group of the same number(1-8)when that user is added to the system. If no limitations apply, enter 0. Enter the a ro riate time window numbers for each artition. Acc Monday Tuesday Wed. Thursda Friday Saturday Sunday Holiday Sch W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 W1 W2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Access Control Schedules To program Access Schedules, do the following: Enter Scheduling Menu Mode [Installer Code] +#80. After entering Scheduling Menu Mode, press 0 until the Access Sched. ? prompt appears. �Access Sched. ? � Enter 1 to program access schedules. 1 Yes 0 = No 0 � ACCESS SCHED#? � Enter the access control schedule number between 01 01-08, 00 = Quit 01 f and 08. Press *to accept entry. Enter 00 at the Access Sched # prompt to quit the Access control menus and display the Quit? prompt. Enter 0 at the Quit? prompt to �Quit? return to the main menu choices �1 =YES 0 = NO 0 and continue programming. Enter 1 to quit Scheduling Menu Mode. MON A1 Window 1? Enter the first time window number from 01-20 for which 00:00 00:00 00 � this access schedule applies for the displayed day. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press * to continue. C MON A1 Window 2 ?� Enter the second time window number from 01-20 for �00:00 00:00 00 f which this access schedule applies for the displayed day. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press * to continue. TUE A1 Window 1? �� Repeat the procedure for the other days of the week. 00:00 00:00 00 � When the last day of the week has been programmed, the holiday opening and closing windows may be entered. —136 — �Hol A1 Window 1 ? � Enter the first time window number for holidays for which �00:00 00:00 00 � this access schedule applies. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press *to continue. �Hol A1 Window 2? � Enter the second time window number for holidays for ��00:00 00:00 00 � which this access schedule applies. As the number is keyed in, the actual time that has been stored for the window will be displayed. Press *to continue. When all access control schedules have been programmed, enter 00 at the Access Sched #prompt to quit this set of inenus. #81 Temporary Schedule Menu Mode Each partition can be assigned a Temporary Schedule which will override the regular open/close schedule (and the holiday schedule). This schedule takes effect as soon as it is programmed and remains active for up to one week. Partition/Windows Mon Tue Wed Thu Fri Sat Sun 1 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 2 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 3 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 4 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 5 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 6 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 7 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM —137 — Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM 8 Disarm Window Start Time HH:MM Sto Time HH:MM Arm Window Start Time HH:MM Stop Time HH:MM Programming Temporary Schedules Enter[Seecurity Code] + #+ 81 to enter this mode. Note that only users with authority level of manager or higher can program temporary schedules. Temporary schedules only affect the partition from which it is entered. Temporary schedules can also be reused at later dates simply by scrolling (by pressing #) to the DAYS? prompt (described below) and activating the appropriate days. This should be considered when defining daily time windows. �Mon DISARM WIND. ' This prompt asks for the start and end time of disarm IOO:OOAM OO:OOAM (opening) window. Upon entry of this mode, the cursor will be positioned on the tens of hours digit of the start time for Monday's disarm window. Enter the desired hour. Press * to move to the minutes field. The minutes are entered in the same manner. The AM/PM indication is toggled by hitting any key in the 0-9 range while the cursor is under the letter A/P position. Repeat for the stop time entry. Press the * key to move to the arming window for Monday. Press#if no changes are desired. � Mon ARM WINDOW S This prompt asks for the start and end time of arm �OO:OOAM OO:OOAM ' (closing) window. The cursor will be positioned on the tens of hours digit of the start time for the arm window. Enter the desired hour. Press * to move to the minutes field. The minutes are entered in the same manner. The AM/PM indication is toggled by hitting any key in the 0-9 range while the cursor is under the letter A/P position. Repeat for the stop time entry. After the windows for that day have been completed, the system will prompt for disarm and arm time windows for the next day. Press#if no changes are desired. Tue DISARM WIND. � Repeat the procedure described above for all days �OO:OOAM OO:OOAM I of the week. When all of the days have been completed, the system will ask which days are to be activated. —138 — �Days ? MTWTFSS ' This is the prompt that actually activates the j Hit 0-7 x x temporary schedule, and allows the temporary schedule to be customized to a particular week's needs. To select the days which are to be activated, enter 1-7 (Monday = 1). An "X" will appear under that day, indicating the schedule for that day is active. Entering a day's number again will deactivate that day. Pressing 0 will toggle all days on/off. The temporary schedule will only be in effect for the days which have the letter x underneath them. As the week progresses, the selected days are reset to the inactive state. When completed, press * or# to exit the temporary schedule entry mode. #83 User Scheduling Menu Mode The system provides up to 20 "timers" which will be available to the end user for the purpose of controlling output devices (4204 relays or Powerline Carrier devices (e.g., X-10). These timers are analogous to the individual appliance timers that might be purchased at a department store. The output devices themselves are programmed into the system by the installer during #93 Menu Mode—Relay Programming. The end user needs only to know the output device number and its alpha descriptor. The installer may set certain relays to be "restricted" during #93 Menu Mode-Relay Programming. These relays may not be controlled by the end user (prevents end- user from controlling doors, pumps, etc.) To enter this mode, the user enters [Security Code] +#+ 83. Output Timer#? ' Enter the output timer number to be programmed (01-20). 01-20, 00=Quit 01 � Press *to accept entry and move to the next prompt. Enter 00 to quit and return to normal mode. �06 07:OOP 11:45P If that timer number has already been programmed, a PORCH LITE 04 � summary screen will appear. In this example: � 06 =Timer# 04 = Output Device#affected by this timer PORCH LITE = Descriptor for Output Device#4 07:OOPM = Start Time 11:45PM = Stop Time Press*to continue. �06 ENTER OUTPUT# � Enter the desired output number(01-16) �PORCH LITE 04 Q As the number is entered, the descriptor changes to indicate which output device is being affected. Note: 00 entered as the output#deletes the timer(Timer 06 in this example) and displays an output descriptor of "None". Devices are programmed via#93 Menu Mode. �06 ON TIME ? � Enter the ON time in 00:01 - 11:59 format. � 07:00 PM 0 When the display shows the desired time, press the * key to move to the AM/PM field. In this field, any of the keys 0-9 may be used to toggle the AM/PM indication. Enter 00:00 to skip. Note: May use two commands to perform an ON one day and an OFF another day —139 — �06 OFF TIME ? `� Enter the OFF time in 00:01 - 11:59 format. � 11:45 PM � When the display shows the desired time, press the * key to move to the AM/PM field. In this field, any of the keys 0-9 may be used to toggle the AM/PM indication. Enter 00:00 to skip. �06 Days? MTWTFSS � To select the days which are to be activated, enter 1-7 �Hit 0-7 x x i� (Monday = 1). An "X" will appear under that day, indicating the output for that day is active. Entering a day's number again will deactivate that day. Pressing 0 will toggle all days on/off. The outputs will only be in effect for the days which have the letter x underneath them. As the week progresses, the selected days are reset to the inactive state, unless the permanent option is selected (next screen prompt). When completed, press *to continue. 06 Permanent? Selecting "Permanent" means that this schedule will be 0 = N0,1 =YES 0 in effect on a continuous basis. An answer of 0 means means that this schedule will be in effect for one week only. The letter"x" under the day will then be cleared. Press * to accept entry. The system will quit User Scheduling mode and return to normal mode. —140 — • • � • This section provides the following information: • The process of a successful transmission • An explanation of reporting formats for this system • Loading communication defaults • Contact ID report codes A Successful Transmission When a control panel calls the central station receiver, it waits to hear a "handshake" frequency from the receiver to confirm that the receiver is on-line and ready to receive its message. Once the panel hears the handshake it is programmed to listen for, it sends its message. The panel then waits for a "kissoff" frequency from the receiver acknowledging that the message was received and understood. If the handshake frequency is not given or is not understood by the panel, the panel will not send its message. Once the handshake frequency is received and understood by the panel, the panel will send its message. If there is an error in the transmission (the receiver does not receive a "valid" message), the kissoff frequency will not be given by the central station receiver. The panel will make a total of eight attempts to the primary telephone number and eight attempts to the secondary telephone number (if programmed) to get a valid message through. If the panel is not successful after its numerous attempts, the keypad will display "Communication Failure" (Alpha keypad) or "FC" (Fixed-word keypad). Reporting Formats The following chart defines the three sets of(handshake/kissoff)frequencies that the panel supports and the different formats that can be sent for each. FORMAT HANDSHAKE TRANSMITS DATA KISSOFF TRANSMIT TIME Low Speed 1400Hz 1900Hz(10PPS) 1400Hz Under 15 secs. 3+1 (Standard report) 4+1 4+2 Sescoa/Rad 2300Hz 1800Hz(20PPS) 2300Hz Under 10 secs. 3+1 (Standard report) 4+1 4+2 Express 1400-2300Hz DTMF(10 cps) 1400Hz Under 3 secs. 4+2 High Speed 1400-2300Hz DTMF(10 cps) 1400Hz Under 5 secs. Contact ID 1400-2300Hz DTMF(10 cps) 1400Hz Under 3 secs. ADVISORY: Ademco's Contact ID reporting is capable of uniquely reporting all 86 zones of information, as well as openings and closings for all 75 users, to central stations equipped with the Ademco 685 receiver using software level 4.4 or higher. Must be level 4.6 or higher to fully support all new VISTA 50 report codes. 685 software levels below 4.4 cannot support Contact ID reporting. For information regarding updating the 685 receiver, contact the Technical Support group at 1-800-645-7492 (NY) or 1-800-458-9469 (CA). —141 — The following describes each format in greater detail. 3+1 and 4+1 Standard Formats Comprised of a 3- (or 4-) digit subscriber number and a single digit report code (e.g. Alarm, Trouble, Restore, Open, Close, etc). 3+1 and 4+1 Expanded Formats Comprised of a 3- (or 4-) digit subscriber number, and a two-digit re- port code. The first digit is displayed on the first line, followed by a second line where the first digit is repeated 3 (or 4) times and followed by the second digit. This is the "expanded" digit. 4+2 Format Comprised of a 4-digit subscriber number and 2-digit report code. Ademco Contact ID Comprised of a 4-digit subscriber number, 1-digit event qualifier Reporting Format ("new" or"restore"), 3-digit event code, 2-digit Partition No., and 3- digit zone number, user number, or system status number. Ademco High Speed Comprised of 13 digits as follows: A 4-digit account number+ eight channels of zone information (1-8 or duress plus 9-15) + one status channel, which identifies the type of events being reported in the eight zone locations. Report 3+1/4+1 3+1/4+1 4+2 Standard Expanded Low Spd or Express Alarm SSS(S)A SSS(S)A SSSS AZ AAA(A)Z Trouble SSS(S)T SSS(S)T SSSS Tt TTT(T)t Bypass SSS(S)B SSS(S)B SSSS Bb BBB(B)b AC Loss SSS(S)E SSS(S) E SSSS EA� EEE(E)AC Low Batt SSS(S)L SSS(S) L SSSS LL B LLL(L)L B Open SSS(S)O SSS(S)O SSSS OU 000(0)U Close SSS(S)C SSS(S)C SSSS CU CCC(C)U Test SSS(S)G SSS(S)G SSSS Gg GGG(G)g Restore SSS(S)R SSS(S)R SSSS RZ Alarm RRR(R)Z AC Restore SSS(S)RA SSS(S)RA SSSSRA A� Rp�Rp�Rp�(Rp�)A� LoBat Res. SSS(S)R� SSS(S)R� SSSS R�Lg RLRLRL�RL)�B Trouble Res. SSS(S)RT SSS(S)RT SSSS RTt RTRTRT(RT� Bypass Res. SSS(S)R B SSS(S)R B SSSS RBb RBRBRB(R B)b Where: SSS or SSSS= Subscriber ID C= Close Code-1 st Digit A= Alarm Code-1st digit U= User Number(1st&2nd digits) Z= Typically Zone Number'-2nd digit Gg = Test Code(1st&2nd digits) Tt = Trouble Code(1st&2nd digits) R= Restore Code(Alarm)1st&2nd digits Bb = Bypass Code(1st&2nd digits) RTt = Restore Code(Trbl)1st&2nd digits EAC = AC Loss Code(1st&2nd digits) RBb = Restore Code(Byps)1st&2nd digits LLB = Low Battery Code(1st&2nd digits) RAA� = Restore Code(AC)1st&2nd digits O= Open Code-1st Digit R�LB = Restore Code(Bat)1st&2nd digits *Zone numbers for: [*] + [#], or [B] = 99; [3] + [#], or [C] = 96; [1] + [*], or [A] = 95;Duress = 92 —142 — Ademco Contact ID Reporting takes the following format: CCCC QEEE GG ZZZ where: CCCC = Customer(subscriber) ID Q= Event qualifier, where: E = new event , and R = restore EEE = Event code (3 hexadecimal digits) GG = Partition Number(system messages show"00") ZZZ= Zone/contact ID number reporting the alarm, or user number for open/close reports. System status messages (AC Loss, Walk Test, etc.) contain zeroes in the ZZZ location. Ademco High Speed Reporting events by channel: Channels 1 through 8 could have one of the following conditions: 1 = NEW EVENT 2 = OPENING (Status Channel Always = 2)* 3 = RESTORE 4 = CLOSING (Status Channel Always = 4)* 5 = NORMAL, NO EVENT TO REPORT 6 = PREVIOUSLY REPORTED, NOT YET RESTORED * NOTE: Channel 1 will contain the user ID 1-9, A-F if Open/Close reporting is enabled. The status channel might have one of the following conditions: 1 = DURESS (For Duress Plus Channels 9-15 Only) 2 = OPENING 3 = BYPASS (For Channels 1-8 Only) 4 = CLOSING 5 = SUPERVISORY/TROUBLE (For Channels 1-8 Only) 6 = SYSTEM STATUS: • AC LOSS in Channel 1 • LOW BATTERY in Channel 2 • TIME SET in Channel 3 • LOG CLEAR in Channel 3 • LOG 50% FULL in Channel 3 • LOG 90% FULL in Channel 3 • LOG OVERFLOW in Channel 3 • POWER ON RESET in Channel 4 • WALK TEST START, END in Channel 8 7 = NORMAL ALARM STATUS (Channels 1-8 Only) 9 =TEST REPORT A typical high speed report may look as follows: 1234 5115 5555 7 (Acct#1234 with alarms on channels 2 and 3) LIMITATIONS 1. When using Ademco high speed, remember there are only 15 channels available, plus a duress channel. If more than 15 zones are being used, they will have to share channels. 2. With Ademco High Speed reporting, channels 9-15 cannot report troubles or bypasses. Use these channels for zones that will not report these conditions. 3. Only user numbers 1-15 can be uniquely reported with open/close reports in Ademco High Speed. —143 — Loading Communication Defaults To help expedite the installation, the system provides 4 different communication defaults (Low Speed, Ademco Express, Ademco High Speed & Ademco's Contact ID). These defaults automatically program industry-standard code assignments for zones, keypad panics, non-alarm and supervisory conditions, and can be loaded at any time without affecting non-communication program fields. You may load communications defaults at any time. However, it is recommended that the panel be defaulted first (*97) only if no other programming has been done. If other programming has already been done, there is no need to default the panel. To load communication defaults, do the following: Enter program mode [Installer Code] + 8 0 0. Once the Programming mode is entered, first press *94 and then enter one of the following field numbers: TABLE OF DEFAULT PROGRAMMING COMMANDS PRESS TO LOAD THIS DEFAULT PROGRAM SET *80 Low S eed communication defaults *81 Ademco 4 + 2 Ex ress communication defaults *82 Ademco Hi h S eed communication defaults *83 Contact ID communication defaults TABLE OF CONTACT ID EVENT CODES Code Definition Code Definition 110 Fire Alarm 401 O/C By User 121 Duress 403 Power-Up Armed 122 Silent Panic 406 Cancel by User 123 Audible Panic 407 Remote Arm/Disarm(Download) 131 Perimeter Burglary 408 Quick Arm 132 Interior Burglary 409 Keyswitch O/C 133 24 Hour Burglary (zone rype 11,if supported) 411 Call back Requested 134 Entry/Exit Burglary 441 Armed STAY 135 Day/Night Burglary 451 Early open/close 150 24 Hour Auxiliary 452 late open/close 301 AC Loss 453 Fail to open 302 Low System Battery 454 Fail to close 305 System Reset 455 Auto-arm fail 306 Program Tamper 457 Exit Error by User 309 Battery Test Fail 459 Recent Close 332 Poll Loop Short-Trouble 570 Bypass 333 RF Receiver Failure-Trouble 602 Periodic Test 373 Fire Loop Trouble 607 Walk Test Mode 374 Exit Error by Zone 621 Event Log Reset 380 Trouble (global) 622 Event Log 50%Full 381 Loss of Supervision -RF 623 Event Log 90%Full 382 Loss of RPM Supervision 624 Event Log Overflow 383 RPM Sensor Tamper 625 Time/Date Reset 384 RF Transmitter Low Battery 626 Time/date inaccurate 631 Exception schedule change 632 Access schedule change —144 — COMMUNICATION PROGRAMMING GUIDE Field# Low Speed Contact ID High Speed Express '46,'48 Choose transmission No effect No effect No effect speed and frequency "52,"53 Send as either 4+2 No effect No effect No effect orexpanded '79,'80 Enables alarm restores Enables alarm restores Enables alarm restores Enables alarm restores 49 Add checksum digit o e ect dd checksum digit o e ect '81,'82 Define codes and 1st digit enables report 1st digit enables report Define codes and selects 4+1 or 4+2 if it is non-zero if it is non-zero selects 4+1 or 4+2 54, 56,'59, Defines alarm event Enabies reports Assigns reporting chnl Defines alarm event '61,"64,"66, code for ail reports from this code '69,'71,'74, zone. Enables alarm �76 reporting '55,"57,'60 Defines code and No effect No effect Defines code and '62,'65,*67, selects 4+1 or 4+2 selects 4+1 or 4+2 �70,*72,�75,'77 58, 63, 68, na es report an na es report na les report na es report an *73,�78 selects code. Note: Note:Alarm channel selects 1 st digit of.the No restores if must be programmed. 2-digit event code. event not sent. (01-15) NOTE: No restores if event not sent. '50 Sescoa/Radionics; No effect No effect No effect Selects fixed digit time instead of fixed interdigit. ote: ow pee wi not send 3+2 messages.ZonelD digit is suppressed. Loading communication defaults results in the following: Low Speed • Selects low speed, standard format, with no checksum, for both phone (*94*80) numbers. • Assigns the following report codes: 03 for zones 2-47 01 for zones 1 & 48-55 (fire zones) 02 for zones 62,63 (panic trans), &95, 96, 99 (keypad panics) 09 for all alarm restores • Enables all zone type restores. For 4+2 reporting, enter 2nd digits in the "ID" fields of each report code. For "expanded" reporting, enable fields*52 and *53. ADEMCO Express • Selects Ademco express reporting format, with checksum, for both phone (*94*81) numbers. • Report codes for zones 1-86, RF receiver, and keypad panics are sent as their respective zone ID numbers (01-86, 88-91, 95-99), Duress is sent as "DD". Alarm restore is"E" + 2nd digit. • Enables all zone type restores. ADEMCO High Speed • Selects Ademco High Speed format, with no checksum, for both phone (*94*82) numbers. • Reporting is assigned to the following channels: Channel 1 for zones 1 &48-55 (Fire zones) Channel 2 for zones 2-8 Channel 3 for zones 9-16 Channel 4 for zones 17-31 Channel 5 for zones 32-47 (RF interior zones) Channel 6 for zones 56-61 & 87 Channel 9 for zones 62 &63 (panic transmitter) Channel 7 for second RF receiver(88 &89) & polling loop short (97) Channel 8 for first RF receiver(90 &91) Channels 10, 11 & 12 for keypad panics 95, 96 & 99 respectively • Enables all zone type restores. • Enables Duress to be sent. ADEMCO's Contact ID • Selects Contact ID format for both phone numbers. (*94*83) • Reporting is enabled for all zones. • Enables all zone type restores. • Refer to the SYSTEM COMMUNICATION section for event code definitions. -145 - COMMUNICATION DEFAULTS for LOW SPEED FORMAT(*94*80) *45 PRIMARY FORMAT u Ademco�ow Speed �51 DUAL REPORTING u no �46 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Primary) n adem�o�ow *52 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR PRIMARY Speed �I ❑ � ❑ ❑ ❑ *47 SECONDARY FORMAT O� Ademco Low Speed 0 0 0 0 0 0 standard Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat *48 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Sec.) 0� Ademco�ow Speed �53 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR SECONDARY �49 CHECKSUM VERIFICATION � I 0 I �I �❑ �❑ �❑ �❑ �❑ standard No checksum Primary Secondary Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat �50 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT u Radionics ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 1-32&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES �54 CODE '55 ID *56 CODE *57 ID *58 '59 CODE '60 ID '61 CODE '62 ID �63 1 0�1 0�0 9 0�3 0�0 0�9 A�arm Rst. 17j 0�3 0�0 25� 0�3 0�0 0�9 Alarm Rst. 2 0�3 0�0 10 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trouble 18I 0�3 0�0 26 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trouble 3 0�3 0�0 11 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 19 0�3 0�0 27 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 4 0�3 0�0 12 0�3 0�0 0�0 Bypass 20 0�3 0�0 28 0�3 0�0 0�0 Bypass 5 0�3 I 0�0 13 0�3 0�0 0�0 I syPss Rst. 21� 0�3 0�0 29 0�3 0�0 0�0 ByPss Rst. 6 0�3 � 0�0 14 0�3 0�0 22 0�3 0�0 30 0�3 0�0 7 0�3 0�0 15 0�3 0�0 23� 0�3 0�0 31 0�3 0�0 8 0�3 � 0�0 16 0�3� 0�0� 24: 03 0�0 32� 0�3 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 33-64&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES *64 CODE '65 ID �66 CODE '67 ID *68 '69 CODE '70 ID '71 CODE '72 ID *73 33I 0�5 � � 0�0 . 41 I 0�5 � � 0�0 � 0�9� Alarm Rst. 49 0�1 0�0 57 0�6 0�0 0�9 Alarm Rst. 34 0�5 0�0 , 42 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trouble 50 0�1 0�0 58 0�6 0�0 0�0 Trouble 35 0�5 0�0 43 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 51� 0�1 0�0 59 0�6 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 36 0�5 0�0 44 0�5 0�0 0�0 Bypass 521 0�1 0�0 60 0�6 0�0 0�0 Bypass 37 0�5 0�0 45 0�5 0�0 0�0 sypss Rst. 53 0�1 0�0 61 0�6 0�0 0�0 sypss Rst. 38 0�5 0�0 46 0�5 0�0 54� 0�1 0�0 62 0�9 0�0 39 0�5 0�0 � 47 0�5 0�0 55� 0�1 0�0 63 0�9 0�0 40 0�5 0�0 � 48 0�1 0�0 56 0�6 0�0 64 0�6 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 81-87, 65-80, RF RCVRs&PANICS,&THEIR SUPV.&RESTORE CODES 1'35 CODE 1*36 ID 1*37 CODE 1*38 ID 1"39 *74 CODE *75 ID *76 CODE *77 ID *78 65'; 0�3 0�0 73 0�3 0�0 0�9 Alarm Rst. 81 0�3 0�0 89 0�7 0�0 � 0�9 Alarm Rst. 66 0�3 0�0 74 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trouble 82 0�3 0�0 90 0�7 0�0 ; 0�0 Trouble 67' 0�3 0�0 75 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 83 0�3 0�0 91 0�7 0�0 I 0�0 Trble Rst. 68 0�3 0�0 76� 0�3 0�0 0�0 Bypass 84 0�3 0�0 Dures 0�2 0�0 , 0�0 Bypass 69� 0�3 0�0 77I 0�3 0�0 0�0 Byps Rst 85 0�3 0�0 97 0�7 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 70� 0�3 0�0 78� 0�3 0�0 86 0�3 0�0 95 0�2 0�0 � (�+*� 71 0�3 0�0 79 0�3 0�0 87 0�7 0�0 96 0�7 0�0 �3+#) 72, 0�3 0�0 80 0�3 0�0 88 0�7 0�0 � 99 0�7 0�0 ; (* +#) SYSTEM NON ALARM CODES NOTES:97=Poll Loop Short;88&90=RCVR not receiving �81 First Digit �82 SeCOnd Digit transmitter signals.89&91 =RCVR not responding,bad conn.to Close 0�0 0�0 Second digit of each panel. Open 0�0 0�0 code applies only to 4+2 ZONE TYPE RESTORE ENABLES Low Battery 0�0 0�0 or expanded tormats '79 ZONE TYPES 1-8 All enabled Low Bat Res. 0�0 0�0 (fields�52&�53) �� � I 12I �1 sl �a�s❑ s� �� s AC Loss 0�0 0�0 �80 ZONE TYPES 9&10 1� 1� AC Restore 0�0 0�0 All enabled 9 10 Test 0�0 0�0 Power 0�0 0�0 Cancel 0�0 0�0 Prog.Tamper I 0�0 0�0 -146 - COMMUNICATION DEFAULTS for ADEMCO EXPRESS FORMAT(*94*81) �45 PRIMARY FORMAT I 3� Ademco Express *51 DUAL REPORTING �] no ''46 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Primary) 0� '52 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR PRIMARY *47 SECONDARY FORMAT 3� Ademco Express � 0� 0� 0� 0� 0� standard �48 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Sec.) u Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls �ow eat '53 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR SECONDARY *49 CHECKSUM VERIFICATION 0� 0� p� � u u u u standard No checksum Primary Secondary Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat *50 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT On Radionics ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 1-32&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES 'S4 CODE 'S5 ID *56 CODE '57 ID "58 *59 CODE `60 ID *61 CODE '62 ID *63 1 � 1�0 , � 0�1 9 1�0� 0�9� 1�4 Alarm Rst. 17��1 0�7 25 0�2 0�5 1�4 Alarm Rst. 2 1�0 0�2 10 0�1 1�0 0�0 Trouble 18 0�1 0�8 26 0�2 0�6 0�0 Trouble 3 1�0 I 0�3 11 0�1 0�1 0�0 Trble Rst. 19 0�1 0�9 27 0�2 0�7 0�0 Trble Rst. 4 1�0 � 0�4 12 0�1 0�2 0�0 Bypass 20I 0�2 1�0 28 0�2 0�8 0�0 Bypass 5 1�0 0�5 13 0�1 0�3 0�0 aypss Rst. 21 0�2 0�1 29 0�2 0�9 0�0 Bypss Rst. 6 1�0 0�6 14 0�1 0�4 22 0�2 0�2 30 0�3 1�0 7 1�0 0�7 15 0�1 0�5 23;� 0�2 0�3 31 0�3 0�1 8 1�0 , 0�8 16 0�1 0�6 24� 0�2 0�4 32 0�3 0�2 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 33-64&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES *64 CODE *65 ID *66 CODE *67 ID *68 *69 CODE *70 ID *71 CODE *72 ID *73 33 0�3 0�3 41 0�4 0�1 . 1�4 Alarm Rst. 49 0�4 0�0 57 0�5 0�0 1�4 Alarm Rst. 34 0�3 0�4 42 0�4 0�2 , 0�0 Trouble 50 0�5 0�0 58r 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trouble 35 0�3 0�5 43 0�4 0�3 0�0 Trble Rst. 51 I 0�5 0�0 59� 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 36 0�3 0�6 44 0�4 0�4 0�0 Bypass 52 0�5 0�0 60 0�6 0�0 0�0 Bypass 37 0�3 0�7 45 0�4 0�5 0�0 aypss Rst. 53 0�5 0�0 61 0�6 0�0 0�0 sypss Rst. 38 0�3 0�8 46 0�4 0�6 . 54� 0�5 0�0 62 0�6 0�0 39 0�3 0�9 47 0�4 0�7 ; 55 0�5 0�0 63 0�6 0�0 40I 0�3 I I 1�0 I 48 0�4 � 0�8 I 56. 0�5 0�0 64 0�6 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 81-87,65-80, RF RCVRs&PANICS,&THEIR SUPV.&RESTORE CODES 1*35 CODE 1*36 ID 1*37 CODE 1*38 ID 1*39 *74 CODE *75 ID *76 CODE '77 ID *78 65 0�6 0�5 73 0�7 0�3 1�4 Alarm Rst. 81 0�8 0�1 89 0�8 0�9 1�4 Alarm Rst. 66 0�6 0�6 74 0�7 0�4 0�0 Trouble 82 0�8 0�2 90 0�9 1�0 0�0 Trouble 67 0�6 0�7 75 0�7 0�5 0�0 Trble Rst. 83 0�8 0�3 91 0�9 0�1 0�0 Trble Rst. 68� 0�6 0�8 76 0�7 0�6 0�0 Bypass 84 0�8 0�4 Dures 1�3 1�3 0�0 Bypass 69 0�6 0�9 77 0�7 0�7 0�0 Byps Rst 85 0�8 0�5 97 0�9 0�7 � 0�0 Bypss Rst. 7O 0�7 1�0 78 0�7 0�8 86 0�8 0�6 95 0�9 0�5 I. (1+*) 71 0�7 0�1 79� 0�7 0�9 87 0�8 0�7 96 0�9 0�6 . (3+#) 72 0�7 0�2 80 0�8 1�0 88 0�8 0�8 99 0�9 0�9 . (� +#) SYSTEM NON ALARM CODES � NOTES:97=Poll Loop Short;88&90=RCVR not receiving '`81 First Digit *82 Second Digit transmitter signals.89&91 =RCVR not responding, bad conn.to Close 0�0 0�0 Second digit of each panel. Open 0�0 0�0 code applies only to 4+2 ZONE TYPE RESTORE ENABLES Low 68ttery 0�0 0�0 or expanded formats *79 ZONE TYPES 1-8 All enabled Low Bat Res. 0�0 0�0 (fields•52&•53) � � � � � � � � AC Loss 0�0 0�0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 '80 ZONE TYPES 9&10 n � AC Restore 0�0 0�0 All enabled 9 10 Test 0�0 0�0 Power 0�0 0�0 Cancel o�o o�o Prog.Tamper 0�0 0�0 -147 - COMMUNICATION DEFAULTS for ADEMCO HIGH SPEED FORMAT(*94*82) �45 PRIMARY FORMAT I 2� Ademco High Speed *51 DUAL REPORTING �] no ''46 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Primary) 0� '52 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR PRIMARY *47 SECONDARY FORMAT 2� Ademco High Speed � 0� 0� 0� 0� 0� standard �48 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Sec.) u Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls �ow eat '53 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR SECONDARY *49 CHECKSUM VERIFICATION 0� 0� p� � u u u u standard No checksum Primary Secondary Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat *50 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT On Radionics ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 1-32&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES 'S4 CODE 'S5 ID *56 CODE '57 ID "58 *59 CODE `60 ID *61 CODE �62 ID *63 1 � 0�1 , � 0�0 9 0�3� 0�0� 0�1 Alarm Rst. 17��4 0�0 25 0�4 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 2 0�2 0�0 10 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trouble 18 0�4 0�0 26 0�4 0�0 0�0 Trouble 3 0�2 0�0 11 0�3 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 19 0�4 0�0 27 0�4 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 4 0�2 0�0 12 0�3 0�0 0�0 Bypass 20 0�4 0�0 28 0�4 0�0 0�0 Bypass 5 0�2 0�0 13 0�3 0�0 0�0 aypss Rst. 21 0�4 0�0 29 0�4 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 6 0�2 0�0 14 0�3 0�0 22 0�4 0�0 30 0�4 0�0 7 0�2 0�0 15 0�3 0�0 23;� 0�4 0�0 31 0�4 0�0 8 0�2 , 0�0 16 0�3 0�0 24� 0�4 0�0 32 0�5 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 33-64&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES *64 CODE *65 ID *66 CODE *67 ID *68 *69 CODE *70 ID *71 CODE *72 ID *73 33 0�5 0�0 41 0�5 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 49 0�1 0�0 57 0�6 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 34 0�5 0�0 42 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trouble 50 0�1 0�0 58 0�6 0�0 0�0 Trouble 35 0�5 0�0 43 0�5 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 51 I 0�1 0�0 59, 0�6 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 36 0�5 0�0 44 0�5 0�0 0�0 Bypass 52 0�1 0�0 60 0�6 0�0 0�0 Bypass 37 0�5 0�0 45 0�5 0�0 0�0 aypss Rst. 53 0�1 0�0 61 0�6 0�0 0�0 sypss Rst. 38 0�5 0�0 46 0�5 0�0 . 54� 0�1 0�0 62 0�9 0�0 39 0�5 0�0 47 0�5 0�0 ; 55 0�1 0�0 63 0�9 0�0 40I 0�5 I I 0�0 I 48 0�1 � 0�0 I 56. 0�6 0�0 64 0�6 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 81-87,65-80, RF RCVRs&PANICS,&THEIR SUPV.&RESTORE CODES 1*35 CODE 1*36 ID 1*37 CODE 1*38 ID 1*39 *74 CODE *75 ID *76 CODE '77 ID *78 65 1�4 0�0 73 1�5 0�0 0�1 AlarmRst. 81 1�3 0�0 89 0�7 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 66 1�4 0�0 74 1�5 0�0 0�0 Trouble 82 1�3 0�0 90 0�8 0�0 0�0 Trouble 67 1�4 0�0 75 1�5 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 83 1�3 0�0 91 0�8 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 68� 1�4 0�0 76 1�5 0�0 0�0 Bypass 84 1�3 0�0 Dures 0�1 0�0 0�0 Bypass 69 1�4 0�0 77 1�5 0�0 0�0 Byps Rst 85 1�3 0�0 97 0�7 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 70 1�4 0�0 78 1�5 0�0 86 1�3 0�0 95 1�0 0�0 (1+ .� 71� 1�4 0�0 79� 1�5 0�0 87 0�7 0�0 96 1�1 0�0 , (3+#) 72 1�4 0�0 80 1�5 0�0 88 0�7 0�0 99 1�2 0�0 . (� +#) SYSTEM NON ALARM CODES � NOTES:97=Poll Loop Short;88&90=RCVR not receiving '`81 First Digit *82 Second Digit transmitter signals.89&91 =RCVR not responding, bad conn.to Close 0�0 0�0 Second digit of each panel. Open 0�0 0�0 code applies only to 4+2 ZONE TYPE RESTORE ENABLES Low 68ttery 0�0 0�0 or expanded formats *79 ZONE TYPES 1-8 All enabled Low Bat Res. 0�0 0�0 (fields•52&•53) � � � � � � � � AC Loss 0�0 0�0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 '80 ZONE TYPES 9&10 n � AC Restore 0�0 0�0 All enabled 9 10 Test 0�0 0�0 Power 0�0 0�0 Cancel o�o o�o Prog.Tamper 0�0 0�0 -148 - COMMUNICATION DEFAULTS for ADEMCO's CONTACT ID FORMAT(*94*83) *45 PRIMARY FORMAT u Ademco Contact ID �51 DUAL REPORTING u no �46 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Primary) On '52 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR PRIMARY *47 SECONDARY FORMAT 1� Ademco Contact ID [I 0� � 0� 0� 0� standard �48 LOW SPEED FORMAT(Sec.) u Aia�m Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat �53 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT FOR SECONDARY �49 CHECKSUM VERIFICATION 0� n No checksum � p� p� p� p� p� standard Primary Secondary Alarm Rstr Bypass Trbl Opn/Cls Low Bat �50 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT �l Radionics ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 1-32&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES �54 CODE '55 ID '56 CODE '57 ID �58 '59 CODE *60 ID '61 CODE '62 ID *63 1 0�1 0�0 9 0�9 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. �7I O�Z l O�O 25 1�0� 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 2 0�2 0�0 10 1�0 0�0 0�0 Trouble 18 0�3 0�0 26 1�1 0�0 0�0 Trouble 3 0�3 0�0 11 1�1 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 19 0�4 0�0 27 1�2 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 4 0�4 0�0 12 1�2 0�0 0�0 Bypass 20 0�5� 0�0 28 1�3� 0�0 0�0 Bypass 5 0�5 � 0�0 13 1�3 0�0 0�0 sypss Rst. 21 0�6 0�0 29 1�4 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 6 0�6 0�0 14 1�4 0�0 22, 0�7 0�0 30 1�5 0�0 7 0�7 0�0 15 1�5 0�0 23� 0�8� 0�0 31 0�1� 0�0 8 0�8 , 0�0 16 0�1 0�0 24 0�9 0�0 32 0�2 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 33-64&SUPERVISORY&RESTORE CODES �64 CODE '65 ID *66 CODE '67 ID "68 '69 CODE *70 ID '71 CODE *72 ID *73 33� 0� � � 0�0 41 I 1�1 I � 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 49; 0�4 0�0 57 1�2 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 34 0� 0�0 42 1�2 0�0 0�0 Trouble 50 0�5 0�0 58� 1�3 0�0 0�0 Trouble 35 0� 0�0 43 1�3 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 51 0�6 0�0 59 1�4 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 36 0� 0�0 44 1�4 0�0 0�0 Bypass 52i 0�7 0�0 60 1�5 0�0 0�0 Bypass 37 0� 0�0 45 1�5 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 53 0�8 0�0 61 i 0�1 0�0 0�0 Bypss Rst. 38 0� 0�0 46 0�1 0�0 54 0�9 0�0 62 0�2 0�0 39 0� 0�0 47 0�2 0�0 55 1�0 0�0 63 0�3 0�0 40 �0 0�0 48 0�3 0�0 56� 1�1 0�0 64� 0�4 0�0 ALARM REPORT CODE&ID DIGITS FOR ZONES 81-87, 65-80, RF RCVRs&PANICS,&THEIR SUPV.& RESTORE CODES 1*35 CODE 1*36 ID 1*37 CODE 1*38 ID 1*39 *74 CODE *75 ID *76 CODE *77 ID *78 65 0�5 0�0 73 1�3 0�0 0�1 P.larm Rst. 81 0�6 0�0 89 1�4 0�0 0�1 Alarm Rst. 66 0�6 0�0 74 1�4 0�0 0�0 Trouble 82 0�7 0�0 90 1�5 0�0 0�0 Trouble 67 0�7 0�0 75 1�5 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. 83 0�8 0�0 91 0�1 0�0 0�0 Trble Rst. F)H� 0�8 0�0 76 0�1 0�0 0�0 Bypass 84 0�9 0�0 Dures 0�2 0�0 0�0 Bypass 69 0�9 0�0 77 0�2 0�0 0�0 Byps Rst 85 1�0 0�0 97 0�3 0�0 , 0�0 I Bypss Rst. 70 1�0 0�0 78 0�3 0�0 86 1�1 0�0 95 0�4 0�0 , (�+�� 71 1�1 0�0 79 0�4 0�0 87 1�2 0�0 96 0�5 0�0 I (3+#) 72 1�2 0�0 80 0�5 0�0 88 1�3 0�0 99 0�6 0�0 (� +#) SYSTEM NON ALARM CODES NOTES:97=Poll Loop Short;88&90=RCVR not receiving �81 First Digit �82 Second Digit transmitter signals.89&91 =RCVR not responding, bad conn.to Close 0�0 0�0 Second digit of each panel. Open 0�0 0�0 code applies only to 4+2 ZONE TYPE RESTORE ENABLES Low Battery 0�0 0�0 or expanded formats �79 ZONE TYPES 1-8 All enabled Low Bat Res. 0�0 0�0 (fields*52&•53) I� �❑ �❑ �❑ �❑ �❑ �I I� AC Loss 0�0 0�0 � 2 3 4 5 6 � $ AC Restore o�0 0�0 �80 ZONE TYPES 9&10 1� 1� Test 0�0 0�0 All enabled 9 10 Power 0�0 0�0 Cancel o�o o�o Prog.Tamper 0�0 0�0 —149— • � � � � � ■ . . (Remote Downloading is not a UL Listed feature) This section provides the following information: • General information about downloading • Getting on-line with a control panel • Advisories • Access security • Connecting the 4100SM module for direct wire downloading General Information Downloading allows the operator to remotely access, program, and control the security system over normal telephone lines. Anything that can be done directly from the keypad can be done remotely, using ADEMCO's VLINK� downloading software. To communicate with the control panel, the following is required: 1. An IBM PC compatible 286, 386, or 486 computer with at least 1 MB RAM, a hard disk with 12MB available disk space, running MS DOS 3.1 or higher operating system. 2. A HAYES 1200 SMARTMODEM (external: level 1.2 or higher; internal: level 1.1 or higher), or a Hayes Optima 24 + Fax 96. Other brands are not compatible, even if claimed to be 100% compatible. L�� Internal modems must have 4 position DIP switch. Modems with 6 position DIP switch will not work. 3. Alternately, you may use a 4100SM interface module to "direct wire" the control panel to your computer at the site (see Figure . 4. V-LINK� DOWNLOADING software, from ADEMCO. This software is available on both 3-1/2" and 5-1/4" diskettes, and includes a complete User's Manual. Getting On-Line with a Control Panel At the protected premises, the Control panel must be connected to the existing telephone line (refer to the PHONE LINE CONNECTIONS section). No programming of the panel is required before downloading to an initial installation. To download, do the following: 1. Enter the installer code + [#] + [5]. The panel temporarily enables a ring count of 5 and sets the Download Callback option to "1" (callback not required). 2. Call the panel using the downloader software set to "FIRST COMMUNICATION" mode. 3. The downloader will establish a session with no callback. The panel information can then be downloaded. In order to remotely access, control, or program the alarm panel, a "link" must be established between the computer and the control panel, as follows: —150 — 1. The computer calls up the Control panel. (The phone number for each customer is entered into the customer's account file on the computer). 2. The Control panel "answers" at the pre-programmed ring count and executes a handshake with the computer. 3. The computer sends a request for call-back to the Control, unless call-back is not required. 4. The panel acknowledges the request and hangs up. During the next few seconds, the Control will process the request making sure certain encrypted information, received from the computer, matches its own memory. 5. Upon a successful match, the Control panel will seize the phone line and call the computer back, unless call-back is not required. 6. The computer answers, usually by the second ring, and executes a handshake with the panel. 7. The panel then sends other default information to the computer. If this information matches the computer's information, a successful link is established. This is known as being "ON-LINE". L� /� 1. Alarm and trouble responses and reports are disabled during on-line time. � Should an event occur during this time, the response will take place and the report will go through as soon as the remote access sequence is completed. Alarm and trouble conditions are not ignored, they are simply delayed. 2. The keypads are inactive during downloading communication, and resume normal functions after hang up. All keypad entries are ignored during on-line time. On-Line Control Functions The following functions can be performed while on-line with a control panel: • Arm the System in the Away Mode; Disarm the System • Bypass a Zone • Force the System to Accept a New Program Download • Shut Down Communication (dialer) Functions (non-payment of monitoring fees in an owned system) • Shut Down all Security System Functions (non-payment for a leased system) • Inhibit Local Keypad Programming (prevents takeover of your accounts) • Leave a message for customer • Command the System to Upload a Copy of its Resident Program to the office • Read: Arming Status, AC Power Status, List of Faulted Zones, List of Bypassed Zones, 224 Event Log, List of Zones Currently in Alarm, List of Zones Currently in Trouble • Set the Real-Time clock. —151 — Access Security Accessing the Control from a remote location is protected against compromise by the use of 4 levels of protection: 1. Security Code Handshake: The subscriber's account number as well as an 8- digit ID number (known only to the office) must be matched between the Control and computer. 2. Hang-Up and Call-Back: The Control panel will "hang-up" and call the computer back at the pre-programmed number only if the security codes match. 3. Data Encryption: All data that is exchanged between the computer and Control is encrypted to reduce the possibility of anyone "tapping" the line and corrupting data. Additionally, all account files are encryped to prevent them from being opened on another installer's VLink� downloading software package. 4. Operator Access Levels: Up to 15 operators can have access to the DOWNLOADER, each having their own log-on code. However, each operator can be assigned one of three levels of access in both FILE and COMMAND functions, as follows: FILE ACCESS: Read Only.• able only to look at the database; cannot change any information, and cannot see the customer's access codes. Part Read/Write: able to look at and change all information. except the customer's access codes. Full Read/Write: able to look at and change any and all information in the database. CONTROL/COMM ACCESS: Read Only: able only to Upload and arm the system. Not able to DISARM, BYPASS, or change any information. Part Read/Write:able to ARM, BYPASS, UPLOAD, DOWNLOAD but cannot shutdown the system. Full Read/Write:able to perform all control and status commands, as well as shutdown all or part of the system. NOTES: 1. Each time the Control panel is accessed successfully, a PROGRAM TAMPER report(*81) is sent to central station, if programmed. 2. When downloading, the keypad displays "MODEM COMM." 3. Whenever a download or a save is done, an automatic time stamp is done, indicating the date and time of the last download (or save) and the operator ID number. 4. The average time for a complete download, including initial call-up, hang-up and call-back is under 4 minutes. 5. A complete hard copy of each individual account can be obtained by connecting a printer to the computer. Refer to your computer owner's manual or contact your dealer for printer recommendations. —152 — Connecting a 4100SM Module for Direct Wire Downloading The Control can be downloaded without using a modem or telephone line by using VLink� Software and a 4100SM Serial Module. The direct wire downloading connection is to be temporary, and is not part of the permanent installation. Direct wire downloading is meant as a tool for the installer during the installation process. L� � The connections between the Control and the 4100SM are different than � those shown in the 4100SM Installation Instructions. See the diagram below for correct connections. In addition, when the "green"wire is referred to in step 2 of the IN CASE OF DIFFICULTY section of the 4100SM Instructions, use the "violet"wire. Connector J8, located above connector J7 on the right hand side of the main PC board (see the Summary of Connections diagram on the inside back cover of this manual), is intended to be interfaced to either a local serial printer (see EVENT LOG PRINTER CONNECTIONS) or a computer. Make connections to a computer as shown below. Note that the violet wire connection for a computer differs from that used when connecting a serial printer. �� �� 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 O O O O O O O O O J8 CONNECTOR NU Z Y W } O W � W U O � J � W � � a > c� i � � m m m � p Z� Z� �n �o �� $� _���Q-�J = �J OJ O Q�J � �� � � � ¢ 4142TR CABLE(SUPPLIED WITH 4100SM) 4100SM SERIAL MODULE To T66 Aux.Power(+) O +pWR (25mA current draw) To TB7 Aux.Power(-) 7 -(GND) 6 RXD 5O not used aO not used 3O TXD 2O not used 1O not used d d d RED BLUE WHITE Figure 30: Direct Wire Downloading Connections —153 — • ' � • This section provides the following information: • General information about the real-time clock • Setting the time and date General Information This system provides a real-time clock, which must be set in order for the system's event log to keep track of events by time and date. It must also be set in order to execute scheduling programs (time-driven events). L��� Use a 5137AD or 6139 alpha keypad to set the real-time clock, or set the clock via the Downloader software. Only users with installer or master authority level can set the real-time clock. Setting the Time and Date 1. Enter installer or master code + #63. Typical display shows I TIME/DATE — THU L 12:01 AM 01/01/90 2. The day of the week is automatically calculated based on the date entered. Time and date entries are made by simply entering the appropriate hour, minute, month, day and year. Press the � key to accept the entered value. The cursor then moves to the right. Press the � key to move the cursor to the left of the display, to the previous position. Enter the correct hour then press � to move to the minutes and make the correct entry. Press � again, then press any key 0-9 to set AM/PM. Press any key again to change AM to PM, or PM to AM. Press � to move cursor to the month position and enter the correct month using a 2-digit entry. Press � and enter the correct date. Press � and enter the correct year. 3. Exit clock mode by pressing the �, key after the cursor is in the year position. –154 – � . - . • � This section provides the following information: • General information about security access codes • Definition of user authority levels • How to add a user access code • How to change a user access code • How to delete a user access code General Information This system allows a total of 75 security access codes to be allocated, each identified by a user ID number. Note that regardless of the number of partitions each code has access to, it occupies only one user slot in the system. If a particular code is not used in all partitions, that user ID number cannot be used again. The Quick Arm feature can also be programmed (partition-specific program field *29), which allows the [#] key to be pressed instead of entering the security code when arming the system. The security code must always be entered to disarm the system. G� �, User#2 must be programmed for the Quick Arm feature to function. � User Codes & Levels Of Authority Each user of the system can be assigned a level of authority (tells system what system functions that user is authorized to do), and can have different levels of authority within different partitions. In general, users can perform most system functions, including Test and Chime modes, but certain authority levels restrict disarming, bypassing or the assigning of other user codes. These restrictions are noted in the descriptions below. Use the "View Capabilities" keypad function to view the partitions and authority levels for which a particular user is authorized. In highest to lowest ranking, these levels are described below. Auth Tltle 0 Installer 1 Master 2 Manager 3 Operator level A 4 Operator level B 5 Operator level C 6 Duress Level 0: Installer(User 1) • Programmed in field *00 (default=4-1-4-0). Installer open/close reporting is selected in field *39. • Can perform all system functions (arm, disarm, bypass, etc.), but cannot disarm if armed by another code (or by Quick Arm). • Can add, delete, or change all other authority level codes, and can select open/close reports for any user. • Is the only code that can enter program mode, but even this can be prevented by exiting program mode using *98. (The only way to access Programming mode if this done is by powering down the system, powering up again, and then pressing both the * and # keys at the same time within 30 seconds of power up.) • Must program at least one master code during initial installation. Master codes are codes intended for use by the primary user(s ) of the system. —155 — Open/Close Reporting Note: When adding a user, the system will only prompt for Open/Close reporting capability if the user is being added by the Installer. When a Master or Manager adds a new user, the new user's Open/Close reporting enable will be the same as that of the Master or Manager adding the user. If Open/Close reports are required to be selectable by the Master or Manager, the Installer should assign two Master or Manager user codes: one with Open/Close reporting enabled, and one without. Note that Open/Close reporting of Quick Arm is enabled if User 2 is enabled for Open/Close reporting, and that Quick Arm reports as User 0. In order for Quick Arm reports to be sent for all partitions, User #02 must have authority and Open/Close enabled for all partitions. If a code with access to all partitions is not desired, it is suggested that user #02 be assigned authority level 5 in all partitions, and that the code be kept secret. Authority level 5 cannot disarm the system unless armed by that user. Level 1: Master Codes • Can perform all normal system functions • Can be used to assign up to 73 lower level codes, which can be used by other users of the system. • Cannot assign anybody a level of 0 or 1. • May change his own code. • Can add, delete, change manager or operator codes. Each user's code can be individually eliminated or changed at any time. • Open/close reporting of added users are same as that of the master or manager adding the new user. Level 2: Manager Codes • Can perform all system functions (Arm, Disarm, Bypass, etc.) programmed by Master. • May add, delete or change other users of the system below this level (Manager cannot assign anybody a level of 0, 1, or 2). • May change his own code. • Open/close reporting of added users will be same as his own (enabled or disabled as assigned by installer or master). Levels 3-5: Operator Codes • Can arm and disarm the system to the authority assigned, but cannot add or modify any user code. • May operate a partition with one of the three OPERATOR authority levels A through C listed below. Level Title Functions Permitted 3 O erator A Arm, Disarm, B ass 4 Operator B Arm, Disarm 5 Operator C Arm, Disarm only if armed with same code • Operator C (sometimes known as Baby-sitter code), cannot disarm the system unless the system was armed with that code. This code is usually assigned to persons who may have the need to arm and disarm the system at specific times only (ex. a baby-sitter needs to control the system only when baby- sitting). —156 — Level 6: Duress • Sends a silent alarm to a central monitoring station if the user is being forced to disarm (or arm)the system under threat(only useful if the system is connected to a central station). • When the system's Auxiliary Voltage Triggers are connected to another communication's media (Derived Channel/Long Range Radio), note that duress is signaled on the same trigger that signals silent panic (whereas duress has its own unique report when digitally communicated). • Assigned on a partition by partition basis and can be any code or codes desired. • Will disarm (or arm)the system, but will also send a silent alarm to the central station (if service is connected). There will be no indication at the keypad that an alarm was sent.. L�� Duress Reporting Note: The Duress report triggering logic activates on the 5th key depression (such as OFF), not the 4th key depression (last digit of code). Duress reports will not be triggered if the 5th key is a [*], such as when erformin a GOTO or viewin the ca abilities of a user. General Rules on Authority Levels and changes The following rules apply to users when making modifications within the system based on the user code authority levels: • Master Codes and all lower level codes can be used interchangeably when perForming system functions within a partition (a system armed with a user's temporary code can be disarmed with the Master Code or another user's temporary code), except the Operator Level C Code described above. • A user may not delete or change the user code of the SAME or HIGHER authority than which he is assigned. • A user(levels 0, 1 & 2 only) may only ADD users to a LOWER authority level. • A user may assign other users access to only those partitions to which he himself has access. • A user can only be DELETED or CHANGED from within the partition he is assigned. • User numbers must be entered as 2-digit entries. Single digit user numbers must, therefore, always be preceded by a "0" (example, 03, 04, 05, etc.). Make sure the end user understands this requirement. Temporary codes are entered as 4-digit numbers. � Ademco Contact ID format is capable of reporting Users 01-75 uniquely. If any other report format is used, only user numbers#1 -#15 can uniquely report to the central station. Users#16-#75 will report as User#15. Multiple Partition Access Examples Each user is programmed for a primary (home) partition. A user can also be given access to operate one or more partitions. In addition, within each partition, each user may be programmed to have different levels of authority. For example, User#3, the V.P. of Engineering, could be assigned to work within the Engineering Department (Partition 1) of ABC Manufacturing. Since he needs the full capabilities in his area, he is assigned as a MASTER with Level 1 authority. This means he may Arm, Disarm, Bypass, Add or Modify users in partition 1. It is also a requirement that he be able to gain access to the manufacturing area (partition 2) on an emergency basis. You can set this up easily with the partitioned system by now requesting that he also be assigned to partition 2, with a level of authority set lower, such as Level 4 (OPERATOR Level B)which allows him to Arm and Disarm, but nothing else. The control will automatically assign him the same user number within partition 2 and does not require reprogramming of his already existing 4 digit security code. —157 — EXAMPLE OF MULTIPLE PARTITION ACCESS Part 1 Part 2 Part 3 Part 4 Part 5 Part 6 Part 7 Part 8 User 3 User 3 Levell Leve14 Master Oper B In the above example, User 3 has MASTER authority in partition 1 and OPERATOR B authority in partition 2. His user number is the same for both partitions. Note that if a user number is already being used in a partition, the system will automatically assign an unused User number. Also notice that no access is allowed for this user into partitions 3 - 8. Attempts to access these partitions would be denied automatically. To ADD a Master, Manager or Operator Code �, During user code entry, normal key depressions at other keypads in a partition will be ignored. However, panic key depression will cause an alarm and terminat _use_r entry._ Enter Installer Codet+ [g] + new user#(02-75) + new user's code tOr Master or Manager code, but must be code with higher level of authority than the code being changed (i.e. Master code can add a Manager or Operator level code, but cannot add another Master code; a Manager code can add an Operator level code, but cannot add a Master or another Manager code). Keypad will prompt for the Authority Level for this user. ��User Number= 03 11 Enter the level number as follows: Enter Auth. Level � 1 = Master(Arm, Disarm, Bypass, add or modify lower level users) 2 = Manager (Arm, Disarm, Bypass, add or modify lower level users) 3 = Operator Level A (Arm, Disarm, Bypass) 4 = Operator Level B (Arm, Disarm) 5 = Operator Level C ( Arm, Disarm only if system armed with this code) 6 = Duress (Arm, Disarm, triggers silent panic alarm) Keypad will then prompt for Open/Close reporting option for this user. I Open/Close Rep.? � Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES), depending on whether or not I 0 = NO , 1 = YES � arming/disarming by this user will trigger opening & closing reports. This prompt appears only if the installer code is used to add a user. �Access Group? � If access schedules have been programmed, this prompt �Enter 0-8 � appears. Enter the user's access group number (1-8) if this user should have limited access to the system. Enter 0 if no access group should be assigned. �RF Button ? � If a 5800 series button transmitter has been enabled for 0=N0 , 1=YES � arming/disarming functions, and is not assigned to a user, this prompt will appear. Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES). Enter Button ZN # � If yes was given as the answer to the RF button question, i(01-86) I the zone number for the button will be requested. Enter any one of the zone numbers assigned to the button transmitter as AWAY, STAY or DISARM. The system will then assign all buttons of the transmitter to this user number. —158 — �Multi-Access ? '� Press 0 (NO) if the user is to have access to this partition �0 = NO , 1 = YES � only. Press 1 (YES) if the user is to have access to more than one partition. If NO, the program exits this mode. If yes, the Keypad prompts for the Global Arm option for this user. Global Arm ? I Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES), depending on whether or not 0 = NO , 1 = YES u this user will be allowed to arm more than one partition � via Global Arm prompts (described in the KEYPAD FUNCTIONS section) . The keypad now prompts for the user's access to the next partition. �Part. 2—SHOP ? � Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES), depending on whether or not �0 = NO , 1 = YES p this user will have access to the displayed partition number. If NO, the keypad displays this prompt for the next partition number in sequence. If YES, the keypad prompts for the following: • User's authority level in the displayed partition (see Authority Level prompt above). • Open/Close option for this user in the displayed partition (see Open/Close prompt above). • Global Arm option for this user in the displayed partition. When all partitions have been displayed, the keypad will scroll through all partitions to which access has been assigned, and will display the user number, authority level, open/close and global arm options that were programmed for each partition the user was granted access. For example: �Part. 1 AO *WHSE � Note that the "G" following the authority level indicates User 03 Auth=3G. � that the global arm feature is enabled for this user in the � displayed partition, and that the period at the end of the second line indicates open/close reporting is enabled for this user in the displayed partition. The "*" indicates the partition from which the user may be changed or deleted. To CHANGE a Master, Manager or Operator code Enter Installer code* + [8] + User number(02-75) + new user's code. " Or Master or Manager code, but must be code with higher level of authority than the code being changed. (i.e. Master code can change a Manager or Operator level code, but cannot change another Master code; a Manager code can change an Operator level code, but cannot change a Master or another Manager code). �User Number= 03 '1 The system detects that the user number is already NEW USER? assigned and will prompt if this is a new user. Press 0 - (NO). The system will then confirm that the change is allowed based on authorization level. —159 — Adding An RF Key To An Existing User To add an RF key to an existing user, or to change a user's global arm option, first delete that user's code, then re-add the user code as described in the "Add A User" paragraph. To Delete a Master, Manager or Operator code Enter your code* + [8] + User number(02-75) +your code again * Installer, Master or Manager code, but must be code with higher level of authority than the code being deleted. (i.e. Master code can delete a Manager or Operator level code, but cannot delete another Master code; a Manager code can delete an Operator level code, but cannot delete a Master or another Manager code). �OK TO DELETE 03? I The system will prompt to confirm that you want to delete �0=N0 1=YES � this user. Press 0 (NO) or 1 (YES). If yes, that user's code will be removed from all partitions to which it had been assigned, and all authorization levels and other information about that user will be deleted. Note that a user can only be deleted by a user with a higher authority level. A user cannot delete himself. L�� A user code can only be deleted from the partition through which it was entered. � If trying to delete from another partition, the message "User [XX] Not Deleted"will be displayed. _ _ _ To EXIT The User Edit Mode Press either[*] or[#], or don't press any key for 10 seconds. —160 — • ' � � • This section provides the following information: • General information about keypad usage • Basic keypad functions • Global arming • Access control • Delaying closing time • Executing the "Go To" command • Viewing: A user's capabilities Zone descriptors Downloaded messages Built-in user's guide • Speed key macro commands • Executing #70 Manual Relay Activation mode General Information The keypad allows the user to arm and disarm the system, and perform other system functions, such as bypassing zones, viewing messages from the central station, and displaying zone descriptors. Zone and system conditions (alarm, trouble, bypass) are shown in the display window. When an alarm occurs, keypad sounding and external sounding will occur, and the zone(s) in alarm will be displayed on the keypad. Pressing any key will silence the keypad sounder for 10 seconds. Disarming the system will silence both keypad and external sounders. When the system is disarmed, any zones that were in an alarm condition during the armed period will be displayed (memory of alarm). To clear this display, simply repeat the disarm sequence (enter the security code and press the OFF key). The keypads also feature chime annunciation, and 3 panic keys (for silent, audible, fire or personal emergency alarms)which can notify the central station of an alarm condition, if that service is connected. Arming Functions The following is a brief list of system commands. For detailed information concerning system functions, refer to the User's Manual. Display Faulted Before arming, the system must be in the READY Zones condition (all zones must be intact). If the "NOT READY" message appears, press the READY � key to display faulted zones. Arming Away Enter code + �2 (AWAY). Arming Stay Enter code + �3 (STAY). (all zones designated as zone types 4 and 10 will be automatically bypassed) Arming Instant Enter code + � (INSTANT) (same as STAY without entry delay). Arming Maximum Enter code + � (MAXIMUM) (same as AWAY without entry delay). Disarming Enter code + � (OFF). Bypassing Zones Enter code + �6 (BYPASS) + zone number. To automatically bypass all faulted zones, use "Quick Bypass" method: Enter code + BYPASS + �. Chime Mode Enter code + �9 (CHIME). To turn chime mode off, enter code + CHIME again. —161 — Quick Arming: Note that if QUICK ARM is enabled (field *29), the �# key can be pressed instead of entering the security code, for any of the arming procedures (Away, Stay, Instant, Maximum, etc.). L� �, User#02 must be programmed into the system in order for the Quick Arm feature �� to work. SUMMARY OF ARMING MODES Mode Features For Each Arming Mode Exit Entry Perimeter Interior Delay Delay Armed Armed AWAY Yes Yes Yes Yes STAY Yes Yes Yes No INSTANT Yes No Yes No MAXIMUM Yes No Yes Yes Global Arming If enabled for the user, the keypad will display the following: � ARM ALL ? � If NO, the keypad prompts for arming each partition �0 - NO , 1 - YES � individually. If YES, the system attempts to arm all partitions allowed by this user. If there are any faults (open doors, windows, etc.) the keypad will display them. See notes below. These faults must be corrected or the zone bypassed before arming will occur. When faults are corrected, repeat the arming procedure. 1. When using the Global Arm feature, if there are faults in any of the selected partitions, the system will enter a summary mode in which the faulted zones of all of the selected partitions will be displayed. These faults must be corrected or bypassed (code + BYPASS + [#] will attempt to bypass the faults in all of the selected partitions). This summary mode will end in approx. 120 seconds if no keys are pressed. 2. If, when disarming the system using a Global Disarm, any of the selected partitions has a condition which would cause the keypad to beep (such as alarm memory or a trouble condition), the system will cause the keypad to beep and will enter a summary mode in which the alarm memory or trouble conditions of all of the selected partitions will be displayed. This mode will continue until either approx. 120 seconds elapses or a second disarm occurs which clears the beeping L�� Global arming cannot be performed from a wireless keypad or a non-alpha displa � keypad. -162 - Access Control If programmed, one relay may be used for access control in each partition. The relay is programmed in data field 1*76. To activate this relay, the user enters his user code + 0]. The relay will pulse for 2 seconds. Delaying Closing Time If Open/Close schedules are used, end users can manually delay closing time by extending the closing window by 1 or 2 hours. This is useful if a user must stay on the premises later than usual. The user must have authority level of manager or higher. To extend the closing window, enter user code + #+82. Closing Delay? � Enter the number hours, 1 or 2, by which the end of the Hit 0-2 Hours closing window should be extended. Note that the delay is from the scheduled closing time, not from the current time. Press n to accept entry and exit this mode. Press# to exit this mode without changes. The system will send an "Access Schedule Change" message to the central station when the closing window is extended (if programmed in fields 2*13 and 2*14. , An extension of the closing window cannot be reduced once it is set. However, a L�� 1 hour delay can be increased to 2 hours. This is to prevent the user from deleting the delay after the normal window expires, thereby missing the end of the window. Partition "GOTO" Commands Each keypad is assigned a default partition for display purposes, and will show only that partition's information. To see information for another partition, or perform system functions in another partition, use the GOTO command (code + [*] +partition number 0-8). The keypad will remain in the new partition until directed to go to another partition, or until 120 seconds has elapsed with no keypad activity. To return to your home partition, enter G + partition number 0. L� ,� You must program data field 2*18 to enable the GOTO function. This is a �� partition-specific field that must be set for each partition the user wants to acces from another artition's ke ad Viewing Capabilities Of A User The keypad will display the partitions that a user is authorized for, the user number, and the authority level for all partitions authorized. Enter code + [*] + [*]. The user's capabilities in each authorized partition will typically be displayed as fol lows: I Part. 1 AO *WHSE The user's Open/Close report capability is shown by the �User 01 Auth.-1 G_,� dot following the authority level. If Open/Close is not enabled for a user, the dot will not appear. Viewing Zone Descriptors The Alpha Keypads can display all programmed descriptors, which is useful to the installer when checking entries, and can be helpful to the user when there is a need to identify zones. To display descriptors, the system must be disarmed and ready to arm. Press and hold the READY key until the built-in instructions for that key appear, then release the key. The zone descriptors will appear one at a time, for about 2-3 seconds each. For faster viewing, press the READY key to display the next descriptor in numerical order and so on. When all descriptors have been displayed, the control will exit display mode. To exit display mode before all descriptors have been displayed, enter the security code and press the OFF key. -163 - Viewing Downloaded Messages Users may occasionally receive a message from their installation company displayed on an alpha keypad. When this occurs, the keypad will display "Message. Press 0 for 5 secs.". Instruct the user to press and hold the 0 key to display the central station's message. Note that the system must be in the READY state to view these messages. Using The Built-In User's Manual An abbreviated User's Manual is stored in the system's memory, and can be particularly useful to the end user if the printed User's Manual is not conveniently accessible when the user needs to perForm a seldom used and unfamiliar system procedure. The Built-in User's Guide is displayed only on an alpha keypad by simply pressing any of the function keys (e.g., OFF, AWAY, STAY, MAXIMUM, BYPASS, INSTANT, CODE, TEST, READY, #, and CHIME) for approximately 5 seconds and then releasing it. Abbreviated instructions relative to the key that has been pressed will then be displayed (2 lines of text are displayed at a time). This function operates in either the armed or the disarmed state. Panic Keys There are three panic key pairs (shown below) that, if programmed, can be used to manually initiate alarms and send a report to the central station. Each key pair can be individually programmed for 24 Hour Silent, Audible or Auxiliary (Emergency) responses, as well as Fire. The panic function is activated when the appropriate key pair is pressed at the same time. The panic functions are identified by the system as follows: PANIC Displayed as Zone � � 95 For alpha keypads, these panic keys can also be programmed with an alpha � �3 96 descriptor. � �� 99 � For the Panic functions to be of practical value, the system must be connected to ��� a central station. Speed Key [D] (Macros) The "D" key can be used to activate a string of up to 16 keystrokes. These keystrokes are known as a macro and are stored in the system's memory . Each partition may have its own macro. Typical Speed Key functions include: • Arming sequences that involve first bypassing certain zones before arming. • Seldom used but repeatable sequences. • Relay activation sequences. To program a macro, enter your user code + [#] + [D]. The following appears: ENTER SPEEDKEY"D" existing sequence displayed Enter up to 16 keystrokes. A speed key sequence can include different commands. Press the "D" key to separate different commands. For example, you may want to perform the following sequence. Desired function Ke strokes GOTO partition 2 Enter*2 Bypass zones 10 & 11 Press bypass [6], then the zone numbers 10 & 11 Arm in maximum mode Press maximum [4] key Return to partition 1 Enter*1 —164 — To program that speed key sequence, type the following : *2�D61011 �D4�D *1�D �D Note that the "D" key is pressed after the "2,"the last "1" and the "4," separating the different commands. Press "D"twice to complete the entry and exit. To execute a speed key sequence, press the "D" key. The following appears: ENTER USER CODE **** Enter your user code. The programmed speedkey sequence will begin automatically. When defining speedkey sequences, do not use the [#] key to represent Quick L�� Arming. The system uses the code entered in response to the prompt to initiate commands in a speedkey sequence, so the quick arm key is unnecessary. The system interprets the use of the [#] key in a speedkey sequence as its designated function only (e.g. #2 is not interpreted as arm in away mode, but rather as enter house ID sniffer mode . Manual Relay Activation Mode (#70 Mode) The system allows users to manually activate relays/X-10 modules by keypad command using either the keypad or a telephone keypad (if VIP module is used). The user will be prompted (either by keypad alpha display or telephone voice module). To activate relays from a keypad, enter 4-digit security code + [#]+70. To activate relays using a telephone and VIP module, first dial the 2-digit phone access code. When the system acknowledges the access, enter 4-digit security code+ [#] + 70. The following prompts/voice responses will begin. ENTER DEVICE NO. � Voice: "ENTER DEVICE CODE NOW" 00=QUIT 01 � Enter the 2-digit number of the relay/X-10 module to be activated. �nn DEVICE IS OFF II Voice: "voice descriptor DEVICE nn ON/OFF. FOR HIT 0=0FF , 1=0N voice descriptorON ENTER 1, FOR voice descriptor OFF ENTER 0" Press 0 or 1 to turn the device off or on respectively. "nn" represents the 2-digit relay/X-10 module number and voice descriptor is the relay voice descriptor programmed by the installer (see relay descriptor programming section). �nn DEVICE IS OFF � Voice: "voice descriptor DEVICE nn ON/OFF. TO EXIT � HIT THE "*" KEY ENTER 00 NOW" From a keypad, press � to continue. The ENTER DEVICE NO. prompt will appear. From a telephone keypad, enter 00 to exit, or enter the next relay number to be programmed. The current on/off state of that relay will be annunciated as described above. Alternatively, if 6 seconds elapses with no key depression, the voice module will annunciate the "ENTER DEVICE CODE NOW" message. —165 — • • This section provides the following information: • Using Test Mode • Turning the system over to the user • Trouble conditions Using Test Mode General Information After the installation is completed, thoroughly test the Security System on a partition by partition basis as follows: 1. With the System in the disarmed state, check that all zones are intact. If DISARMED - Press T to show faults is displayed, press the n key to display the descriptors of the faulted zone(s). Restore faulted zone(s) if necessary, so that****DISARMED*** READY TO ARM is displayed. 2. Enter the security code and press the TEST key. The external sounder (if used) should sound for 3 seconds and then turn off (the system is operating on the back-up battery only at this time). NOTE 1. If the sounder does not sound, this may be an indication that the backup battery is discharged or missing. NOTE 2. As a reminder that the system is in the Test mode, the keypad will sound a single beep at 15-second intervals. NOTE 3. In the Test mode, no alarm reports will be sent to the central station for the partition being tested. Also, the external sounder (if used) will not be activated. NOTE 4: Test mode is active only for the partition at which Test mode is entered. Other partitions are still operative and will cause the external sounder and communicator to activate if an alarm condition occurs. Doors and Windows • Open and close each protected door and window in turn. Each action should produce three beeps from the keypad. The descriptor for each protection zone will appear on the keypad display. Motion Detectors • Walk in front of any interior motion detectors. Listen for three beeps when the detector senses movement. While it is activated, its descriptor will remain displayed on the keypad. Note that wireless PIRs will have a 3 minute lockout between transmissions to conserve battery life (remove cover for walk test to override the 3-minute lock-out on 5700 series units, move jumper inside 5800 series units to "Test" position (put back to "Normal" position when test is complete)). Smoke Detectors • Follow the test procedure provided by the manufacturer of each smoke detector to ensure that all detectors are operational and are functioning properly. NOTE: A 2-wire smoke detector display will not clear until the Test mode is exited. Turning Off TEST mode • Enter the security code and press the 1� (OFF) key. —166 — Armed System Test L� � 1. A message will be sent to the central station during the following tests. Notify �� the central station that a test will be in progress. 2. A display of"COMM. FAILURE" (FC on fixed work keypads) indicates a failure to communicate (no Kissoff by the receiver at the central station after the maximum number of transmission attempts is tried). If this occurs, verify that the phone line is connected, the correct report format is programmed, etc. 1. Arm the system and fault one or more zones. Silence alarm sounder(s) each time by entering the code and pressing OFF. Check that Entry/Exit delay zones provide the assigned delay times. 2. Check the keypad-initiated alarms, if programmed in field *05, by pressing the Panic key pairs ([*] + [1], [#] + [3], [*] + [#]). If the system has been programmed for audible emergency, the keypad will emit a loud, steady alarm sound. The word ALARM and a descriptor"99"will be displayed for[*] + [#]. (if [*] + [1] is pressed, a "95"will be displayed; if[#] + [3] is pressed, a "96"will be displayed). Silence the alarm by entering the security code and pressing OFF. If the system has been programmed for silent panic, there will be no audible alarms or displays, but a report will be sent to the central station, if programmed to do so. 3. Notify the central station that all tests are finished and verify results with them. Turning The System Over To The User 1. Fully explain the operation of the system to the user by going over each of its functions as well as the User's Manual supplied. 2. In particular, explain the operation of each zone (entry/exit, perimeter, interior, fire, etc.). Be sure the user understands how to operate any emergency feature(s) programmed into the system. IMPORTANT: In the spaces provided in the User's Manual, record the Entry and Exit Delay times, and those functions that have been programmed into the available pairs of PANIC key pairs ([*] + [1], [#] + [3], [*] + [#]). 3. Make sure the user understands the importance of testing the system at least weekly, following the procedure provided in the User's Manual. To The Installer Regular maintenance and inspection (at least annually) by the installer and frequent testing by the user are vital to continuous satisfactory operation of any alarm system. The installer should assume the responsibility of developing and offering a regular maintenance program to the user as well as acquainting the user with the proper operation and limitations of the alarm system and its component parts. Recommendations must be included for a specific program of frequent testing (at least weekly)to insure the system's proper operation at all times. —167 — Trouble Conditions The word "CHECK" on the keypad's display, accompanied by a rapid "beeping" at the keypad, indicates that there is a trouble condition in the system. The audible warning sound can be silenced by pressing any key. Instruct users to call for service immediately upon seeing any of the following messages. "Check" Messages • "CHECK" accompanied by a display of one or more zone descriptor(s) Indicates that a problem exists with those zone(s). Zone trouble may be caused by one of the following conditions: --A hardwired fire zone is open (broken wire) --A Day/Night zone (Zone Type 5) is faulted --A polling loop zone is not seen by the control panel --A polling loop zone has been tampered (cover removed on a 4190) --A wireless zone has not checked in during the time programmed in field 1*31 --A 5800 series transmitter has been tampered (cover removed) • "CHECK" accompanied by a numeric display of"87" Indicates the 4285 VIP Module is not communicating with the control panel. • "CHECK" accompanied by a numeric display of"97" Indicates that a short exists on the Polling Loop and may eliminate some of the protection. Fault "97" can be assigned an alpha descriptor when using the alpha keypad. • "CHECK" accompanied by a numeric display of"88", "89", "90", or"91" Indicates a wireless receiver problem. These faults indicate the following: 88: The 2nd receiver has not heard from any supervised RF transmitters for the period of time programmed in field 1*30. 89: The 2nd receiver is not communicating with the control panel. 90: The 1 st receiver has not heard from any supervised RF transmitters for the period of time programmed in field 1*30. 91: The 1st receiver is not communicating with the control panel. L�� If the problem has been corrected, key an OFF sequence (Security Code plus OFF)twice to clear the display. —168 — Other System Messages • "COMM. FAILURE" (alpha) or"FC" (fixed-word) at the Keypad Indicates that a failure occurred in the telephone communication portion of your system. • "LO BAT" (alpha) or "BAT" (fixed-word) and a zone descriptor, accompanied by a once per minute beep at the Keypad Indicates that a low battery condition exists in the wireless transmitter displayed. The audible warning sound may be silenced by pressing any key. • "SYSTEM LO BAT" (alpha) or "BAT" with no zone number (fixed-word) indicates that a low battery condition exists with the system's backup battery. • "RCVR SET UP ERROR" (alpha) or"E8" (fixed-word) at the keypad Indicates that the system has more wireless zones programmed than the wireless receiver can support. If this is not corrected, none of the zones in the system will be protected. If additional wireless zones are desired, use an appropriate receiver. • "MODEM COMM" (alpha)or"CC" (fixed-word) Indicates that the control is on-line with the remote computer and the control is not operating. Panel's response to alarm and trouble conditions will be delayed until on-line session is completed. Power Failure If the POWER indicator is off, and the message "AC LOSS" (alpha) or "NO AC" (fixed-word) is displayed, the keypad is operating on battery power only. Check to see that your system's plug-in transformer has not been accidentally pulled out. Instruct the user to call a service representative immediately if AC power cannot be restored. —169 — � � � � � � UL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS The following requirements apply to both UL Residential and UL Commercial Burglary installations: 1. All partitions must be owned and managed by the same person(s). 2. All partitions must be part of one building at one street address. 3. The audible alarm device(s) must be placed where it/they can be heard by all partitions. 4. The Control cabinet must be protected from unauthorized access. This can be done by installing a tamper switch on the cabinet door (not supplied with VISTA 50P; supplied with VISTA 50PUL) or by installing a UL Listed passive infrared detector positioned to detect cabinet access. Wire the selected device to any EOLR supervised zone (zone 1-8). Program this zone for day trouble/night alarm (type 05) or 24 hour audible alarm (type 07) response. The 24 hour alarm response must be used for multiple partitioned systems. 5. Remote Downloading and auto-disarming are not UL Listed features. UL609 GRADE A LOCAL MERCANTILE PREMISES/LOCAL MERCANTILE SAFE 8�VAULT 1. Use the VISTA 50PUL. 2. All zones must be configured for EOLR supervision (*41=0). Wireless sensors may not be used. If 4190WH RPMs are used, set field *24 to "0" to enable tamper detection. 3. Attach a door tamper switch (supplied) to the VISTA 50PUL cabinet backbox. For safe and vault installations, a shock sensor (not supplied) must also be attached to the backbox. (Also see MOUNTING THE CABINET section) 4. Wire an Ademco AB12 Grade A Bell/Box to the bell output. Bell wires must be run in conduit. Program the bell output for 16 or more minute timeout and for confirmation of arming ding. (Also see EXTERNAL SOUNDERS section) 5. Wire the VISTA 50PUL tamper switch and AB12 Bell/Box tamper switches to any EOLR supervised zone (zones 1-8). Program this zone for day trouble/night alarm (type 05) or 24 hour audible alarm (type 07) response. The 24 hour alarm response must be used for multiple partitioned systems. 6. Entry delays must not exceed 45 seconds and exit delays must not exceed 60 seconds. UL365 POLICE STATION CONNECTED BURGLAR ALARM Follow the instructions for UL609 local instructions. For Grade A Service: • You may use the VISTA-50PUL dialer alone, or the 7720 Long Range Radio alone. • When using the dialer, program it to send burglary alarm, low battery and communicator test reports. Field *27 must be set to "024" (or less) so that test reports are sent at least once every 24 hours. • When using the 7720, connect it to the VISTA-50PUL burglary/audible panic alarm panic alarm trigger. For Grade AA Service: • You must use a 7920SE Long Range Radio. • Connect the 7920SE to the VISTA-50PUL burglary/audible panic alarm panic alarm trigger. —170 — UL611/UL1610 CENTRAL STATION BURGLARY ALARM 1. Follow the instructions for UL609 Local installations given above. For Grade A Service: • You must use the VISTA-50PUL's dialer with a 7720 Long Range Radio. • Connect the Control's burglary/audible panic alarm trigger (on J7 header) and the 659EN's phone line monitor output to the 7720. The 7720 will send a report to the central station when a telephone line fault condition is detected. • Also connect the 7720's radio fault output to one of the VISTA-50PUL's EOLR supervised zones (i.e., 1-8). Program this zone for a trouble by day/alarm by night(type 05)or a 24-hour alarm (type 07, 08) response to radio faults. • Program the Control's dialer to send burglary alarm, trouble, opening/closing„ and low battery reports. For Grade AA Service: • Follow the instructions for Grade A service except use the 7920SE in place of the 7720. CALIFORNIA STATE FIRE MARSHAL (CSFM) AND UL RESIDENTIAL FIRE 24 HOUR BATTERY BACKUP REQUIREMENTS. The California State Fire Marshal and UL have regulations which require that all residential fire alarm control panels must be provided with backup battery which has sufficient capacity to operate the panel and its attached peripherals devices for 24 hours in the intended standby condition, followed by at least 4 minutes in the intended fire alarm signaling condition. The VISTA 50P can meet this requirement without using a supplemental power supply, provided that the panel's outputs (including the current drawn from the auxiliary power output terminals)are limited as shown below: • Output current is limited to 750mA maximum total auxiliary power, polling loop and bell output current. • Maximum auxiliary current is 300mA(including polling loop current) • Use 14AH battery (Yuasa model NP7-12 recommended, use two connected in parallel. A dual battery harness is provided with Ademco No. 4100EOLR Resistor kit (kit also contains EOL resistors having spade lug/heat shrink tubing construction which has been approved by UL and CSFM for fire zone usage). Both batteries will fit inside the panel's cabinet. —171 — "FEDERAL COMMUNICATION5 COMMISSION (FCC) STATEMENT" This equipment has been tested to FCC requirements and has been found acceptable for use. The FCC requires the following statement for your information: This equipment generates and uses radio frequency energy and if not installed and used properly,that is,in strict accardance with the manufacturer's instructions,may cause interference to radio and television reception.It has been type tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B computing device in accordance with the specifications in Part 15 of FCC Rules,which are designed to provide reasonable protection against such interference in a residential installation. However,there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation.If this equipment does cause interference to radio or television reception,which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • If using an indoor antenna,have a quality outdoor antenna installed. • Reorient the receiving antenna until interference is reduced or eliminated. • Move the receiver away from the control/communicator. • Move the antenna leads away from any wire runs to the control/communicatar. • Plug the control/communicator into a different outlet so that it and the receiver are on different branch circuits. If necessary,the user should consult the dealer or an experienced radio/television technician for additiona] suggestions. The user or installer may find the following booklet prepared by the Federal Communicarions Commission helpful: °Interference Handbook" This booklet is available from the U.S.Government Printing Office,Washington,DC 20402. The user shall not make any changes or modifications to the equipment unless authorized by the Installation Instructions or User's Manual. Unauthorized changes or modifications could void the user's authoriry to operate the equipment. IN THE EVENT OF TELEPHONE OPERATIONAL PROBLEMS In the event of telephone operational problems, disconnect the control panel by removing the plug from the RJ31 X (CA38A in Canada) wall jack. We recommend that you demonstrate disconnecting the phones on installation of the system. Do not disconnect the phone connection inside the Control Panel. Doing so will result in the loss of your phone lines. If the regular phone works correctly after the Control Panel has been disconnected from the phone lines,the Control Panel has a problem and should be returned for repair. If upon disconnection of the Control Panel,there is still a problem on the line,notify the telephone company that they have a problem and request prompt repair service. The user may not under any circumstances (in or out of warranty) attempt any service or repairs to the system. It must be returned to the factory or an authorized service agency for all repairs. FCC PART 68 NOTICE This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules. On the front cover of this equipment is a label that contains, among other information, the FCC registration number and ringer equivalence number (REN) for this equipment.If requested,this infarmation must be provided to the telephone company. This equipment uses the following jacks: An RJ31X is used to connect this equipment to the telephone network. The REN is used to determine the quantiry of devices which may be connected to the telephone line. Excessive RENs on the telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call.In most,but not all areas,the sum of the RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be connected to the line,as determined by the total RENs,contact the telephone company to determine the maximum REN for the calling area. If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company wil] notify you in advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also,you will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you believe necessary. The telephone company may make changes in its facilities,equipment,operations,or procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in arder for you to make the necessary modifications in order to maintain uninterrupted service. If trouble is experienced with this equipment,please contact the manufacturer for repair and warranty information. If the trouble is causing harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may request you remove the equipment from the network until the problem is resolved. There are no user serviceable components in this product, and all necessary repairs must be made by the manufacturer. Other repair methods may invalidate the FCC registration on this product. This equipment cannot be used on telephone company-provided coin service. Connection to Party Line Service is subject to state tariffs. This equipment is hearing-aid compatible. When programming or making test calls to an emergency number,briefly explain to the dispatcher the reason for the call.Perform such activities in the off-peak hours; such as early morning or late evening. —172 — CANADIAN DEPARTMENT OF COMMUNICATIONS (DOC) STATEMENT NOTICE The Canadian Department of Communications label identifies certified equipment. This certification means that the equipment meets certain telecommunications network protective, operational and safety requiremenis. The Department does not guarantee the equipment will operate to the user's satisfaction. Befare installing this equipment,users should ensure that it is permissible to be connected to the facilities of the local telecommunications company. The equipment must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. In some cases, the company's inside wiring associated with a single line individual service may be extended by means of certified connector assembly (telephone extension card). The customer should be aware that compliance with the above conditions may not prevent degradation of service in some situarions. Repairs to certified equipment should be made by an authorized Canadian maintenance facility designated by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by the user to this equipment,or equipment malfunctions,may give the telecommunications company cause to request the user to disconnect the equipment. Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections of the power utility,telephone lines and internal metallic water pipe system, if present, are connected together. This precaution may be particularly important in rural areas. Caution: User should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but should contact the appropriate electric inspection authority,or electrician,as appropriate. The Load Number (LN) assigned to each terminal device denotes the percentage of the total load to be connected to a telephone loop which is used by the device,to prevent overloading. The termination on a loop may consist of any combination of devices subject only to the requirement that the total of the Load Numbers of all the devices does not exceed 100. AVIS L'etiquette du ministere des Communications du Canada identifie le materiel homologue. Cette etiquette certifie que le materiel est conforme a certaines normes de protection, d'exploitation et de securite des reseaux de telecommunications. Le ministere n'assure toutefois pas que le materiel fonctionnera a la satisfaction de 1'utilisateur. Avant d'installer ce materiel, 1'utilisateur doit s'assurer qu'il est permis de le raccorder aux installations de 1'entreprise locale de telecommunications. Le materiel doit egalement etre installe en suivant une methode acceptee de raccordement. Dans certains cas,les fils interieurs de 1'entreprise utilises pour un service individuel a la ligne unique peuvent etre prolonges au moyen d'un dispositif homologue de raccordement(cordon prolongateur tel'ephonique interne). L'abonne ne doit pas oublier qu'i] est possible que la conformite aux conditions enoncees ci-dessus n'empechet pas la d'egradation du service dans certaines situations. Actuellement, ]es entreprises de telecommunications ne permettent pas que 1'on raccorde leur materiel aux prises d'abonnes, sauf dans les cas precis prevus par les tarifs particuliers de ces entreprises. Les reparations du materiel homologue doivent etre efFectuees pas un centre d'entretien canadien autorise d'esigne par le fournisseur. La compagnie de telecommunications peut demander a]'utilisateur de d'ebrancher un appareil a la suite de reparations ou de modifications effectuees par 1'utilisateur ou a cause de mauvais fonctionnement. Pour sa propre protection, 1'utilisateur doit s'assurer que tous les fils de mise en terre de la source d'energie electrique, des lignes telephoniques de reseau de conduites d'eau s'i] y en a, soient raccord'es ensemble. Cette precaution est particulierement importante dans les regions rurales. Avertissement: L'utilisateur ne doit pas tenter de faire ces raccordements lui-meme; il doit avoir recours a un service d'inspection des installations electriques,ou a un electricien,selon le cas. L'indice de charge (IC) assigne a chaque dispositif terminal pour eviter toute surcharge indique le pourcentage de la charge totale qui peut etre raccord'e a un circuit telephonique boucle utilise par ce dispositif.La terminaison du circuit boucle peut etre constituee de n'importe quelle combinaison de dispositifs, pourvu que la somme des indices de charge de 1'ensemble des dispositifs ne d'epasse pas 100. —173 — � DIP SWITCH TABLES FOR ADDRESSABLE POLLING LOOP DEVICES 4208 ZONE EXPANDER 4192D/4192SDT/4192CP 4190WH ZONE EXPANDER Beee0a0a00 SMOKE DETECTORS O DIP + O DIP 00000000 DIP � SIDE VIEW 0 0 0 0 0 SHOWN SET FOR ��P� ID 10(A) SIDE VIEW � 2�4 ��p� APPLIES TO TABLE A UPLY C� APPLIES TO TABLE A&B UPLY ���B� UP SHOWN SETi FOR ID 10 u SHOWN SETi FOR ID 10(A) � 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 SIDE VIEW DN �������� SID(DN�EW �������� DN (DN) POS.1: LOOPS 1&2 � RESPONSE TIME: � W/TABLE FAST SLOW POS.1:MUST BE DOWN WITH TABLE: A B A UP DN POS.1 MUST BE: DN UP B DN UP THIS TABLE FOR DIPS WITH THIS TABLE FOR DIPS WITH WORD"DN" A WORD"UP" B (��_��=DN) (��_��=DN) �EVICE �IPSWITCHPOSITION DEVICE DIPSWITCHPOSITION THIS TABLE FOR DIPS �o z s a s s � e �o z s < s e � s WITH WORD"DN" � 10 - - - UP - UP�- 10 .�UP UP UP - UP - UP („—°=DN) 71 - - - UP I- UP UP �1 I�P UP UP - UP - - 72 - UP UP - 12 UP UP UP - - UP UP DEVICE DIPSWITCHPOSITION 13 - UPIUP - UP 13 IUP UP UP - - UP- ID �< - - - 11P.l1P UP - '14 IUP UP UP - - UP 2 3 Q 5 15 - UP UP UP UP 15 -UP UP UP - - - - 76 - UP - 'I6 Il1P 11P - UP UP UP UP �O-�6 UP » - - �P - - - �P 17 UP UP - UP UP UP- 17-Z4 UP 18 = - �P - - �P - 18 �UP UP - UP UP - UP — — — 79 - UP -�- UP UP '19 �UP UP - UP UP - - 25-32 UP UP 20 - UP - UP - 20 IUP UP - UP - UP UP — — 21 „==UP=UP - UP 27 I.l1P lJP - UP - UP- 33-40 — UP — — _ . _--�-- — �-- 41-48 — UP — UP 22 - - 11P - t1P UP - 22 �UP UP - UP - - UP 23 - UP - UP UP UP 23 UP UP - UP - 49-56 UP �JP 24 - UP UP I,- - 24 UP UP - - UP 11P UP 57-64 — UP UP UP zs - - uP ua - - uP Zs .uP uP - - uP ua- 26 - UP UP-- UP�_ 26 UP UP - - UP - UP 27 .. -.. ..11P 11P - UP..UF 27 UP UP - UP _ _ 28 - UP UP UP - 28 .UP UP - - UP UP 29 - -IUP UP�UPI-.UP 29 �l1P,L1P - - - UP- 30 -��.11P 11P 11P UP - 30 -UP UP - - UP 31 -'�.UP UP�UP'iUP UP 37 UP UP - 32 UP - - I- - 32 I�P - UP UP UP UP UP 33 - UP I- �UP 33 �UP - UP UP UP UP- 34 - UP - - UP - 34 -UP - UP UP UP - UP THIS TABLE FOR DIPS ss - ub - - - uP'uP as ua - ua uP uP - - 36 - UP - - L1P - 36 UP - UP UP - UP UP WITH WORD��UP 37 =UP= - UP - UP 37 11P - UP UP_ lIP- 38 - UP - -i�P UP - 38 UP - UP UP - - UP ("—„=DN) 39 - UP - - UP UP UP 39 �UP - UP UP - - - 40 - UP - UP i_ _I- 40 I 11P - UP - UP UP UP DEVICE DIP SWITCH POSITION 4t - UP - UP - -'UP 41 UP - UP - UP UP- ID 42 - UP�- UP -�UP.- 42 UP=UP - UP - UP 2 3 4 5 43 - UP I- 11P -IUP UP 43 UP - UP - UP - - 44 - UP I- UP UP - 44 UP - UP - - UP UP 10-16 UP UP UP — a5 - uP I- uP uP i-.up as uP=ua - =uP- ��-Z4 UP UP UP 46 - �UP I- UP UP IUP - 46 UP - UP - - - UP — 47 - UP - UP UP UP�UP 47 UP - UP - 25-32 UP UP 48 - UP IUP - . 48 11P - - UP UP UP UP 33-40 UP — UP UP 4B - UP UP - - - UP 49 UP - - UP UP UP- G'I-A$ UP — UP — 50 =UP.UP__-�- UP I- 50 UP=- UP UP - UP_ St - UP 11P I- UP UP 51 11P - - UP UP - 49-56 UP UP 52 - UP UP - 11P - 52 UP - - UP - UP UP 5�-64 UP — — — 53 =UP UP - UP - UP 53 UP - - UP - UP- 54 - UP t1P - UP UP - 54 UP - - UP - - UP 55 - UP UP - UP UP UP 55 UP - - UP - 56 - UP UP UP�- Sfi �P - - UP lIP UP 57 - UP UP UP.- -�UP 57 UP - - UP UP- 58 - UP UP UP - UP - 58 UP - - UP - UP 59 - UP UP 11P -i,UP UP 59 UP - - UP - - 60 - UP UP UP UPI- 60 UP - - UP UP 61 - UP UP UP UP�- UP 67 UP=._.- .=UP- fi2 - UP It1P UP UP'iUP - 62 UP - - - - - UP 63 - UP,UP UP UP UP UP 63 UP - 64 UP -I- - - 64 - UP UP UP UP UP UP �fi5 � UP -�- - -�- UP 65 - UP UP UP UP UP- 66 UP - - UP�- 66 - UP uP UP UP - UP 67 11P _ � - _ UP UP 67 �- UP UP UP UP - - 68 UP - - UP - 68 I- UP UP UP - UP UP 69 UP - - UP - UP s� J.-...�P UP.. P - P- 70 11P - - UP UP - 70 I_ UP UP UP - - UP 7'I UP - -IUP UP UP 71 - UP UP UP - - - 72 UP - - UP - 72 I- lJP UP - UP ll_P UP 73 UP - - tIP - UP 73 - UP UP - UP UP- 74 UP - - UP - UP - 74 - UP UP - UP - UP 75 11P - - 11P - UP UP 75 - UP UP - UP - - 76 UP - - UP�UP - 76 - UP UP - - UP UP 77 UP - - UP UP - UP 77 - 11P.�- - P- 78 11P - - 11P I UP UP - 78 - UP UP - - - UP 79 �UP - - UP UP UP UP 79 - UP UP - - - - 60 UP - UP - 80 - 11P - UP UP lIP UP 8'I UP - UP - UP 81 - UP - UP UP UP- 82 UP - UP - - UP - 82 - UP - UP UP - UP 83 11P - UP - - UP UP 83 - UP - UP UP - - 84 UP - UP - UP - 84 - UP - UP - UP UP 85 UP - UP - UP - UP lJP - P - lIP'_ 86 11P - UP - UP UP - 8�- UP - UP - UP 87 UP - UP - UP UP UP 87 - UP - UP - - - 88 UP - UP UP - 88 - 11P - - UP 11P UP 89 11P - UP UP�- _.�UP. 89 I- UP - - UP UP- BIT B�T VALUE: 64 32 i6 8 4 2 7 VALUE: I64 32 76 8 4 2 7 -174 - DIP SWITCH TABLES FOR POLLING LOOP DEVICES 4275 PIR 4278 PIR 4194 REED CONTACT (SURFACE MOUNT) 0 � � � � e Im � O DIP O DIP MIRROR p�p MIRROR +� i SHOWN SET FOR SIDE VIEW SHOWN SET FOR ID 10(A) SHOWN SET FOR ID 10 ID 10 �� SIDE VIEW �� (DN) �� SIDE VIEW 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 (UP) � 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 � 1 2 3 4 5 6 (DN) ������� DN � �������� pN ������ UP � U "L� POS 6: UP(A),DN(B)=INST.MODE POS 7: UP=NORMAI MODE DN(A),UP(B)=PULSE COUNT DN=INSTANT MODE POS.7: UP(A),DN(B)=WALK TEST POS.8: UP=W/T DISABLE DN(A),UP(B)=W/T DISABLE DN=WALK TEST THIS TABLE FOR DIPS � WITH WORD"DN° DIP SWITCH POSITION DIP SWITCH POSITION DEVICE DEVICE DEVICE DIP SWITCH POSITION �� 1 2 3 4 5 6 �� 1 2 3 4 5 6 ID � p 3 4 5 10 UP UP - UP - UP 10 - UP - UP - 10 - UP - UP - �1 UP UP - UP - - 11 - - UP - UP UP 11 - UP - UP UP �2 UP UP - - UP UP 12 - - UP UP - - 12 - UP UP - 13 UP UP - - UP - 13 - - UP UP - UP 14 UP UP - - UP 14 - UP UP UP - 13 - UP UP - UP 15 UP UP - 15 - UP UP UP UP 14 - UP UP UP - �6 UP - UP UP UP UP 16 - U - - - - 15 - UP UP UP UP 17 UP - UP UP UP - 17 - UP - - - UP 16 UP - - - - �g UP - UP UP - UP 18 UP - - UP - 17 UP UP 19 UP - UP UP - 19 - UP - - UP UP 18 UP - - UP - p0 UP - UP - UP UP 20 - UP - UP - - 19 UP - - UP UP p1 UP - UP - UP - 21 - UP - UP - UP 20 UP - UP - - Zp UP - UP - - UP 22 - UP - UP UP - 21 UP - UP - UP 23 UP - UP - - - 23 - UP - UP UP UP 22 UP - UP UP - pq UP - - UP UP UP 24 - UP UP - - - 23 UP - UP UP UP p5 UP - - UP UP - 25 - UP UP - - UP 24 UP UP - - - 26 UP - - UP - UP 26 - UP UP - UP - 25 UP UP - - UP p7 UP - - UP - - 27 - UP UP - UP UP 26 UP UP - UP - 28 UP - - - UP UP 28 - UP UP UP - - 27 UP UP - UP UP pg UP - - - UP - 29 - UP UP UP - UP 28 UP UP UP - - 30 UP - - - - UP 30 - UP UP UP UP - 29 UP UP UP - UP 31 UP - - - - - 31 - UP UP UP UP UP 30 UP UP UP UP - 32 - UP UP UP UP UP 32 UP - - - - - 31 UP UP UP UP UP 33 - UP UP UP UP - 33 UP - - UP 34 UP UP UP - UP 34 UP - - UP - 35 - UP UP UP - 35 UP - - UP UP THIS TABLE FOR DIPS ss — uP UP - UP uP ss UP - - UP - - WITH WORD"UP° B 37 - UP UP - UP - 37 UP - - UP - UP 38 UP UP - - UP 38 UP - UP UP - DEVICE DIP SWITCH POSITION 39 UP UP - 39 UP - - UP UP UP ID 1 2 3 4 5 40 - UP - UP UP UP 40 UP - UP - - - 41 - UP - UP UP - 41 UP - UP - - UP 10 UP - UP - UP 42 UP - UP - UP 42 UP - UP - UP - 11 UP - UP - 43 - UP - UP - 43 UP - UP - UP UP 12 UP - UP UP 44 UP - - UP UP 44 UP - UP UP - 13 UP - - UP - 45 - UP - - UP - 45 UP - UP UP - UP 14 UP - UP 46 UP - - UP 46 UP - UP UP UP - 15 UP - 47 - UP - 47 UP - UP UP UP UP 16 UP UP UP UP 48 - UP UP UP UP 48 UP UP - 17 - UP UP UP - 49 - UP UP UP - 49 UP UP - - UP 18 UP UP - UP 50 - UP UP - UP 50 UP UP - - UP - 19 - UP UP - 51 - UP UP - 51 U UP - - UP UP 20 UP - UP UP 52 - UP - UP UP 52 UP UP - UP - 21 - UP - UP - 53 - UP - UP - 53 UP UP - UP - UP 22 UP - - UP 54 - UP - - UP 54 UP UP - UP UP - 23 - UP - 55 - UP - 55 UP UP - UP UP UP 24 - UP UP UP 56 - UP UP UP 56 UP UP UP - 25 - UP UP - 57 - UP UP - 57 UP UP UP - - UP 26 - UP - UP 58 - - - UP - UP 58 UP UP UP - UP - 27 - UP - 59 - UP - 59 UP UP UP - UP UP 28 - UP UP 60 - - - UP UP 60 UP UP UP UP - - 29 - UP - 61 - UP - 61 UP UP UP UP - UP 30 - UP 62 - - - - - UP 62 UP UP UP UP UP - 31 63 63 UP UP UP UP UP UP BIT BIT BIT VALUE: 16 8 4 2 1 VALUE: 32 16 8 4 2 1 VALUE: 32 16 8 4 2 1 -175 - DIP SWITCH TABLES FOR 5700 RF SYSTEM WIRELESS DEVICES HOUSE ID 5701 PANIC TRANSMITTER 5706/5707 SMOKE 5775 PIR SWITCH SETTING FOR ALL DETECTORTRANSMITTER DETECTOR/TRANSMITTER DEVICES EXCEPT 5716 HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) 0 o,P o�P MIRROR DEVICE DIP SWITCH POSITION �� Z 3 4 5� 6 DIP SIDE ID 1 2 3 4 5 V��P) 1 UP UP UP UP - a a���� z uP ua uP — ua �P HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) 3 UP UP UP — — SIDE �� a ua ua — uP uP DN VIEW(UP) 1� 2 3 4 5� 6 7 8 9 10 5 UP UP - UP - e �P �P �P �P �P POS6UP=XMTRID62 � aaaa�aaa�� �P s uP — uP uP — DN=XMTR ID 63 DN io UP - UP - UP HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) SIDE �r 11 UP - UP - - ,� �P - - �P �P 5727 KEYPAD � VIEW(UP) XMTR ID �s uP — — uP — 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 (32 SHOWN) UP=PULSE COUNT ia ua — — — ua �� � —=INST.MODE u uP — — — — a UP i6 - UP UP UP UP ��O HMTR oIPSWITCHPOSITION 17 - UP UP UP - O �O _ DN �� fi 7 8 9 18 - UP UP - UP 32 UP UP UP UP 19 - UP UP - - ` 2a - UP - UP UP ��P XMTR ID 33 UP UP UP - 34 UP UP UP 21 — UP — UP — (4H SHOWN� P P — — 22 - UP - - UP 36 UP UP UP 23 - UP - - - 37 UP UP 24 - - UP UP UP XMTR DIPSWITCHPOSIrION 38 UP UP zs — — uP uP — HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) XMTR ID 1° 6 � 8 ss uP — — — 27 - - UP - UP i FIXED AT 48 UP UP UP 40 - UP UP UP 28 - - - UP UP 49 11P UP - 41 - UP UP �� 2 3 5 ����'� 50 UP UP 42 UP UP 29 - - - UP a a a a� 1 11P - = 43 = UP - - 30 - - - - UP UP SIDE 52 UP UP 44 UP UP 37 53 UP 45 UP Bli VIEW 54 - - UP 46 UP vn�ue�. is s a z i DN (DN) ss a� — — — — 5715 571115711WM iMPORTnNr 5716 DOORIWINDOW TRANSMITTER UNIVERSAL TRANSMITTER DOORIWINDOW TRANSMITTER BATT RIY REM VED OO ��P SW4 Tw�NSMiiiEa — oiaswircnaasirioN io s s a a z i 1 UP UP UP UP UP TERMINAL—► z uP — uP uP uP uP BLOCK TERMINALS DIP W3 s — — ua uP uP uP 4 UP UP UP UP UP DIP 5 UP UP UP UP � 6 5 4 3 2 1 s uP _ _ uP uP uP O DIP DIP UP 8 UP UP UP UP UP UP � eaaaa� 9 UP UP UP UP SW4 10 UP - UP - UP UP HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) SIDE �p uP uP UP — uP uP i SIDE VIEW(UP) i3 — ua — — uP uP � 2 1�3 6 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 VIEW XMTR ID(33 SHOWN) � is UP - - - UP uP aB a��a��aaaa�� (�N� 16 UP UP UP UP = UP HOUSE ID(1 SHOWN) UP � - 17 UP UP UP UP 6 5�3� 18 UP UP UP UP DN �s — — uP uP — uP POS.�� DN=FOSTMRE~�E SE (33 SHOWN) POS.12:UP-N.O. SW3� a a a a�� pN za uP uP uP UP — uP POS.2:UP=NO COVER TAMPER (Avoid ID 32-37 with N.O.) zs — u u — — u 26 UP UP UP DN=COVER TAMPER(use N.C.setting) POS.6: UP=N.O. 2� — — uP — — uP DN=N.C. zs uP uP — — — uP 29 UP UP %MTR DIP SWITCH PaSITION 30 UP UP ID fi 7 8 9 10 11 XMTR oIPSWITCHPO5ITI0N HOUSE DIPSWITCHP051TION 31 UP 1 UP UP UP UP UP �� fi 7 8 9 10 11 �� 5 4 3 2 1 32 UP UP UP UP UP - 2 UP UP UP UP UP 33 UP UP UP UP � UP UP UP UP 33 - UP UP UP UP - 3 UP UP UP UP 34 UP UP UP UP Z UP UP 11P 11P 34 UP - UP UP UP - 4 UP UP UP UP UP 35 UP UP UP 3 UP UP UP 35 - - UP UP UP - 5 UP UP UP UP 36 UP UP UP UP 4 UP UP 11P UP 3 - P UP - 6 UP UP UP UP 37 UP UP UP S UP UP UP 37 - UP - UP UP - 7 UP UP UP 38 UP UP UP 6 UP 11P 11P 38 UP - - UP UP - 8 UP UP UP UP UP 39 UP UP 7 - - UP UP 39 - - - UP UP - 9 UP UP UP UP 40 UP UP UP UP e UP UP UP 11P 40 UP UP UP - UP - 10 UP UP UP UP 41 UP 11P UP 9 UP UP UP 41 - UP UP - UP - 1� UP UP UP 42 UP UP UP �D UP - UP - 11P 42 UP - UP - UP - 12 UP UP UP UP 43 UP UP it - - UP - UP 43 - - UP - UP - 13 UP UP UP 44 UP UP UP 12 UP UP l/P 4 P P - - - 14 UP UP UP 45 UP UP 13 UP UP - - - - 15 11P UP 46 UP UP 14 UP 11P 46 UP - - - UP - 16 UP UP UP UP UP 47 UP - - - �5 - - - �P - - - - - 17 UP UP UP UP 4$ UP UP UP UP i6 UP UP UP 11P - 48 UP UP UP UP - - 18 UP UP UP UP 49 U UP UP 17 - UP UP UP - 49 - UP UP UP - - 19 lJP UP UP 50 UP UP UP 18 UP UP 11P P - P P - - 20 UP UP UP UP 5� UP UP 19 UP UP 51 - - UP UP - - 21 UP UP UP 52 UP UP UP 20 UP UP - UP - 52 UP UP - UP - - 22 UP UP UP 53 UP UP 2� UP UP 53 - UP - UP - - 23 UP UP 54 UP UP 22 UP - - 11P - 54 UP - - UP - - 24 UP UP UP UP 55 UP 23 - - - �P - 55 - - - UP - - 25 U U U 56 UP UP UP Z4 UP UP UP 56 UP UP UP - - - 26 UP UP UP 57 - - - �P U 25 — UP UP - - 57 - UP UP - - - 27 UP UP 58 - - - UP UP 26 UP - UP - - 58 UP - UP - - - 28 UP UP UP 59 - - - UP - - - - - 59 - - �P - - - 29 UP - - - UP 6p - - - UP UP 28 UP UP - - - 60 UP UP - - - - 30 UP - - - UP g - - - - �p 29 - UP - - - 61 - UP - - - - 31 UP - - - - gz - - - - UP 30 UP 62 UP - - - - - 32 UP UP UP UP UP 63 31 - - - - - 63 - - - - - - BIT BIT - - - - - - BIT BIT VALUE: 32 16 8 4 2 1 VALUE 32 i6 8 4 2 1 VALUE'. 1 2 4 8 16 VALUE � 2 4 8 16 32 For 5700 series transmitters not shown in this table, refer to the instructions accompanying each transmitter. —176 — � ' • • � � Event Logging Commands Event Log Display=Code+[#] +60 (Alpha keypad only) Event Log Print=Code+ [#] +61 (Installer Only) Clear Event Log =Code+#+ 62 (Installer Only) Wireless System House Id Sniffer Mode=Code + [#] +2 (Installer Only) Commands Transmitter ld Test=Code+ [#] + 3 (Installer Only) Go/No Go Test=Code+5 (Test Key) User Code Commands Add A User Code=User Code+ 8+New User Number+New User's Code (Alpha keypad only) Change A Code=User Code+ 8 +User Number+New User's Code Delete A User's Code=Your User Code + 8 + User Number To Be Deleted + Your Code Again View User Capability=User's Code + * + * Set Real-Time Clock(Installer,Master Only)=Code+#+63 Arming Functions Arming Away Enter Code+Away [2]. Arming Stay Enter Code+Stay [3]. Arming Instant Enter Code+Instant [7]. Arming Maximum Enter Code+Maximum [4]. Quick Arm Use # Key Instead Of User Code Followed By Any Of The Above Arming Mode Keys. (Alpha keypad only) Global Arming If Enabled For The User, The Keypad Will Display A Prompt.Answer The Prompted Questions Disarming Enter Code+Off[1]. Bypassing Zones Enter Code + Bypass [6] + Zone Number. To Automatically Bypass All Faulted Zones,Use Quick Bypass "Quick Bypass" Method: Enter Code+Bypass + [#]. Chime Mode Enter Code + Chime [9]. To Turn Chime Mode Off, Enter Code+Chime Again. (Alpha keypad only) Partition Goto= User Code+ * +Partition Number 0-8 GOTO Home Partition=User Code+ * +0 Panics *+1 Zone 95 (A Key) *+#Zone 99 (B Key) #+3 Zone 96 (C Key) (Alpha keypad only) View Downloaded Messages=Press 0 For 5 Seconds Display All Zone Descriptors=Press * For 5 Seconds Display User Self Help=Hold Any Key For 5 Seconds Programming Commands Site Initiated Download=User Code+#+ 1 Direct Wire Download Enable=User Code+#+5 Enter Program Mode=Installer Code+ 800 Exit Program Mode=*99 Or*98 Scheduling Commands Installer Programmed Schedule Events=Installer Code+#+ 80 (Alpha keypad only) Temparary Schedule Editing=User Code + # + 81 (Installer, Master, Manager Only) Extend Closing Window=User Code+#+ 82 (Installer,Master,Manager Only) End User Output Device Programming=User Code+#+ 83 Output Device Control Activate Output Device As Programmed =User Code+#+71 (Alpha keypad only) Activate Output Device As Programmed=User Code+#+72 Activate Access Relay For Current Partition=User Code+0 Activate Output Device Manually=User Code+#70. —177 — ' � � VISTA 50P/VISTA 50PUL CONTROLS Physical: 12-1/2"W X 14-1/2"H X 3"D (VISTA SOP) 14-1/2"W X 18"H X 4.3"D (VISTA SOPUL) Electrical: VOLTAGE INPUT: From Ademco No. 1361 Plug-In Transformer(use 1361CN in Canada) or 4300 transformer(far X-10 installations)rated 16.SVAC,40 VA. ALARM SOUNDER OUTPUT: lOVDC-13.8VDC,2.8 amps max.,(UL1023,UL609 installations); 750mA less aux. current draw (UL985 installations). AUXILIARY POWER OUTPUT: 9.6VDC-13.SVDC,750mA max. For UL installations,the accessories connected to the output must be UL Listed,and rated to operate in the above voltage range. BACK-UP BATTERY: ]2VDC,4AH or 7AH gel cell. YUASA NP4-12 (12V,4AH) or NP7-12 (12V,7AH)recommended. STANDBY: 4 hours min.with 750 mA aux.load using 7 AH battery. CIRCUIT PROTECTORS: PTC circuit breakers are used on battery input to protect against reverse battery connections and on alarm sounder output to protect against wiring faults (Shorts). A solid state circuit breaker is used on auxiliary power output to protect against wiring faults (shorts). DIGITAL COMMUNICATOR FORMATS SUPPORTED: ADEMCO HIGH SPEED ADEMCO 4+2 EXPRESS ADEMCO LOW SPEED ADEMCO CONTACT ID SESCOA RADIONICS LOW SPEED LINE SEIZE: Double Pole RINGER EQUIVALENCE: 0.7B FCC REGISTRATION NO.: AC398U-68192-AL-E 4137AD/5137AD REMOTE KEYPADS Physical: Width: 8.4 inches Height: 4.75 inches Depth: 1.1 inches Electrical: Voltage Input: 12VDC Current Drain: 60 mA (4137AD) 90 mA (5137AD) Interface Wiring: RED: 12VDC input(+) auxiliary power BLUE: Not Used GREEN: Data to control panel YELLOW: Data from control panel BLACK: Ground and(-)connection from supplemental power supply. 6137/6139 Remote Keypad Physical: Width: 6.25 inches Height: 4.75 inches Depth: 1.25 inches (6137 = 1 inch ) Electrical: Voltage Input: 12VDC Current Drain: 100 mA(6139)/ 85mA(6137) Interface Wiring: RED: 12VDC input(+) auxiliary power BLUE: Not Used GREEN: Data to control panel YELLOW: Data from control panel BLACK: Ground and(-)connection from supplemental power supply. —178 — CONTACTING TECHNICAL SUPPORT PLEASE, Before you call Technical Support, be sure you: • READ THE INSTRUCTIONS! • Check all wiring connections. • Determine that the power supply and/or backup battery are supplying proper voltages. • Verify your programming information where applicable. • Be sure all keypads and devices are addressed properly. • Note the proper model number of this product, and the version level (if known) along with any documentation that came with the product. • Note your ADEMCO customer number and/or company name. Having this information handy will make it easier for us to serve you quickly and effectively. You may contact Technical Support via Toll Free Fax. Please include your return fax number. You will receive a reply within 24 hours. You may also contact Technical Support via modem to ATLIS-BBS, Tech Support's Electronic Bulletin Board System. Replies are posted within 24 hours. East Coast Technical Support: 1-800-645-7492 (8 a.m.-6 p.m. E.S.T.) West Coast Technical Support: 1-800-458-9469 (8 a.Yn.-S p.m. P.S.T.) Technical Support Fax Number: 1-800-447-5086 ATLIS-BBS Electronic Bulletin Board System: 1-516-496-3980 (1200 - 9600 Baud, 8 Data Bits, 1 Start/Stop Bit, No Parity) -179 - INDEX ASCII CHART ....................................... 117 740 81 Connector J7........................................... 72 Supervised RF ........................................ 49 747 .......................................................... 81 Consoles Maximum wire length............... 20 5711 ........................................................48 7720 ........................................................ 72 Contact ID Event Codes 5802MN................................................... 50 7920SE ................................................... 72 Table of .........................................144 5816 ........................................................51 A661031 Contact ID Re ortin 141, 143, 145 . ...... . . ............................ 81 p 9.............. 12/24 HOUR TIME AC Loss Ke ad Soundin 95 Cross-Zoning ...........................................91 STAMP FORMAT ....................83, 105 Yp g""""""""""' CTS ...83 ACLoss Siren ...................................................... 11361 ........................................ 13,86, 178 AC Outlet Ground................................15,86 Custom Index ..................................68, 121 1361CN ...................................................86 AC Power Loss ............................. Custom Message................................... 113 24-hour Audible Alarm ............................� External Alarm gg Custom Message Display ......................116 24-hour Auxiliary Alarm ...........................93 ................................ Custom Words ...............................113, 114 Keypad Sounding ............................ 88 24-hour Silent Alarm ...............................� AC Randomize .......................... . , gg Daily Open/Close Worksheet ................129 3+1 and 4+1 Expanded Formats ........... 142 Access Control .......................... 3, 126, 163 Daylight Savings Time ...........................105 3+1 and 4+1 Standard Formats ............ 142 Access Control Relay . . 105 DB25 ........................................................83 4+1 ........................................................145 Access Control Schedules............. 126, 136 Default Screen .......................................116 4+2 ........................................................145 Ademco 4+2 Express .................... 144, 178 Delay Closing Time ...............................163 4+2 Format ................................. .......... 142 Ademco Contact ID ...... 142, 144, 157, 178 Device Programming .....23,44,58,68, 118 4100SM ..................................... 16,82, 153 Ademco High Speed ..................... 144, 178 Dial Tone Detection..................................99 4137AD .......................................2,89, 178 Ademco LOW SPEED ...........................178 Dial Tone Pause.......................................98 4139SN ...................................................� Aiarm Re ort Code y� Digital Communicator 178 ............................ 4142TR ............................................. 14,57 Alarm Sounder Duration .................... 80,94 DIP Switch Tables................................. 174 X-10 ................................................... 14,57 Alpha Descriptors,entering ...................108 DIP Switches........................................... 49 4146 ................................................... . 76 ALPHA VOCABULARY ..........................117 Disable Download Callback.................... 104 4146 keyswitch ..........................................3 Amseco motor bell&box ........................ 81 Disarm Delay .........................................123 4190 ........................................................88 Amseco PAL 328N ................................. 75 Disarm Window .....................................137 4191SN ...................................................40 Arm Window 137 Disarming ........................................93, 161 4192CP ............................................. 40,88 Arm-Away ............................................... 93 Download Command Enables .................98 4192SD ............................................. 40,88 Arm-Stay ................................................. 93 Download ID No. ..................................... 98 4192SDT ...........................................40,88 Download Phone No. ..............................98 arm/disarm ............................................. 132 4194 ..................................................38,88 Arm/Disarm commands 132 Downloaded Messages ......................... 4197 ..................................................38,88 Armin Awa 161 Viewing ..........................................164 4204 Relay Module 9 Y .......................................... .................................� Armin Functions 161 DSR .........................................................83 4208 ..................................................39,88 Arming Instant ...................................161 DTR......................................................... 83 4275 . .39,88 ....................................... Dual Re ortin 100 ............................................... . Armin Maximum 161 P 9........................................ 4278 ............................................38,39,88 Arming Stay ...:...............................161 Duress................................................... 155 4281 ...................................RF Receiver 88 Arming Window .....................................106 Earth Ground Considerations ..................86 4281 H ......................................................41 ATLIS-BBS............................................. 179 ECP Address ...........................................62 4281 L ......................................................41 Audio Alarm Verification ..................... 4,69 EDP Printer ......................... . . .. . ......82 . .... . . . .. 4281 M ................................................ ... 41 Auto Armin . . 122 Enable 5800 RF Button Force Bypass...104 4285 VIP Module ...................... . . 65,66 Auto Disarming . 123 Enable 5800 RF Button Global Arm......[104 .... . . 4285 VIP Module........................ Options 67 Auto-Arm Delay ................... 106, 122, 126 Enable Dialer Reports........................... 101 4300 transformer ........................ .... 15,57 Auto-Arm warnin 106, 126 Enable Force Arm for Auto-Arm.............106 487-12 .....................................................21 Auto-Disarm Delay ........................ 106, 126 Enable GOTO for This Partition.............. 107 488-12 ................................. . .. . . . . . .21 Auxiliary Alarm Signaling Equipment......t 78 Enable J7 Triggers by Partition.............. 107 .. . . . .. . . . 5137AD ............................... 2,89, 113, 178 Auxiliary Device Current Draw Enable Open/Close Report for 5137TRK ............................. . . .. . .. . .71 Installer Code. .................................98 Worksheet...................................... 88 5700 Series Transmitter Supervision...... 46 Auxiliary Output Enable ............ 74,76, 104 Entry Warning ........................................ 101 5700 series wireless................................ 42 Entry/Exit Delay................................. . .92 5701 � Back-Up Battery .............................. 15, 178 EOL resistor ..........................22,28,32,76 ........................................ ............... Basic Hardwired Zones..................... .... 5706 ........................................................48 gasic Scheduling Menu Structure .........127 Event Log Printer On-Line................83, 105 5715WH ..................................................48 Batter 88 Event Log Types ..............................83, 105 5716 y .................................................... ........................................................� Battery Life .............................................. 49 Event Log Printer Connections ............... 82 5716WM ..................................................� Battery Selection Table........................... 89 Event Logging Procedures ......................83 5727 ........................................................48 Baud 1200 105 Event Log Report Codes ....................... 103 ............................................. 5742 ........................................................48 Baud 300 ................................................105 Exception Reports .................................123 5743 ........................................................48 Burg.Alarm Comm.Delay ....................101 Exit Delay Rese......................................t 90 5775 ........................................................48 Burg.Trigger For Response Type 8 ........ 96 Exit Error by User ....................................90 5800 Series Transmitter Input Types...... 49 gutton Transmitters 49 Exit Error by Zone ...................................90 5800 series transmitters ..........................49 gypass Commands ...............................132 Exit Error Logic ........................................90 5800TM ...................................................44 B assin Zones 161 Express Reporting..................................145 ................................... 5801 ..................................................49,50 Cabinet Lock 0 False Alarm Reduction ............................90 5802 .................................................. 49,50 California State Fire Marshal .................171 FCC ....................................................... 172 5802CP ............................................. 49,50 Call Waitin Defeat 103 FCC Registration No .............................178 5802MN .............................................. ....49 Call Waiting Defeat Logic ..................... 91 Federal Communications Commission 5803 ...................:..............................49,50 Canadian Department of (FCC)Statement 172 ................................... 5806 ................... ....................................� Communications 173 First Test Report Time ...........................100 5816 .......................... ........................................................49 Check Messages.................................. 168 Force Arm .....................................123, 126 5817 ..................................................49,51 Check-in Signal ....................................... 49 Formats .................................................141 5818 ........................................................51 Checksum ....................................... 99, 145 General Information .................................72 5827 ........................................................49 Chime Mode 161 Global Arm .............................................162 5827BD .......................................44,48,49 Chime on External Siren ................. 80, 104 Global Disarm ........................................ 162 5849 ........................................................51 Circuit Protectors . 178 GoTo ......................................................163 5881 RF Receiver ...................................� Cold Water Pipe ................................ 15,86 Ground Start Module ...............................74 5882L/5882H ...........................................41 Comm. Failure .......................................167 Handshake ............................................141 5890 ........................................................51 Comm.Split Report Selection.................103 High Speed ............................................145 6137,6128,4137AD ...............................� Common Characteristics of Holiday Definitions&Schedule 6139 .................................... 2,89, 113, 178 Worksheet .....................................131 Polling Loop Zones......................... 33 6139,5137AD .........................................� Common Characteristics of Holiday Schedules..........................126, 131 6139TRK .................................................� Wireless Zones............................... 41 IEI 735L series detectors......................... 30 675 ....................................................72,88 Common Lobby Logic ................................6 IgnoreExpansion Zone Tamper............... 96 675 Ground Start Module.................. 13,74 Communication Defaults ......................... 16 Installer Code ..........................................9� 702.......................................................... 81 Compatible Glass Break Detectors......... 30 Installer's Message ................................ 116 702 sirens................................................ 80 Confirmation of Arming Ding ................... g5 Intelligent Test Reporting .........................96 719 ..........................................................81 Connecting a 4100SM Module for .............. Interference Handbook.......................... 172 719 sirens ................................................� Direct Wire Downloading ...............153 Interior w/Deiay .......................................93 -180 - Interior, Follower .....................................92 REPORT CODES FOR ZONES 65-80...103 Time-Driven Event Worksheet ..............132 J7 ............................................................� RESPONSE TYPES ..............................101 timers ..................................................... 139 JB............................................................. 82 RESTORE REPORT TIMING................101 TOUCH-TONE OR ROTARY DIAL.........97 Keypad Connections ...............................21 Restrict....................................................123 TOUCH-TONE W/ROTARY Keypad Panic Enables ...........................95 Restrict disarm.........................................126 BACKUP.........................................103 Keypads ..................................................20 Restriction................................................62 Trouble by Day/Alarm by Nigh ...............t 93 Keyswitch Assignment 76,77,95 RF RCVR CHECK-IN INTERVAL............44 Trouble Conditions ................................168 Limitation of Access............................... 123 RF RCVR SUPERVISION CHECK-IN I Turning The System Over To The User 167 Limitation of Access by Time Worksheet 136 NTERVAL ..................................... 102 UL 15,21 Limited Warranty ................................... 184 RF TRANSMITTER CHECK-IN UL AC LOSS SIREN ............................... 95 Line Seize ............................................. 178 NTERVAL.........................................52 UL Household Fire/Burglary applications 45 Loop Number........................................... 37 RF TRANSMITTER CHECK-IN I UL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS. 170 LORRA ................................................3,72 NTERVAL .......................................103 UL installations ........................................65 Low Speed Format...................99, 144, 145 RF TX LOW BATTERY REPORT UL Listed applications .............................74 Manager Code ............................... 155, 158 ENABLE...........................................52 UL1023 Household&UL609 Commercial Manual Relay Activation Mode RF TX LOW BATTERY REPORT Burglary Installations .......................80 (70 Mode).......................................165 ENABLE......................................... 102 UL365 POLICE STATION CONNECTED Master Code...........................155, 157, 158 RING DETECTION COUNT...............67,99 BURGLAR ALARM .......................170 Master Keypad Setup ................................8 RINGER EQUIVALENCE ......................178 UL609 GRADE A LOCAL MERCANTILE Menu Mode .............................................49 ringer equivalence number.....................172 PREMISES/LOCAL MERCANTILE Menu Mode Programming ...................... 19 RJ31X ....................................................172 SAFE&VAULT ............................. 170 Modem ..................................................153 RS232 ..................................................... 83 UL611/UL1610 CENTRAL STATION Mounting the Cabinet .............................. 10 Schedule number ...................................132 BURGLARY ALARM .....................171 Multiple Alarm Soundings .......................96 Programming .........................................126 Unsupervised RF 49 Multiple Alarms ........................................80 SCHEDULING RELATED DIALER USE PARTITION DESCRIPTORS........ 107 Multiple Alarms ........................................96 REPORTS .....................................106 User Codes ............................................ 155 Multiple Partition Access ....................... 158 SECONDARY FORMAT......................... 99 Adding a Master Manager or Operator ..158 Non-Alarm Report Codes....................... 100 SECONDARY PHONE NUMBER...........\97 Changeing a Master Manager or Normally Closed or EOLR .......................98 SECONDARY SUBSCRIBER ACCT .....101 Operator ........................................ 158 Normally Closed or EOLR(Zones 2-8) ...30 SCHEDULING OPTIONS ......................122 Deleting a Master Manager or Not Ready ............................................. 161 SETTING THE REAL-TIME CLOCK .....154 Operator ........................................ 158 NP4-12 ............................................89, 178 Section 22 General Information ............................... 155 NP7-12 ............................................89, 178 KEYPAD FUNCTIONS ..................161 Using The Built-In Number of Partitions ............................. 105 Section 23 User's Manual ................................164 Open/Close Reporting.................... 126, 132 TESTING THE SYSTEM ...............166 Viewing Data Fields .................................17 Open/Close Reporting SEND CANCEL IF ALARM+OFF VIP Module ..............................................65 for Keyswitch..............................77,98 (partition-specific)......................... 104 VIP MODULE PHONE CODE .................67 Open/Ciose Schedules .........125, 128, 130 Serial Number Learning/Deleting ...........111 VIP MODULE PHONE CODE................. 95 Operator Code ...................................... 158 SESCOA ................................................178 Voitage Triggers ..................................3,72 Operator Level A ................................... 155 Sescoa/Radionics ..................................145 WIRELESS KEYPAD Operator Level B ................................... 155 SESCOA/RADIONICS SELECT.............100 ASSIGNMENT .................................52, 104 Operator Level C ................................... 155 SOUNDER OPTION .......................24, 119 WIRELESS KEYPAD Optional Expansion Zones ........................ 1 SOUNDERS TAMPER DETECT........................ 103 Output Devices ........................................58 Compatible ..................................... 81 wireless"keys" .........................................49 PA400 ......................................................79 External .......................................... 79 Wireless Zone Assignments for PA400B ...................................................81 SPECIFICATIONS .................................178 5700 Series Transmitters ................47 PA400R ...................................................81 Standard Phone Line Connections .........12 wiring length/gauge chart ........................20 PABX ................................................ 13,97 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT X-10 .........................................................56 Panic Keys ..............................................93 PRIMARY........................................100 ZONE 9 FAST/NORMAL RESPONSE ....30 Partition Descriptors .............................. 115 STANDARD/EXPANDED REPORT ZONE 9 RESPONSE TIME ................... 94 Partitioning ................................................ 5 SECONDARY............................... 100 Zone Cust Perimeter Burglary. ................................. 92 STANDBY CURRENT DRAW ................ 88 Deleting a zone ...............................63 Permanent Keypad Display Backlight.... 103 START .................................................... 60 ZONE DESCRIPTOR ............................113 Phone Line Connections......................... 12 Start Event ...................................... 61 Zone Descriptors ...................................113 Polling Loop .......................................33,88 Start Time ......................................128 Zone List Polling Loop Current Draw Worksheet ....88 STOP ...................................................... 60 Deleting ...........................................63 Power Up in Previous State ..............88,96 substitute word ................................68, 121 Zone List Programming ...........................63 Power-Up Procedure ......................... 13,86 SUMMARY ............................................. 184 ZONE PROG7, .......................................36 Prevent Fire Time-out........................80, 95 SUMMARY OF CONNECTIONS ...........184 ZONE PROG? ...................................30,52 Prevent Zone XX Bypass ...................... 98 Supervised Fire ....................................... 93 Zone Programming ................................109 Primary Format ........................................99 SUPERVISION PULSES FOR LORRA .107 ZONE RESPONSE TYPE .......................67 Primary Phone Number ...........................97 Supplementary Power Supply ................ 21 ZONE RESPONSE TYPES ....................94 Primary Subscriber Acct ..........................97 SUPPRESS TX SUPERVISION Zone Type ...........................31,36,53, 109 PRINTER BAUD RATE..................... 83 105 SOUND...........................................104 ZONE TYPE RESTORES .................... 100 Programming Alpha Descriptors............ 113 SUPPRESS TX SUPERVISION Zone Types ..............................................61 Programming The Wireless Receiver.......44 SOUNDING ..................................... 52 Programming Time Windows.................129 Swinger Suppression .............................. 96 QUICK ARM...........................................162 SWINGER SUPPRESSION ( QUICKARM (partition-specific) ............. 97 partition-specific)........................... 101 RADIONICS LOW SPEED.....................178 System Operation ................................... 61 RANDOMIZE AC LOSS REPORT..........[95 tamper protection .................................... 49 real-time clock..........................................83 TECHNICAL SUPPORT RECEIVER TYPE ..................................103 CONTACT .....................................179 Relay Action .............................................60 Temporary schedule Worksheet ............137 relay activated events.............................126 Temporary Schedules ............................137 relay commands.....................................132 Programming .........................................138 relay descriptors.....................................113 TEST REPORT INTERVAL..................... 96 Relay Group.............................................62 THE MECHANICS OF PROGRAMMING 16 RELAY PROG?........................................60 the Open/Close Trigger ...........................75 RELAY TIMEOUT XX MINUTES)..........105 Time Driven ............................................. 56 RELAY TIMEOUT YY SECONDS.......... 105 Time Window ................................ 128, 136 Relay Voice Descriptors...........................63 Beginning .......................................133 Relays and Powerline Carrier devices......56 During ............................................133 Remote Keypad Sounding.......................76 End .................................................133 Remote Keyswitch.....................................76 time window number ..............................132 REPORT CODES FOR EVENT LOG......83 Time Windows 1 .............................. 24, 126 REPORT CODES FOR Time Windows Definitions Worksheet ...128 ZONES 01-64,81-91,95-99)..........100 Time-Driven Event Programming ..........134 -181 - WARNING! THE LIMITATIONS OF THIS ALARM SYSTEM While this System is an advanced wireless security system, it does not offer guaranteed protection against burglary, fire or other emergency. Any alarm system,whether commercial or residential, is subject to compromise or failure to warn for a vari- ety of reasons. For example: Intruders may gain access through unprotected openings or have the technical sophistication to bypass an alarm sensor or disconnect an alarm warning device. Intrusion detectors (e.g., passive infrared detectors), smoke detectors, and many other sensing devices will not work with- out power. Battery-operated devices will not work without batteries, with dead batteries, or if the batteries are not put in properly. Devices powered solely by AC will not work if their AC power supply is cut off for any reason, however briefly. • Signals sent by wireless transmitters may be blocked or reflected by metal before they reach the alarm receiver. Even if the signal path has been recently checked during a weekly test, blockage can occur if a metal object is moved into the path. • A user may not be able to reach a panic or emergency button quickly enough. • While smoke detectors have played a key role in reducing residential fire deaths in the United States,they may not activate or provide early warning for a variety of reasons in as many as 35°/o of all fires, according to data published by the Federal Emergency Management Agency. Some of the reasons smoke detectors used in conjunction with this System may not work are as follows. Smoke detectors may have been improperly installed and positioned. Smoke detectors may not sense fires that start where smoke cannot reach the detectors, such as in chimneys, in walls, or roofs, or on the other side of closed doors. Smoke detectors also may not sense a fire on another level of a residence or building. A second floor de- tector, for example, may not sense a first floor or basement fire. Finally, smoke detectors have sensing limitations. No smoke detector can sense every kind of fire every time. In general, detectors may not always warn about fires caused by carelessness and safety hazards like smoking in bed, violent explosions, escaping gas, improper storage of flammable materials, overloaded electrical circuits, children playing with matches, or arson. Depending on the nature of the fire and/or location of the smoke detectors, the detector, even if it operates as anticipated, may not provide sufficient warning to allow all occupants to escape in time to prevent injury or death. Passive Infrared Motion Detectors can only detect intrusion within the designed ranges as diagrammed in their installation manual. Passive Infrared Detectors do not provide volumetric area protection. They do create multiple beams of protection, and intrusion can only be detected in unobstructed areas covered by those beams. They cannot detect motion or intrusion that takes place behind walls, ceilings, floors, closed doors, glass partitions, glass doors, or windows. Mechanical tampering, masking, painting or spraying of any material on the mirrors, windows or any part of the optical system can re- duce their detection ability. Passive Infrared Detectors sense changes in temperature; however, as the ambient tempera- ture of the protected area approaches the temperature range of 90° to 105°F (32° to 40°C), the detection performance can decrease. • Alarm warning devices such as sirens, bells or horns may not alert people or wake up sleepers if they are located on the other side of closed or partly open doors. If warning devices are located on a different level of the residence from the bed- rooms, then they are less likely to waken or alert people inside the bedrooms. Even persons who are awake may not hear the warn ing if the alarm is muffled by noise from a stereo, radio, air conditioner or other appliance, or by passing traffic. Fi- nally, alarm warning devices, however loud, may not warn hearing-impaired people. • Telephone lines needed to transmit alarm signals from a premises to a central monitoring station may be out of service or temporarily out of service.Telephone lines are also subject to compromise by sophisticated intruders. Even if the system responds to the emergency as intended, however, occupants may have insufficient time to protect them- selves from the emergency situation. In the case of a monitored alarm system, authorities may not respond appropriately. • This equipment, like other electrical devices, is subject to component failure. Even though this equipment is designed to last as long as 20 years,the electronic components could fail at any time. The most common cause of an alarm system not functioning when an intrusion or fire occurs is inadequate maintenance.This alarm system should be tested weekly to make sure all sensors and transmitters are working properly. The security console (and remote keypad)should be tested as well. Wireless transmitters (used in some systems) are designed to provide long battery life under normal operating conditions. Longevity of batteries may be as much as 4 to 7 years, depending on the environment, usage, and the specific wireless device being used. External factors such as humidity, high or low temperatures, as well as large swings in temperature, may all reduce the actual battery life in a given installation. This wireless system, however, can identify a true low battery situation, thus allowing time to arrange a change of battery to maintain protection for that given point within the system. Installing an alarm system may make the owner eligible for a lower insurance rate, but an alarm system is not a substitute for insurance. Homeowners, property owners and renters should continue to act prudently in protecting themselves and continue to insure their lives and property. We continue to develop new and improved protection devices. Users of alarm systems owe it to themselves and their loved ones to learn about these developments. —182 — WARNING:OWNER'S INSTRUCTION NOTICE NOT TO BE REMOVED WEEKLY TESTING IS REQUIRED TO ENSURE PROPER OPERATION OF THIS SYSTEM. NOTES: 1. Zone 1 may be selected for EOLR supervised COMPLIES WITH FCC RULES,PART 68 �7 Header JS Header MAKE CONNECTIONS USING or normally closed(no EOLR)operetion via FCC REGISTRATION NO.AC398U-68192-AL-E cutjumper. (Cut red�umper for normally closed RINGER EQUIVALENCE:O7B 1.Not Used 1. In 2(Printer DTR) Optional programming� No.4142TR CABLE operation.Do not cut for Fire Usage).Zones 2-8 THIS DEVICE COMPLIES WITH PART 15 OF 2_Ground- 2. Ground Out 1:Open/close or keypad-like sounding may be selected for either operation via program FCC RULES.OPERATION IS SUBJECT TO THE 3.Out 1(Ground Start) 3. In 3(4300 sync) Out 2:Armed LED fieid'41. 4.Ground- 4. In 4(4300 sync) Out 4:Ready�ED �00�0�0�� J8 2. Zone 1 supports 2-wire smoke detectors. FOLLOWING TWO CONDITIONS(1)THIS DEVICE 5.Out 2(fire) 5. Ground Ratings for Out 1: See Instaliation Instructions for recommended type MAY NOT CAUSE HARMFUL INTERFERENCE,AND 6.Ground- 6. Out 5(4300 data) Active:tOVDG13.8VDC through 4k OHMS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 and maximum number of detectors supported. (2)THIS DEVICE MUST ACCEPT ANY INTERPERENCE 7.Out 3(burg/aud.panic)7. Out 6(Printer RXD)Not Active:100 OHMS to ground BATTERY 3. Zone 7 may be used for remote keyswitch armingldisarming.RECEIVED,INCLUDING INTERFERENCE S.Ground 8. Ground Rahngs for out 2-4: TABS See Installation Instructions for wiring instructions. THAT MAY CAUSE UNDESIRED OPERATION. 9.Out 4(silent panic/ 9. Ground Active:tOVDG13.8VDC through Sk OHMS duress Not Active:lkOHMStoground O�DO00�00 J7 ; 4. Zone 8 supports 2-wire latching type glass break detectors. � (Refer to Installation Instructions for information conceming Direct Wire See Installation Instructions for recommended type and Red Jumper pownloadin and rinter connections usin the 4100SM Serial Module 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Connect to o � maximum number of detectors su orted. (note 1) 9 P g �) 12VDC,4AH � of12VDC,7AH ZONE2ZONE3 ZONE4 ZONES ZONE6 ZONE7 ZONEB ZONE9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 GEL CELL BATTERY ! ������ ��� ��������� �� �� � � � � ZONE 1 + - 2 a Q 2T CHARGING m p� Q-� ������,� VOLTAGE m� m �Q" � � � DOC LOAD NO.:5 13.7VDC -�°-�° � - + - + ---- + - + ¢O a `�/"'_�r See Connect to z ° �� ° p 9 Installation o p m Handset Incomin Instructions for Z4hr.120VAC, O t - N.C. N.C. N.C. N.C. w� �°o O Phone Line EARTH GROUND 60 Hz Outlet �' a� a� �� `-��� Connect to good earth required c� p m >v _= �9 capacity Z Red Blk Gm Yel Y p v �F � z Telephone connections ground to maintain im- Z REMOTE KEYPAD p Z �w �� using Ademco No.620 munity to transients. Replace O Use4137AD161 3 7161 2 8 � �O ?o E o '� RJ31X direct connect See Instructions for v �p N N.O. N.O. N.O. N.Q vQ �N a cord. propergrounding. every 5137ADI6139 w 3 years TRANSFORMER z (Addressabie keypads)only �w o ¢� a� 16.5VAC,40VA �W a Jm WARNING:TO PREVENT ADEMCO No.1361 See Installation Instructions N o,'� 2k EOLR 2k EOLR 2k EOLR 2k EOLR QN CANADA for max#of keypads N (note 1) (note 1) (note 1) (note 1,3) + - + RISK OF ELECTRICAL USoN43006fCN) andformaxwirerunlength. Q + + 4190 SHOCK,DISCONNECT X-10 DEVICES ' =F------- ADEMCO LIMITED WARRANTY Alarm Device Manufacturing Company, a Division of Pittway Corporation, and its divisions, subsidiaries and affiliates("Seller"), 165 Eileen Way, Syosset, New York 11791, warrants its products to be in conformance with its own plans and specifications and to be free from defects in materials and workmanship under normal use and service for 18 months from the date stamp control on the product or,for products not having an Ademco date stamp,for 12 months from date of original purchase unless the installation instructions or catalog sets forth a shorter period, in which case the shorter period shall apply. Seller's obligation shall be limited to repairing or replacing, at its option, free of charge for materials or labor, any product which is proved not in compliance with Seller's specifications or proves defective in materials or workmanship under normal use and service. Seller shall have no obligation under this Limited Warranty or otherwise if the product is altered or improperly repaired or serviced by anyone other than Ademco factory service. For warranty service, return product transportation prepaid, to Ademco Factory Service, 165 Eileen Way, Syosset, New York 11791. THERE ARE NO WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, OF MERCHANTABILITY, OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR OTHERWISE, WHICH EXTEND BEYOND THE DESCRIPTION ON THE FACE HEREOF. IN NO CASE SHALL SELLER BE LIABLE TO ANYONE FOR ANY CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES FOR BREACH OF THIS OR ANY OTHER WARRANTY, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, OR UPON ANY OTHER BASIS OF LIABILITY WHATSOEVER, EVEN IF THE LOSS OR DAMAGE IS CAUSED BY THE SELLER'S OWN NEGLIGENCE OR FAULT. Seller does not represent that the products it sells may not be compromised or circumvented;that the products will prevent any personal injury or property loss by burglary, robbery, fire or otherwise; or that the products will in all cases provide adequate warning or protection. Customer understands that a properly installed and maintained alarm may only reduce the risk of a bur- glary, robbery,fire or other events occurring without providing an alarm, but it is not insurance or a guarantee that such will not occur or that there will be no personal injury or property loss as a result. CONSEQUENTLY, SELLER SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY PERSONAL INJURY, PROPERTY DAMAGE OR OTHER LOSS BASED ON A CLAIM THE PRODUCT FAILED TO GIVE WARNING. HOWEVER, IF SELLER IS HELD LIABLE,WHETHER DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, FOR ANY LOSS OR DAMAGE ARISING UNDER THIS LIMITED WARRANTY OR OTHERWISE, REGARDLESS OF CAUSE OR ORIGIN, SELLER'S MAXIMUM LIABILITY SHALL NOT IN ANY CASE EXCEED THE PURCHASE PRICE OF THE PRODUCT, WHICH SHALL BE THE COMPLETE AND EXCLUSIVE REMEDY AGAINST SELLER. This warranty replaces any previous warranties and is the only warranty made by Seller on this product. No increase or alteration, written or verbal,of the obligations of this Limited Warranty is authorized. ADEMCO GF� OUP 165 Eileen Way, Syosset, New York 11791 Copyright O 1997 PITTWAY CORPORATION III II IIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIIII IIIII I III N5944-6V1 Rev B 4/99 Irtst2�l��ti�n I�struction far Power S�uperv�sivn M�dute � �o4-�v �� �� r���+��-. �-, � � � w�« _ # _ � �, a s � r � s x � �. u+�r � � � � °� ��t�t � �� � _-� eno[�c u+� � � �.,� �.� zi�4-121�4V � � �� � � � e-�.�-� �-^--•,.•-^-� a�t�acror -. # � _ # � 4 �' 2 l f iS 8 l 3', g } L� � POYV�Ti � rpd SuPERw�90N �+ r. �q � R ' �£E4EGtwC`«qt�CS,) � �� � . �r+ � ! _ �� � �,� � ` �.,.� aa4-���a�v � �, ,� ,�,�.- ���., � ,� �. � � . � ���-�-. --�-� �� - + - + - + � a '3 s � � a s a s x + r s a a s i uNrt �* ;: . y�{..., - � 47dP�C�9�G+,L BPEp� � _ _ . . . . �� _ _ .. , . ... - . . .. ' i�1� h�d� . � � .... � - � I AL IFI Power 5upervisivn IJnit�{!4-BV Power�upenri:ion Clnit�Q4-12PZ4Y �peraring Vo�tage 5.1 - 15 VQC pperating Voltage 8.5-33 VDC Operating Current 33 mA� B VC}C;fi5 mA � i2 VDC C}perating Curr�nt i4 mA i� 12 VDC;2B mA� 24 Vp� Contact Rating{resistiv�e) 2A �2f'i VC1C or 115 VAC C4ntaict Rating (resisti►r�J 2 A � 26 VDC or 115 VAC INSTALLATiQN INSTRUCT�ON$ t.Cnnnect�rown initiating leads as indicated suah that t'�e end of line 3.Neatly dress wires and power su�pervi�ion�nit into device is Gann�ected in serses with the pawer supervising�ont��t, junctian�ax. �see wiring diagram) 4.Mount detector ac�arding to manufaeturers installatinn 2.Gonnect appropriate controi leads as shr�wn. Red incoming and red instructians. from modu�e ta terminal i. 81ack incoming and bla�[fram rr�oduke to t+errninal 2. � � � � Sentrol,Inc. Cmrporate H�dquurtera; sem�a,i�+c.�+n��s� t 2�35 SW Levetan Dri+ua ��csuor�+�rr�nu�r�o�ca. Tualatin,C}€i 97U62 U.S.&Csnada.8U0-547•2556 C�e9+Se�mi,ir�. I�,r FR;l�.Q Q[3£.�'�°,�43 F S E N T Ft O l E N C 503�92-4452 Tachnics�Supp[1rt:8Ij0-B48-i4c4 �Prkrted on rocycbd paper e�ae��o� �az�aEV.B ESL 405-05 and 405-06 Relay Modules � Installation Instructions o� CSFM LISTED 405-05 Polarity Reversal Relay Module For use with 4-Wire Sounder Smoke Detectors and Fire/BurglarAlarm Control Panels � Installation Instructions Testing: 405-05 l. Choose a mounting]ocation in the control panel within reach of 1. Test in accordance with NFPA 72 Chapter 7 Test Methods& the]eads provided.Use 50/50 water to isopropyl alcohol to Frequencies,interfacing equipment. clean the mounting surface.After the surface has dried,remove 2, To test the 405-OS initiate an alarm with smoke or approved protective covering from the tape. Mount unit as shown on test method on any detector connected to the control panel control panel illustration.Route wires to the appropriate via the 405 relay. In alarm,detectors that have responded to terminals as noted below. smoke or test will sound in their distinct alarm patterns. 2. Connect 405-OS trigger wires to the fire alarm output terminals. 3. Reset the smoke detectors by removing power to the Observe polariry. [Gray wire to positive(+)and White wire to detectors. negative(-)]. Note:For two wire smoke detectors,use the ESL 405-01 or 3. Connect 405-OS incoming power wires to the smoke detector 405-03 polarity reversal relay module. power source. [White-Red to(+)and White-Black to(-)]. 4. Connect 405-OS outgoing power wires to the smolce detector power in terminals.[Red to(+)and Black to(-)]. 5. Connect the smoke detector initiating circuit(alarm]oop)to the alarm control. --�------- 6. Maintenance:no maintenance is required. o ���`°°��" Powe� O +Bell Warning o° _�"°°" �o�e oi �o�e oz �o�e oa �o�e oa e os oa This polarity reversal device may not be compatible with all � � �o�O o�O o�O�o o o�o ' power supervision relays.When using ESL 405 Series polarity reversal relays on four wire circuits,use the ESL �,^� 204 Series power supervision relay at the end of line.Note: Another option is to use an ESL 449CTE(or CSTE with Typical 405-05 Mounting Locations Sounder)which incorporates an End-of-Line/Sensitivity in the Contro�Panel Status Relay Output. This polarity reversal device cannot be connected to any � coded annunciator. ESL 405-05 Polarity Reversal Relay Module Burglar/Fire ESL 405-05 Alarm Control Polarity Reversal Relay White ESL 400 Series Smoke Alarm — Detectors Output + Gra with Sounders White/Black ESL 204-12/24V Black Power Supervision Relay Power _ Supply W ite/Red + Red + + Alarm Loop End of Line Device 405-06 DPDT Relay Module For use as a Universal Switch Device Installation Instructions NC White-Red 1. Connect 405-06 trip wires to trigger circuit.Observe Red polarity.[Gray to positive(+)and White to negative(-)]. CoM 2. Connect the 405-06 DPDT relay contacts as required. N O white-Blue The first set of contacts are: common red NC White-Black closed white-red COM Black open white-blue 3. The second set of contacts are: N O Blue common black �------- - --- ------ -- -------------------, closed white-black � I � , � , open blue � ', � , 4. When fail safe operation is required,wire the relay in the ; '� � powered or energized condition. ; '� � I 5. Do not exceed rating of relay. � ' � , 6. Testing: 405-06 � I � , Test unit in accordance with NFPA 72 Chapter 7 Test '------------------------------------------ ---�� Methods and Frequencies, interface equipment. ESL 405-06 � � To test the 405-06,energize the relay coi]and confirm the DPDT Relay � � contacts tranfer. � + Specifications for 405-05 � 405-06 Operating voltage..........................................................8.5-33 VDC Maximum operating current...........................34.0 mA at 12 VDC 35.0 mA at24 VDC Relay contacts............................2 A at 30 VDC,1 A at 120 VAC Operating temperature................32°F to 120°F(0°C to 49°C) Operating humidity range.................0 to 85%Non-condensing Dimensions..................................1.8 in.(4.6 cm)x 1.7 in.(43 cm) Wire connections............... 18 AWG stranded,tinned, 18"long SENTROL-CADDX Sentrol-Caddx reserves the right 12345 SW Leveton Dr.,Tualatin,OR 97062 to change specifications without notice. Tel.: 503.692.4052 Fax: 503.691.7566 E [� T � http//www sentrol com 02000 Sentrol-Caddx J L U.S.&Canada: 800.547.2556 Technical Service: 800.648.7424 A P R O D U C T O F S E N T R O L FaxBack: 1.800.483.2495 12859 Rev B 07/00 ESL 429/449 Series ' � Self-Diagnostic Photoelectric � Smoke Detectors Installation Instructions California State Fire Marshal Approved O MEA(New York City)Approved FM VL APPROVED ��STED Description The ESL 429/449 Series low-profile,self-diagnostic,two-wire and Where to Locate the Required Smoke Alarms in New Construc- four-wire smoke detectors work on the light scattering principle.A tion. pulsed infrared light-emitting diode serves as the light source,and a All of the smoke alarms specified for existing construction are high-speed photo-diode as the sensing element.This design has required and,in addition,a smoke alarm is required in each superior protection against false alanns caused by dust,insects, bedroom. RF,and ambient light. These smoke detectars are especially suited far residential occupancies,including hotels,motels,and dormitories,as well as A. other commercial and industrial fire-system applications.This oining Kitcnen gedroom aedroom Room series is designed for two-wire and four-wire connection to 6-24 � � VDC fire alarm control panels,UL Listed for commercia]ar � household fire protection. Living Room gedroom Features � Self-diagnostics including automatic sensitivity testing. Each detector in the series continually monitars its own sensitiviry and operational status(see Maintenance). A wide range of optional features are offered as shown in the Product Selection Guide. To provide for almost any application, B. Tv Room �ining Kitchen Bedroom these options include a built-in sounder,an auxiliary relay,an Room � integral heat detector,and an isolated heat detector. � Selecting a Location LivingRoom Bedroom Selecting a suitable location is critical to the operation of smoke � � � alarms. This equip�nent should be installed in accordance with the National Fire Protection Association's(NFPA)Standard 72. See Bedroom Figure 1. � A-11-8.3.a Where to Locate the Reguired SmokeAlarms in Existing Construction. The major threat from fire in a family living unit occurs at nigl�t when everyone is asleep.The principal threat to persons in sleeping areas comes from fires in the remainder of the unit. Therefore,a smoke ala��rn(s)is best located between the bedroom C. areas and the rest of the unit.In units with only one bedroom area on one floor,the smoke alarm(s)should be located as shown in � � � Figure 1 A. Bedroom Bedroom In family living units with more than one bedroom area ar with more than one floor,more than one smoke alarm is required,as shown in Figure 1 B. � Living Dining In addition to smoke alarms outside of the sleeping areas,the Room Room installarion of a smoke alarm on each additional story of the family living unit,including the basement,is required.These installations � are shown in Figure 1 C.The living area smoke alarm should be Basement installed in the living room or near the stairway to the upper level, or in both locations.The basement smoke alarm should be installed in close proximity to the stairway leading to the floor above.Where installed on an open-joisted ceiling,the alarm should be placed on �=Required smoke alarms the bottom of the joists.The alarm should be positioned relative to � =Additional smoke alarms required for new construction the stairway to intercept smoke coming from a fire in the basement before the smoke enters the stairway. Figure 1 . Detector Location ESL 429/449 1 e� e�� — e-� — <� a" -� 0 ` (10cm) � . ceiling A A � � �� acceptable here � 4 � (10cm) neverhere r � �2„ (30cm) Fi ure 3. Plu in Terminal Block top of detector—I maximum 9 9-� acceptable here Note �O�e s�de Wau For instructions on removal of terminal block and Measurementsshownaretothe circuitboard,call technical services at 800-648-7424. closest edge of the detector. � _ Figure 2. Detector Placement 4"squareor test switch WIREMOLD mounting (No.5739) mounting allboxes single gang Are More Sm oke Alarms Desirable? a"octago� The required number of smoke alarms might not provide reliable mounting early warning protection for those areas separated by a door �� from the areas protected by the required smoke alarms.For this reason,it is recommended that the householder consider the use cover release of additional smoke alarms for those areas for increased protection.The additional areas indude the basement,bed- rooms,dining room,furnace room,utility room,and hallways Figure 4. Detector Mounting not protected by the required smoke alarms.The installation of smoke alarms in kitchens,attics(finished or unfinished),or garages is not normally recommended,as these locations occasionally experience conditions that can result in improper operation. �n sta I I at i o n Important! The detectars mount to standard single-gang electrical boxes, Regulations pertaining to smoke detector four-inch octagonal or four-inch square electrical boxes,or on installations vary from state to state.For more WIREMOLD No.5739 fixture boxes.The detectors may also be information,contact your local fire department mounted directly to walls or ceilings where local codes/ or local authority having jurisdiction. jurisdictions permit. In addition to NFPA 72,use the following location guidelines to 1. Pull wire through the electrical box and connect to the pLug-in optimize performance and reduce the chance of false alarms: terminal block supplied,one wire per terminal.See Figures 3 • Locate ceiling-mounted smoke detectors in the center of a and 5. room or hallway at least 4 inches(l Ocm)from any walls or 2. Dress wiring neatly and snap the terminal block into the back partitions. of the detector. • Locate wall-mounted smoke detectors so the top of the alarm Note is 4 to 12 inches(10 to 30cm)below the ceiling.See Figure 2. The detector cover must be closed completely,to sup- • When more than one detector is required,spacing of 30 feet port the circuit board,while installing the terminal (9m)may be used as a guide on smooth ceilings.Other block. spacing may be used depending on ceiling height,high air 3. Open the cover and mount the detector,using the mounting movement,and other conditions or response requirements. holes provided.See Figure 4. • Locate in a suitable environment as follows: Note -Temperature between 32°F(0°C)and 100°F(38°C) Positive air pressure from wire openings,conduit, -Humidity between 0 and 95%non-condensing mounting boxes,irregular mounting surfaces,or • Locate away from air conditioners,heating registers and any plenums causing air movement through and away from other ventilation source that may interfere with smoke the detector may prevent proper operation. Seal all entering the detector. openings causing unwanted air flow using UL Listed • Locate away from kitchens,wood stoves,garages,furnaces, expanding foam ar Duxseal. and bathrooms. 4. Remove the red plastic dust cover from the detector.The • Mount smoke detectars on a firm permanent surface, detectors are shipped with a dust cover for protection on typically a stud or metal runner. construction sites with dusty environments. 2 ESL 429/449 429 Series Wiring Diagram firstdetector ModeIs429AT,429C, Mode1429CRT lastdetector 429CT,429CST auxiliary notused power * Two-Wire Compatibility power contacts �; r� ����� Refer to ESL's Compatibiliry � + + Index for compatible control 8 m0 0e panel listings. Compatible Listed Control Unit* fire alarm r+ � End-of-Line initiating 1 circuit � Device 449 Series Wiring Diagram firstdetector Models449 Models449 Models449 lastdetector AT,C,CT,CST CRT,CSRT local non- CSRH' latching alarm auxiliary alarzn smokealarm heatsensor contact power contacts contacts power contacts contacts power �� �� ��. ���� ��� ���� - - ++ - - + + _ _ ++ * The 449CSRH units are smoke alarms with isolated heat detectors. Listed Control Unit red power DC + S power black Supervision — Unit circuit brown brown fire alarm ( initiating <l circuit End-of-Line Device Figure 5. Wiring Diagrams Supervision of System Wiring Smoke Test Power wiring in four-wire systems is required by NFPA 72 to be The units should be tested in place annually using one of the supervised.This is accomplished by installing a power supervi- following methods: sion relay at the end of the detectar power circuit.The contacts of A.Use Smoke! in a can°and follow the directions on the can. the supervision relay are wired in series with the system's alarm initiating circuit,and are closed when energized(see Figure 5). A B•Hold a smoldering punk or cotton wick close to the unit break in the detectar power circuit or a loss of power de-energiz.es and gently direct the smoke into the sinoke entry openings the power supervision relay,opening the contacts and causing a for 20 seconds or until an alarm is indicated. trouble annunciation at the fire alarm control unit. Be sure to proPerly extinguish the smoke source after ESL models 204-6 V and 204-12/24 V are relays UL Listed for testing!This is a go/no go test and is not a reliable indication of four-wire power supervision.Models 449CTE and 449CSTE are detector sensitivity.If it is successful,the LED will remain lit. smoke detectors with a built-in end-of-line power supervison To reset the detector,operate the system reset switch to remove relay,and can be used to supervise a circuit in place of a power power from the detectors.The control unit alarm and all supervison relay.The 449CTE and 449CSTE will also automati- auxiliary functions should be verified for a complete test of each cally send a trouble signal to the control panel whenever the detector. detector needs maintenance. Heat Test I nstal lation Test Models with heat sensors sample for heat every 3 seconds.Test After all connections are complete and the wiring is checked far heat sensors by using a hot air gun.Aim the gun at the heat errors,apply power to the system.There should be no alaim. If sensor from 6-10 inches(I S-25cin)away.The detector should go an alarm is reported,determine if a detectar is latched in alattn or into alarm in less than 30 seconds. if there is a problem with the wiring. ESL 429/449 3 Sensitivity Test optical block chamber 1. Hold the magnet on the hinge side of the unit for more than � Fo ��E one second(see Figure 7).The LED will flash 1 to 9 times. '� 2. Count the number of LED flashes,then use the following �o�Eeti� � table to determine if any action is necessary. � Flashes 0-1 Indication: Unservicable hardware fault. � / Action: Reset and rerun sensitivity test. If the � error persists,replace unit. �nde"tat�o" 2-3 Indication: Unitisbecominginsensitive. > R Action: Clean and reset the unit.Rerun / \ sensitivity test. If the error persists, snap into indentation replace the unit. oPt��ai base 4-7 Indication: Unit is within normal sensitivity range. Action: N/A Figure 6. Detector Maintenance 8-9 Indication: Unit is becoming too sensitive. Action: Verify the optical chamber is snapped down secwely.Clean the unit and replace the optical chamber. After the sequence of flashes,if the sensitivity is within limits and all other tests pass,the unit goes into alarm until reset by _—_ %==- �� the panel.If the sensitivity is not within limits,or an unservice- /,� ?/ able hardware fault is detected,the alarm LED will continue to ////� flash once per second until the unit is reset by the paneL � �� i ) � i Note � � CSRH models auto reset. ��' /��� �magnet �y'�_�'�- Figure 7. Sensitivity Testing Maintenance The smoke detectors are designed for easy field service and maintenance. If a detectar drifts beyond its approved sensitivity range for more than 24 hours,or fails internal diagnostic tests,the �pprOVa�S unit automatically indicates trouble by flashing its LED every second.This meets field sensitivity testing requirements without The smoke detectors are for use in commercial fire protective the need for external meters. signaling systems and in household fire warning systems (NFPA 72). Note 429/449 Series Connect to a power supply that will not automatically Listed by Underwriter's Laboratories;California State Fire reset.Since the self-diagnostics only indicate trouble Marsl�al approved(Listed#7272-0447-128);MEA approved after 27 hours, if the power supply automatically resets (New York City)(Listed#MEA 64-94-E)Factory Mutual every 24 hours the self-diagnostic indication will never approved. be signaled(the smoke detector will still signal alarm correctly). In accordance with NFPA 72,smoke detector sensitiviry should be checked within one year after installation and every alternate year thereafter,in commercial installations,or every three years in residential sites.See Sensitivity Te.rt. The detector's replaceable optical block chamber unsnaps for easy field cleaning and service.Whenever the status LED indicates cleaning is necessary,follow these steps: 1. Open the detector cover,unsnap and throw away d1e optical block chamber.See Figure 6. 2. Thoroughly blow off the optical base and snap a new optical block chamber(part#21 1)back in place. Note Be sure the new optical block chamber is seated all the way down. 3. Close the detector cover and verify sensitivity.See Sensitivity Test. 4 ESL 429/449 Planning for Emergencies Limited Warranty Develop a plan to prepare for emergency situations. Discuss and ESL is a brand of GE Security. The manufacturer warrants this rehearse your plan with everyone by doing a fire drill every few smoke detector to be free from defects in material and workman- months. shi}� under conditions of normal use for a term of 3 years from the date of manufacture. � WARNING During the warranty period, if a GE Security product or any of its Do not enter a building where sirens are sounding components becomes defective, it will be repaired or replaced witl�out charge. Guidelines Out-of-warranty units will be repaired at the discretion of the • Understand how to use your fire system. manufacturer or, if not, a card will be forwarded to the customer suggesting a replacement unit and the cost of that unit. • Know the normal state of doors and windows: open, closed, or locked. Tl�is warranty does not apply to units which have been subject to abuse, misuse, negligence or accident, or to which any modifica- • Escape fast! (Do not stop to pack.) tions, alterations or repairs have been made or attempted. • Use a different escape route if closed doors feel hot to tlle This warranty is extended only to the original purchaser of the touch. smoke detector and may be enforced only by such person. During • Crawl and hold your breath as much as possible to help reduce the warranty period, if the detector or any warranted components smoke inhalation during your escape. thereof becomes defective, it will be replaced or repaired without • Meet at a designated outdoor location. charge at the manufacturer's discretion if returned in accordance • Emphasize that no one should return to tlle premises if there is with the following instructions: a fire. Obtain a Return Authorization Number by calling 1-800-648-7422 • Notify the fire department from a phone in another building. or 503-692-4052, then carefully pack the detector in a well padded and insulated carton and return, postal charges prepaid to: Your Floor Plan When establishing your escape routes, consider the following guidelines: Customer Service RMA# • Have a drawing for each building level. GE Security • Show all exits (two exits per room are recommended). 12345 SW Leveton Drive • Show the location of stairwells and fire escapes. Tualatin, OR 97062-9938 • Show the location of all components of the fire system. • Show the locations of all fire extinguishers, hoses, ladders, ete. A note should be included advising the nature of the malfunetion. Care must be exercised in the proper packing of detectors returned under this warranty as GE Security will not be responsible for � WARNING warranty repairs to equipment damaged because of improper Smoke detectors CANNOT provide warnings for packing. fires resulting from explosions, smoking in bed or The above warranty is in lieu of a❑ other express warran- other furniture, ignition of flammable liquids, ties, and implied warranties of inerchantability and fitness vapors and gases, children playing with matches or for a particular purpose are limited iu duration for a period lighfers. of THREE years from the date of manufacture. Under uo circumstances shall manufacturer be liable to the pur- Warning! Limitations of Smoke chaser or any other person for incidental or consequential damages of any nature, including without limitation Deteetors damages for personal injury or damages to property, and Smoke detectors are very reliable, but may not work under all however occasioned, whether alleged as resulting from conditions. No smoke detector provides total protection of life or breach of warranty by manufacturer, the negligence of properry. Smoke detectors are not a substitute for life insurancc. manufacturer or otherwise. Manufacturer's liability will iu no event exceed the Purchase price of the product. Some Unreliable transmission or receiving of radio frequency states do not allow limitations on how long an implied (RF) signals may occur if the system is not installed, warranty lasts, or the exclusion or limitation of incidental located, serviced and repaired properly. RF signals sent by this or consequential damages, so the above limitations and detector may be blocked or reflcctcd by metal objects. Adjaccnt exclusions may not apply to you. Unless a longer period is dcvices or systcros using radio frequcncy signals may interferc with required by applicable law, any action against manufac- the operation of this alarm. Test the system often to be sure that turer in connectiou with this smoke detector must be signals are being sent and reccived properly. commenced within one year after the cause of action has Smoke detectors may not be heard. A sound sleeper or occurred. someone who has taken drugs or alcohol may not awaken if the No agent, employee or representative of the Manufacturer nor any detector is installed outside a bedroom. Closed or partially closed other person is authorized to modify this warranty in any respect. doors and distance can block sound. This detector is not designed Repair or replacement as stated above is the exclusive remedy of for the hearing impaired. the purchase hereunder. This warranty gives you specific legal Smoke detectors may not always activate and provide rights and you also have other rights wl�ich vary from state to warning early enough. Smoke detectors only acrivate when state. enough smoke reaches the detector. If a fire starts in a chimney, wall, roof, ou the other side of closed doors, or on a different level of the property enough smoke may not reach the detector far it to alarm. Smoke detectors are a significant help in reducing loss, injury and even death. However, no matter how good a detection device is, nothing works perfectly under every circumstance and we must warn you that you cannot expect a smoke detector to ensure that you will never suffer any damage or injury. ESL 429/449 5 Product Selection Guide Model Designator Series Wire Type Model Designator Power Designator Designator\ Features �� Number Descri tion Desi nator j Listing Desi nator Power 449CSRT 2 Two-wire onl 9 � UL A 6/12 VDC 4 Four-wire onl C 12/24 VDC WireType/ \powerDesignator Features Desi nator Feature Description E End-of-Line Power Built-in end-of-line relay that also acts as a sensitivity status output. For four-wire only. Fail-safe Supervisory and relay trips upon loss of power or if smoke detector is outside the approved sensitivity range for Sensitivity Status more than one day. End-of-line resistor is easily connected to terminal with no extra wiring,or Relay relay contacts can be connected to a separate trouble loop. H Isolated Fixed Temp. Isolated fixed 135°F(57°C)and rate-of-rise heat detector, independently trips the LED and alarm and Rate-of-Rise relay output. Smoke detector activates internal sounder(local alarm)and auxiliary relay, but does Heat Detector not latch.Approved as both single station smoke alarm and system heat detector. R Auxiliary Relay Used to activate other devices such as elevator recall, door holders, etc. UL Listed for releasing services. S Built-in Sounder 85db built-in sounder alarms when smoke is detected or when ower wirin olarit is reversed. T Integrated Fixed Temp. Integrated fixed 135°F (57°C)temp. and rate-of-rise heat detector offers double protection. and Rate-of-Rise Either heat detector or smoke detector can trip and latch LED and alarm relay outputs. Heat Detector Electrical Specifications Model 2-Wire -Wire in.Volt.Max.Volt. Max.Ripple Typ.Avg.Stby. Typ.Alarm Cur. Typ.Avg. Pol. Alarm Relay Other Relay (PK to PK) Cur.(12-24V) (12-24V) Rev.Cur. Contacts Contacts (V) (uA) (mA) (mA) (A) (A) 429AT * 6.5 20 10% 70 "see S09A - - - 429C " 8.5 33 10% 70 "see S10A - - - 429CT ' 8.5 33 10% 70 'see S10A - - - 429CRT ' 8.5 33 10% 70 'see S11A - - 2 429CST ' 8.5 33 10% 70 `see S11A 10 - - 449C " 8.5 33 10% 70 15 - 0.5 - 449CT " 8.5 33 10% 70 15 - 0.5 - 449CRT " 8.5 33 10% 70 31 - 0.5 - 449AT ' 5.1 27 10% 70 15 - 0.5 - 449CST ' 8.5 33 10% 70 40 10 0.5 - 449CSRT ' 8.5 33 10% 70 51 10 0.5 2 449CSRH"" " 8.5 33 10% 70 51 10 0.5 2 449CSTE " 8.5 33 10% 23mA 51 33 0.5 2 449CTE " 8.5 33 10% 23mA 31 23 0.5 2 Power Supervision Units Model Min.Volt. Max.Volt. Typ. Avg. Stby.Cur.(uA) Relay Contacts (A) 204-6V (UL Listed) 5.1 15 33mA @ 6VDC 0.5 204-12/24V UL Listed 8.5 33 14mA 12VDC,28mA 24VDC 0.5 Accessories SM-200 Smoke! in a can;R,canned smoke for functional testing of smoke detectors SM-EXT1 Smoke! in a can:» extension accessory 211 Replacement optical blocks(set of 10) 241 Terminal block for 4-wire smoke detectors 449CTE,449CSTE,449AT,449C,449CT,449CST "429 models draw up to a maximum of 60mA current if not limited by panel. ""449CSRH model is a smoke alarm with iso�ated heat detector. Certain items in the installation instructions are protected under one or more of the following patents: 5,546,074; 5,798,701; 5,821,666; 6,756,906 Specifications Operating temperature................... ...32°F to 100°F(0°C to 38°C) Heat detectar ..................fixed temp 135°F,50 foot(15m)spacing Operating humidity range....................... 0 to 95%non-condensing rate-of-rise 15°F/min> 105°F(8°C/min>41°C) Sounder specifications............................................ 85dB at 10 feet Auxiliary relay contacts........ 2A @ 28VDC or 120VAC(resistive) Field wiring size............................................................14-24 AWG Alarm contacts.................................. SOOmA @ 36VDC(resistive) Self-diagnostic indication.................. typically 27 hours after reset Dimensions.................6.1"(15.Scm)diameter x 1.9"(4.7cm)deep (do not connect power supply that resets every 24 hours) Weight.....................................................................8.8 oz.(0.25kg) Color.......................................................................................white GE Security USA&Canada:800-547-2556 12345 SW Levetan Drive Tech Support:800-648-7424 Tualatin,OR 97062 www.ge-security.com 503-692-4052 14153D/September 2004 [0 KNOX� Kr�ox-Boxo 3200 Series ServingFireDepartments5ince7975 LIFT-OFF �OOR MO�EL High Security Industrial/Government Key Box Recessed Mount U� with Face Flange FRONT VIEW -----—-- �� �� - CE 4 W�oE � -- ,- - _ , __�..,r ,�{ � 1/8"5tainle55 5teel } .. 1� � lock cover ��� � �� Hole for I �� HIGH - - tamper seal � .. �: . Surface Mount 1/2"5olid plate eteel door with gaeket The number one high-security KNOX-BOX°key box is used for 3200 Surface Mount most commercial applications including businesses, schools, government and public buildings,community associations and FRONT VIEW SIDE VIEW 7"WIDE apartment complexes. The 3200 Series KNOX-BOX with lift-off v4� 5teei�a5e, tloor holds keys,access cards and other small items necessary Fian e� ''� �ooi Weided 9 � for emergency access. �rece55ed model only) Features and Benefits � - � ��, • Holds up to 10 keys or 3 access cards in interior compartment "'�" � • Ensures high security with UL°Listed Metleco lock • Includes a Knox-Coat° proprietary finishing process that 3"°EE�� � protects Knox products up to fourtimes better than standard �, �� � � 7"x 7°flange— powder coat • Resists moist conditions with a weather resistant door gasket 3200 Recessed Mount • Colors: Black, Dark Bronze or Aluminum Weight: Surface mount- 8 Ibs. Recessed mount-9 Ibs. Options Ordering Specifications • Alarm tamper switches (UL Listed) To insure procurement and delivery of the 3200 Series KNOX-BOX, it is sug- Additional rust and Corrosion protection (Aluminization) 9ested that the follnwing specification paragraph be used: � KNOX-BOX surface/recessed mount with lift-off door,with/without UL Listed tamper switches. • Recessed Mounting Kit(RMK)for recessetl models only 1/4" plate steel housing, 1/2" thick steel door with interior gasket seal. Box and lock UL Listed. Lock has 1/8"thick stainless steel dust cover with tamper seal mounting capability. Exterior Dimensions: Surface mount-5"H x 4"W x 31/4"D Recessed mount-7"H x 7"W x 31/4"D Lock: UL Listed. Double-action rotating tumblers and hartlenetl steel pins accessetl by a biased cut key. Finish: Knox-Coat�proprietary finishing process Colors: Black,Dark Bronze or Aluminum P/N: 3200 Series KNOX-BOX(mfr's cat.ID) Mfr's Name: KNOX COMPANY KNOX COMPANY•1601 W.Deer Valley Road,Phoenix,AZ 85027 • (800)552-5669 • (623)687-2300 • Fax(623)687-2299 • Web:www.knoxbox.com • E-mail:info@knoxbox.com [0 KNOX° �nox-Box� 3200 Series ServingFireDepartments5ince7975 �IIIp�����f� Doo� RAODC� e AAo�q�Z��f-± D'A r±�A AA is is— �— e v� c �v� �v a3� i-e a.� r1 r v� Recessed Mounting Kit The 3200 Recessed Mounting Kit(RMK) is used Suggested minimum mounting height 6 feet above ground for recessed models only. It contains a shell housing and mounting hardware to be cast-in- opt�ona� place in new concrete or masonry construction. Rea r Ta m per La rg e Waeher 5w;t�h � After construction is completed, the KNOX-BOX mounts inside the recessed shell housing. The RMK may only be used in new concrete or 1 masonry construction. To building alarm 5y5tem opt;ona, Installation Door Tamper s`"'t�" Fasten the mounting kit to the inside wall of a Door� concrete form or set-in-place during masonry wall u5e 5i�e°Grade 5 or 8 F�an9e_ A construction. Connect the wiring contluit through fa5te"er5°r eaua� one of several knockout holes in the shell housing. Solid concrete wall Dimensions 3200 Series Surface Mount 3200 Series Recessed Mount 6-1/8"H x 6"W x 5"D, inclutling Rebar Figure A Front View of Rear Plate IMPORTANT: Care should be taken to insure that Rea r Ta m per �z-'�'6��� �5""t°""°'e the front of the RMK shell housing, including All mounting f h��e5 are��16" ; � �,a�� the cover plate antl screw heads, is flush with diameter _�X � X '� -�I � f the finish wall. The RMK must be plumbed to RearTamper �0 � 3/4" SW;t�h � insure vertical alignment of the vault. � Mounting Holes {p q� � t 5" Key Hooks Mounting HoleS �b5/16"�� 1-5/16" HIGH Alarm wire opening y I 3-1/4" , � � � HoleS marked"X"are X � X 3�4 Reeessed Mounting Using RMK 5hell i5 u5ed for mounting with �.- Q -. f Recessed Mounting Kit(RMKI mounted in wall 3/8°grade 5 or 8 during new 7/8" fa5tener5 or ec�ual I KNOX-BOX� conetruction 1-1/8" mount5 in5ide 1ZMK 5hell after Knockout5 2-5/16"� 7/8" � completion of for alarm 4"WIDE con5truction conduit Rebarfor tie-in to � wall Attention: KNOX-BOX° key box is a very strong device that MUST be mounted \ � � � — , Oo properly to ensure maximum security antl resist physical attack. � � � � Knox°Rapid Entry System � � The Knox Company manufacturers a complete line of high security products including / � / Knox-Box key boxes,key vaults,cabinets,key switches,padlocks,locking FDC caps �e�e55ed '\ and electronic master key security systems. For more information or technical Fiange assistance, please call Customer Service at 1-800-552-5669. Mount�ng 5tud5 provided in5ide RMK Concrete or 5hell to accommodate maeonry wall KNOX-BOX con5truction KNOX COMPANY•1601 W.Deer Valley Road,Phoenix,AZ 85027 • (800)552-5669 • (623)687-2300 • Fax(623)687-2299 • Web:www.knoxbox.com • E-mail:infoC�3knoxbox.com OO copyright 2005. Knox Company� MKT-KBSPEC-0020-A INSTALLATION AND MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS �`� s'ySTEM 'h�, ssoo series �` SENSOR' o Mechanical Heat Detector � Single Circuit• 5601P� 5602� 5603� 5604 iszs oi,�o n�e�,�e,st.cna�ies,m��,o;s�ov4 }' Dual Circuit• 5621 5622 5623 5624 i-aoo-seNSOaz,Fnx:�ao-a��-�4�s • f f f www.systemsensar.com Specifications: Operating Voltage/Contact Ratings (Resistive): 6-lZ5 VAC/3A 6-28 VDC/ lA 125 VDC/0.3A 250 VDC/O.lA Maximum Installafion Temperature: Models 5601P, 5603, 5621,and 5623: 100°F (38°C) Models 5602,5604, 5622,and 5624: 150°F (65.6°C) Alarm Temperature: Models 5601P, 5603, 5621,and 5623: 135°F(57°C) Models 5602,5604, 5622,and 5624: 194°F(90°C) Rate-of-Rise Threshold: 15°F (8.3°C) per minute (models 5601P,5602,5621,and 5622 only) Operating Humidity Range: 5 to 95% RH non-condensing Input Terminals: 14-22 AWG Back Box Mounting: 3'/z`octagonal 4"octagonal Single gang 4"square with a square to round plaster ring Dimensions with mounting bracket: Diameter:4.57 inches (11.6cm) Height 1.69 inches (4.3cm) Weight 6 oz. (170 grams) ACAUTION To prevent the activation of the fixed temperature element,the shipping and storage temperature must not exceed 122°F (50°C). Before Installing Markings on the exterior of the detector indicate the This detector must be installed in compliance with specific activation method and temperature rating.All the control panel installation manual and meet the models are identified as either]35°F/57°C or 194°F/ requirements of NFPA 72,and/ar the local authority 90°C. Models equipped with combination fixed tem- having jurisdiction. perature/rate-of-rise sensors are marked FX/ROR. Read this manual carefully before using the detec- Fixed temperature only models are marked FX. tor.This manual should be left with the owner/user Non-Resettable Fixed Temperature Sensor of this equipment. The fixed temperature element reacts to heat by re- General Description sponding to a specific temperature setting (135°F or 194°F). The detection method is based on the The 5600 series mechanical heat detector is in- spring action of a metal contact, held to the metal tended for use in property protection applications, chamber by a fusible alloy. When the temperature or for non-life-safety installations where smoke de- reaches the alloy's melring point, the metal contact tection is not practical or appropriate. will depress the diaphragm, causing the electrical AwaRNiNC contact to close the circait. The circular external heat collector is released from the detector to visu- For life-safety installations, smoke detectors must ally indicate that the detector has been activated. be used,in lieu of,or in addition to mechanical heat detectors. NOTE:5600 series Fixed Temperature models(5603, 5604, 5623, and 5624) are non-resettable, and can- The 5600 series consists of both single- and dual- not be tested. circuit heat detectors featuring fixed temperature thermal sensors or combination fixed temperature/ rate-of-rise sensors,with temperature ratings of 135°F (57°C) or 194°F(90°C). D500-46-00 1 66-2175-003R Table 1.5600 Series Mechanical Heat Detectors Model Temperature UL Maximum Spacing Circuit Thermal Sensor No. Rating (10-foot ceiling) 5601P Single 135°F (57°C) Fixed Temperatw�e/Rate of Rise 50-feet x 50-feet 5602 Single 194°F (90°C) Fixed Temperature/Rate of Rise 50-feet x 50-feet 5603 Single 135°F(57°C) Fixed Temperature 25-feet x 25-feet 5604 Single 194°F (90°C) Fixed Temperature 25-feet x 25-feet 562,1 Dual 135°F (57°C) Fixed Temperature/Rate of Rise 50-feet x 50-feet 5622 Dual 194°F (90°C) Fixed Temperature/Rate of Rise 50-feet x 50-feet 5623 Dual 135°F (57°C) Fixed Temperature 25-feet x 25-feet 5624 Dual 194°F (90°C) Fixed Temperature 25-feet x Z5-feet NOTE:Refer to NFPA72 guidelines for spacing reductions when ceiling heights exceed 10 feet. FM Classification RTI ratings are for installations which must comply with FM 3210. Heat Detector Type RTI Classification Fixed 135°F RTI: SPECIAL RoR and Fixed 135°F RTI: ULTRA FAST and SPECIAL(Respectively) Fixed 194°F RTI: SPECIAL RoR and Fixed 194°F RTI: ULTRA FAST and SPECIAL(Respectively) Self-Restoring Rate-of-Rise(ROR)Sensor Mounting Bracket The rate-of-rise element responds to a rapid rise of All 5600 series detectors are equipped with a mount- temperature, approximately 15°F (8.3°C) per min- ing bracket that includes mounting slots to accom- ute. As the temperature rises, the air within the modate single-gang,3'/z`octagonal,and 4"octagonal sealed chamber expands. Should the chamber air electrical boxes,as we11 as 4"square boxes equipped expa�d faster than it can escape through the cali- with a plaster ring(Figure 1).The mounting bracket brated vent, the diaphragm is depressed, and the is reversible to accommodate flush-mount and sur- electrical contact closes the circuit. face-mount installations (Figure 2). NOTE: Only the ROR element of 5600 series com- W�ring Installation Guidelines bination fixed temperature/ROR models (5601P, All wiring must be installed in compliance with the 5G02,56z1,and 5622) are self-restoring,and may be National Electrical Code, applicable state and local tested using a hair dryer or heat gun. When testing codes, and any special requirements of the loca] the ROR element, to prevent the activation of the Authority Having Jurisdiction. Proper wire gauges fixed temperature element,the heat source must not should be used. The conductors used to connect exceed the fixed temperature rating of the detector. heat detectors to the alarm control panel and ac- cessory devices should be color-coded to reduce the Figure 1.Braeket Mounting Locations: Figure 2.Reversible Mounting Bracket: � A=3%"'Octagonal box p B=4"Octagonal box A C=Single gang box and 4'" s'urfaC@�m�unt square with plaster ring � D=Directry to Wall/Ceiling 50114-00 B4 B� � / �°c��, Flush-mount c n ��; D � S011 3-00 SO115-00 D500-46-00 2 66-2175-003R likelihood of wiring errors. Improper connections Installation can prevent a system from responding properly in Remove power from the alarm control unit or i�iti- the event of a fire. ating device circuits before installing detectors. The non-polarized screw terminals on the back of 1. Detach the detector from the mounting bracket by the detector will accept 14-22 AWG wire. For best rotating the detector 1/4 turn counter-clockwise. system performance, all wiring should be installed 2 prient the mounting bracket properly for either a in separate grounded conduit;do not mix fire alarm flush-or surface-mount installation(Figure 2). system wiring in the same conduit as any other 3. Select the pair of mounting holes suitable for the electrical wiring. Twisted pair may be used to pro- junction box, (Figure 1) and secure the bracket vide additional protection against extraneous elec- to the box. trical interference. 4. Connect the wires to the detector per Figure 3 or Wire connections are made by stripping approxi- Figure 4,as applicable. mately'/4`of the insulation from the end of the feed 5. Place the detector onto the mounting bracket by wire, inserting it into the proper base terminal, and rotating clockwise. The detector will lock into tightening the screw to secure the wire in place. place with a"click°. 6. After all detectors have been installed, apply power to the alarm control unit. 7. Test each detector as described in Testing. Figure 3.Wiring Diagram-Single Circuit Models: g. Reset all the detectors at the alarm control unit. Control 9. Notify the proper authorities that the system is Panel in operation. + EOL OR Auxiliary Device sozs�-oo Figure 4.Wiring Diagram-Dual Ci�cuit Models: Control Panel + � Auxiliary � Auxiliary EOL b Device b Device OR Auxiliary Auxiliary Device Device 50240-00 D500-46-00 3 66-2175-003R Testing/Maintenance AWARNING The rate-of-rise mechanism may be subject to re- When tesring the ROR element, to prevent the ac- duced sensitivity over time. Annual testing of the tivation of the fixed temperature element, the heat rate-of-rise operation is therefore recommended. source must not exceed the fixed temperature rating Before tesfing, nofify the proper authorities that of the detector. maintenance is being performed and the system will be temporarily out of service. Disable the zone or QWARNING system undergoing maintenance to prevent any un- wanted alarms. 5600 series fixed temperature models (5603>5604, 5623, and 5624) are non-resettable, and cannot Only the ROR element of 5600 series combination be tested. fixed temperature/ROR models (5601P, 5602, 5621, and 5622) are self-restoring, and may be tested us- ing a hair dryer or heat gun. AcnurioN When using the RRS-MOD with model 2WTA-B, do not mix the 2WTA-B with other model smoke de- tectors and dry contact closure devices, including mechanical heat detectors,manual pull stations and waterflow switches. Such mixing can cause a direct short on the auxiliary power terminals, damaging the control panel's internal circuitry and/or damage devices connected to the initiating device circuit. Please refer to insert for the Limitations of Fire Alarm Systems Three-Year Limited Warranty System Sensor warrants its enclosed product to be Departmen[, RA u , 3825 Ohio Aventte, St. free from defects in materials and workmanship under Charles, IL 60174. Please include a note describing normal use and service for a period of three years from the malfunction and suspected cause of failure. The date of manufacture. System Sensor makes no other Company shall not be obligated to replace units which express warranty for the enclosed product. No agent, are found to be defective because of damage, unrea- representative, dealer, or employee of the Company sonable use, modifications, or alterations occurring has the authority to increase oi alter the obligations or after the date of manufacture. in no case shall the limitations of this Warranty.The Company's obligation Company be liable for any consequential or incidental of this Warranry shall be limited ro the replace�nent of damages for breach of this or any other Warranty, ex- any part of the product which is found to be defeo- pressed or implied whatsoever,even if the loss or dam- tive in materials or workmanship under ❑ormal use age is caused by the Company's negligence or fault. and service during the three year period commencing Some states do not allow the exclusion or limitation with the date of manufacture. After phoning System of incidental or consequential damages, so the above Sensor's toll free number 800-SENSOR2 (736-767�) ]imitation or exclusion may not apply to you. Tliis for a Return Authorization ❑umber, send defective Warranty gives you specific legal rights, and you may u�its postage prepaid to: System Sensor, Returns also have other rights which vary from state to state. FCC Statement This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules.Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1)This device may�ot cause harmful i�terfere�ce,and (2)this device must accept any interference received,including interfere�ce that may cause undesired operation. NOTE:This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules.These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful inierference in a residential installation.This equipment generates,uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and,if not installed and used in ac- cordance with the instructions,may cause harmful interference to radio communications.However,there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installa[ion. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception,which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,the user is encouraged ro try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: -Reorien[or relocate the receivi�g antenna. -Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. -Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. -Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technicia�for help. D500-46-00 4 I56-2175-003R �2009 System Sensor �� SYSTEM .__ . _ :rd � SENSOR° ;�; � � �_� � - -_ -_ . . �--�� -- - - � M�n�-Horns -:.�,.� � __-�_�_ -� � -�=-�_- -� -� � � The SpectrAlert°Advance series of mini-horn sounders are �_� �— ���-ti --� designed to simplify installations to provide primary and _ - - � - -- - �� - - - -- secondary signaling for fire and security applications. �`+,, C�� SPECTR�ert A � V A N C E Features The MHR and MHW mini-horns operate at 12 and 24 volts and are ideal for hotel, motel or residential fire system applications,where a • 12 and 24V operation smaller notification device is desired.The mini-horns offer high and • High and low volume settings low volume settings,and temporal or non-temporal tones. The horns • Temporal and non-temporal tones can be mounted to single gang back boxes for aesthetically sensitive Mounts to singie gang back box applications. Synchronization is also provided when using the � MDL module. • Compatible with MDL sync module • Mechanically and electrically compatible with PA400 series The MHR and MHW mini-horns can operate between 32 and 120 Mini-AlertT'"sounders degrees Fahrenheit from a regulated DC or full-wave rectified, unfiltered power supply.They are listed to Underwriter's Laboratories • Listing for ceiling or wall mounting Standard UL 464 for fire protective signaling systems. Agency Listings U ���� o L F M I I I�+ l=��J=/ IJ Llr �k w LISTED APPROVED 54011 3028007 CS1099 7135-1653:196 SpectrAlert°Advance Mini-Horn Specifications Mini-horns shall be a System Sensor Model MHR or MHW capable of operating at nominal 12 or 24VDC and shall mount to a deep single gang back box.Mini-horn shall be listed to Underwriter's Laboratories Standard UL464 for fire protective signaling systems.Mini-horns shall operate between 32 and 120 degrees Fahrenheit from a regulated DC,or full-wave rectified, unfiltered power supply.When used with the Sync•Circuit'M Module, 12-volt rated notification appliance circuit outputs shall operate between nine and 17.5 volts;24-volt rated notification appliance circuit outputs shall operate between 17 and 33 volts. Dimensions 4.6"L x 2.9"W x .45"D Weight 2.67 oz. Operating Temperature Range 32°F to 120°F(0°C to 49°C) Mounting Surface:deep single-gang back box(23/a'"deep) Flush:Standard 4""x 4""back box with single gang mud ring,which allows sufficient clearance for conduit entrance. .- InputTerminals 12 to 18 AWG Nominal Voltage Regulated 12DC/FWR or regulated 24DC/FWR Operating Voltage 8-33 Operating Voltage with MDL 9-33 UL Sound Output and Current Draw Data . Switch Setting Pattern Output Level 8-17.5 VDC 8-17.5 VFWR Nominal 12 Nominal 12 16-33 16-33 VDC VFWR VDC VFWR 1 Temporal High 68 67 71 70 78 76 2 Temporal Low 66 65 69 68 76 75 3 Non- High 72 71 75 74 80 79 temporal 4 Non- Low 70 69 73 72 78 77 temporal _ � 8-17.5 Volts 16-33 Volts Switch Position Sound Pattern Volume DC FWR DC FWR 1 Temporal High 12 10 17 15 2 Temporal Low 10 9 14 13 3 Non-temporal High 22 17 29 25 4 Non-temporal Low 17 13 21 19 Ordering Information .- MHR Mini-Horn,Red MHW Mini-Horn,White l\��� �STEM 002012 System Sensor. �� 1 ✓ 3825 Ohio Avenue•St.Charles, IL 60174 P�oducts�ecit�icationssubjeatochanyewahoutnotice,Visitsystemse�soccom ��y� SE/VSORr Phone:800-SENSOR2•Fax:630-377-6495 forcurrentproductinto�mation,mdudmgme�atestve�sionofmisdatasheet. AVDS01500•3112 �� SYSTEM ��� SENSOR° _ _ � -- -- C01224T and C01224TR - • � I � - Carbon Monoxide � - �� � Detectors �� . . with RealTest°Technology ,� , � � -��- The System Sensor C01224T and C01224TR(round) - - , � __ t ��. Carbon Monoxide(CO)Detectors use a highly accurate and reliable electrochemical sensing cell to provide early �, ,�' warning of dangerous CO levels. Features With RealTest�technology,the CO gas sensing cell used in the C01224T and C01224TR CO detectors can be tested using a • ReaiTestOO enables a functional test using canned CO CO gas agent,fully meeting the requirements of NFPA 720:2009. • Full compliance with UL 2075 Simply put the detector into RealTest mode, spray a small amount • A code-required trouble relay of CO into the detector per the installation instructions,and within seconds the detector will alarm, indicating successful gas entry. (See • Wiring supervision with SEMS terminals the reverse page or the user manual for complete instructions.) • A six-year end-of-life timer • 12/24 VDC When dangerous amounts of CO are detected,the C01224T and A low current draw of 20 mA in standby and 40 mA in alarm C01224TR detectors alert residents by sounding and flashing a � temp 4 signal alarm.With 24/7 central station monitoring, residents • Versatile mounting for wall and ceiling are guaranteed protection whether they are away from home, • Accurate and reliable electrochemical sensing technology sleeping,or already suffering from the effects of CO. • Optional CO-PLATE CO Detector Replacement Plate to upgrade The C01224T and C01224TR are designed for system operation. previously installed competitor detectors to the C01224T These detectors are fully listed to UL 2075 and offer a code- required trouble relay to send a sensor failure or end-of-life signal to the control panel and the central station.The C01224T and C01224TR also use SEMS-type terminal Philips head screws for quicker and more positive wiring connections and code-required wiring supervision.With a low current draw,these detectors enable more devices to be connected to the panel, limiting the need to purchase extra power supplies or more expensive paneis.As 12/24 VDC detectors,the C01224T and C01224TR will operate on most industry security and fire alarm control panels. Agency Listings ��.�� ��� oL l���i �L� ��K LISTED �� F307195 E304075 5276-1653�0194 C01224T and C01224TR Carbon Monoxide Detector Specifications Carbon monoxide(CO)detector shall be a system-connected System Sensor model number C01224T or C01224TR listed to Underwriters Laboratories UL 2075 for Gas and Vapor Detectors and Sensors.The detector shall be equipped with a sounder and a trouble relay.The detector's base shall be able to mount to a single-gang electrical box or direct(surface)mount to the wall or ceiling.Wiring connections shall be made by means of SEMS screws.The detector shall provide dual-color LED indication that blinks to indicate normal standby,alarm,or end-of-life.When the sensor supervision is in a trouble condition,the detector shall send a trouble signal to the panel.When the detector gives a trouble or end-of-life signal,the detector shall be replaced.The detector shall provide a means to test CO gas entry into the CO sensing cell.The detector shall provide this with a test mode that accepts CO gas from a test agent and alarms immediately upon sensing CO entry.The detector shall perform in the detection of CO up to 12,000 feet above sea level and alarm within the time specified by ANSI/UL 2034 for CO concentrations of 70, 150 and 400 parts per million(ppm), as verified by a Nationally Recognized Test Laboratory. Operating Voltage 12/24 VDC Audible Signal 85 dB in alarm Standby Current 20 mA Alarm Current 40 mA(75 mA test) Alarm Contact Ratings 0.5 A@ 30 VDC Trouble Contact Ratings 0.5 A@ 30 VDC Size:C01224T Length:5.1 in,Width: 3.3 in,Height: 1.3 in C01224TR Diameter:6 in, Height: 1.3 in Approximate Weight C01224T:7 oz;C01224TR: 11 oz Operating Temperature Range 32°F to 104°F(0°C to 40°C) Operating Humidity Range 22 to 90%RH InputTerminals 14 to 22 AWG Mounting Single-gang back box;surface mount to wall or ceiling Operation Modes .. . . Normal(standby) Blink 1 per minute — — Alarm — Blink in temp 4 pattern Sound in temp 4 pattern RealTest°Feature: The System Sensor C01224T and C01224TR Carbon Monoxide Detectors with RealTest enable evaluation of the functionality of the CO sensing cell using a canned CO test agent. �s,:= __ � � I . � � � � . Push and hold the Test/Hush button for Spray canned CO agent into Verify CO sensing at the two seconds to enter RealTest mode.The the detector. control panel.The detector will green LED will flash once every second automatically exit RealTest alarm to indicate RealTest mode has started. mode after about 20-60 seconds. NOTE:Check with local codes and the ANJ to determine if a functional gas test is desired for an installation. Hush Feature: Pushing the Test/Hush button will silence the sounder for 5 minutes(except in RealTest mode). Trouble Feature: When the detector is in a trouble condition, it will send a trouble signal to the panel. End-of-Life Timer: After the detector's internal sensor has reached the end of its life,a trouble signal will be sent to the panel to indicate it is time to replace the detector.An electrochemical CO detector lifespan is about six years.The detector must be replaced by the date marked on the inside of the product. CO-PLATE: System Sensor also offers the CO-PLATE CO Detector Replacement Plate to cover the footprint(when � _ � necessary)of previously installed competitive carbon monoxide detectors that require replacement. Ordering Information co P�ArE .- C01224T 12/24 volt,4-wire system-monitored carbon monoxide detector with RealTestO Technology C01224TR 12/24 volt,4-wire system-monitored round carbon monoxide detector with RealTestO Technology CO-PLATE CO detector replacement plate to cover the footprint of previously installed competitive detectors as necessary �� �/STEM 3825 Ohio Avenue•St.Charles, IL 60174 ozo,zsYSCemsenso�. I Phone:800-SENSOR2•Fax:630-377-6495 P�oducts�eciticationssubjecttocha�gewrthoutnotice Visitsystemsenso�com � �Cw/�O�� for current product intormation,induding the latest version of this data sheet. ��V www.systemsensor.com SCD500100•4/12 �� SYSTEM ��� SENSOR� � � � � � � �� � -�� _a � , '��� o ��k Selectable-Output � � �� ' Horns, Strobes, and , ��.�,� Horn Strobes � _ � SpectrAlert°Advanceselectable-outputhorns,strobes, � '���' and horn strobes are rich with features guaranteed to cut installation times and maximize profits. SPECTf��C� A � V A N E Features The SpectrAlert Advance series offers the most versatile and •Plug-in design with minimal intrusion into the back box easy-to-use line of horns,strobes,and horn strobes in the industry. •Tamper-resistant construction With white and red plastic housings,wall and ceiling mounting options,and plain and FIRE-printed devices,SpectrAlert Advance can •Automatic selection of 12-or 24-volt operation at 15 and 15/75 meet virtually any application requirement. candela •Field-selectable candela settings on wall and ceiling units:15, 15/75, Like the entire SpectrAlert Advance product line,horns,strobes, 30,75,95,1 10,1 15,135,150,177,and 185 and horn strobes include a variety of features that increase their •Horn rated at 88+dBA at 16 volts application versatility while simplifying installation.All devices •Rotary switch for hom tone and three volume selections feature plug-in designs with minimal intrusion into the back box,which make installations fast and foolproof while virtually •Universal mounting plate for wall and ceiling units eliminating costly and time-consuming ground faults.Furthermore, •Mounting plate shorting spring checks wiring continuity before a universal mounting plate with an onboard shorting spring tests device installation wiring continuity before the device is installed,protecting devices •Electrically compatible with existing SpectrAlert products from damage. •Compatible with MDL sync module In addition,field-selectable candela settings,automatic selection of 12-or 24-volt operation,and a rotary switch for horn tones with three volume selections enables installers to easily adapt devices to suit a wide range of application requirements. Agency Listings '-=��;;�..�,� SIGNALING I(��,��1 O �� � o� F M MEA `'� a roved �,zs-�bsa�8e���,�oo�s«o�es� LISTED aarAOVeo PP �izs-ies3:�aamo�nsc����s, 540'l(chimes,ho:nstrobes,horn) 3023577 MEA452-OS-E chlrnesvobes) SSSl7(sttobes) 7135-1653:189(homs,chirnes) SpectrAlert Advance Specifications General SpectrAlert Advance horns,strobes,and horn strobes shall mount to a standard 4 x 4 x 1�/z-inch back box,4-inch octagon back box,or double-gang back box.Two-wire products shall also mount to a single-gang 2 x 4 x 1'/s-inch back box.A universal mounting plate shall be used for mounting ceiling and wall products.The notification appliance circuit wiring shall terminate at the universal mounting plate.Also,SpectrAlert Advance products,when used with the SynoCircuit"Module accessory,shall be powered from a non-coded notification appliance circuit output and shall operate on a nominal 12 or 24 volts. When used with the SynaCircult Module,12-volt-rated notification appliance circuit outputs shall operate between 9 and 17.5 volts,24-volt-rated notification appliance circuit outputs shall operate between 17 and 33 volts.Indoor SpectrAlert Advance products shall operate between 32 and 120 degrees Fahrenheit from a regulated DC or full-wave rectified unfiltered power supply.Strobes and horn strobes shall have field-selectable candela settings induding 15,15/75,30, 75,95,1 10,115,135,150,177,and 185. Strobe The strobe shall be a System Sensar SpectrAlert Advance Model listed to UL 1971 and shall be approved for fire protective serviceThe strobe shall be wired as a primary signaling noiification appliance and comply with the Americans with Disabilities Act requirements for visible signaling appliances,flashing at 1 Hz over the strobe's entire operating voltage range.The strobe light shall consist of a xenon flash tube and associated lens/reflector system. Horn Strobe Combination The horn strobe shall be a System Sensor SpectrAlert Advance Model listed to UL 1971 and UL 464 and shall be approved for fire protective service.The horn strobe shall be wired as a primary-signaling notification appliance and comply with the Americans with Disabilities Act requirements for visible signaling appliances,flashing at 1 Hz over the strobe's entire operating voltage range.The strobe light shall consist of a xenon flash tube and associated lens/reflector system.The horn shall have three audibility options and an option to switch between a temporal three-pattern and a non-temporal(continuous)pattern.These options are set by a multiple position switch.On four-wire products,the strobe shall be powered independently of the sounder.The horn on horn strobe models shall operate on a coded or non coded power supply. Synchronization Module The module shall be a System Sensor Sync•Circuit model MDL listed to UL 464 and shall be approved for fire protective service.The module shall synchronize SpectrAlert strobes at 1 Hz and horns at temporal three.Also,while operating the strobes,the module shall silence the horns on horn strobe models over a single pair of wires.The module shall mount to a 4"/,e x 4"/,6 x 2'/a-inch back box.The module shall also control two Style Y(dass B)circuits or one Style Z (dass A)circuitThe module shall synchronize multiple zones.Daisy chaining two or more synchronization modules together will synchronize all the zones they control.The module shall not operate on a coded power supply. Standard Operating Temperature 32°F to 120°F(0°C to 49°q Humidity Range 10 to 93%non-condensing Strobe Flash Rate 1 flash per second Nominal Voltage Regulated 12 DC/FWR or regulated 24 DC/FWR' Operating Voltage Rangez 8 to 175V(12V nominaq or 16 to 33 V(24V nominaD InputTerminal Wire Gauge 12 to 18 AWG Ceiling-Mount Dimensions(induding lens) 6.8""diameter x 2.S"high(173 mm diameter x 64 mm high) Wall-Mount Dimensions(induding lens) 5.6""L x 4.7""W x 2.5`D(142 mm L x 119 mm W x 64 mm D) Horn Dimensions 5.6"'L x 4.7""W x 13`D(142 mm L x 119 mm W x 33 mm D) Wall-Mount Back Box Skirt Dimensions(BBS-2,BBSW-2) 5.9""L x 5.0"W x Z2`D(151 mm L x 128 mm W x 56 mm D) Ceiling-Mount Back Box Skirt Dimensions(BBSG2,BBSCW-2) 7.1""diameter x 2.2`high(180 mm diameter x 57 mm high) Wall-Mount Trim Ring Dimensions(sold as a 5 pack)(TR-HS,TRW-HS) 5.7"'L x 4.8""W x 035"D(145 mm L x 122 mm W x 9 mm D) Ceiling-MountTrim Ring Dimensions(sold as a 5 pack)(TRGHS,TRCW-HS) 6.9""diameter x 03S"high(175 mm diameter x 9 mm high) Notes: L Full Wave Rectified(FWR)voltage is a non-regulated,time-varying power source that is used on some power supply and panel outputs. 2.P,S,PC,and SC products will operate at 12 V nominal only for 15 and 15/75 cd. A05-0395-007 UL Current Draw Data � � 8-17.5 Volts 16-33 Volts 8-17.5 Volts 16-33 Volts Candela DC FWR DC FWR Sound Pattern d6 DC FWR DC FWR Standard 15 123 128 66 71 Temporal High 57 55 69 75 Candela Range 15/75 142 148 77 81 Temporal Medium 44 49 58 69 30 NA NA 94 96 Temporal Low 38 44 44 48 75 NA NA 158 153 Non-temporal High 57 56 69 75 95 NA NA 181 U6 Non-temporal Medium 42 50 60 69 110 NA NA 202 195 Non-temporal Low 41 44 50 50 115 NA NA 210 205 Coded High 57 55 69 75 High 135 NA NA 228 207 Coded Medium 44 51 56 69 Candela Range 150 NA NA 246 220 Coded Low 40 46 52 50 177 NA NA 281 251 185 NA NA 286 258 - � - 8-17.5 Volts 16-33 Volts DClnput 15 15/75 15 15/75 30 75 95 110 115 Temporal High 137 147 79 90 107 176 194 212 218 Temporal Medium 132 144 69 80 97 157 182 201 210 Temporal Low 132 143 66 77 93 154 179 198 207 Non Temporal High 141 152 91 100 116 176 201 221 229 Non Temporal Medium 133 145 75 85 102 163 187 207 216 Non Temporal Low 131 144 68 79 96 156 182 201 210 FWR Input Temporal High 136 155 88 97 112 168 190 210 218 Temporal Medium 129 152 78 88 103 160 184 202 206 Temporal Low 129 151 76 86 101 160 184 194 201 Non Temporal High 142 161 103 112 126 181 203 221 229 Non Temporal Medium 134 155 85 95 110 166 189 208 216 Non Temporal Low 132 154 80 90 105 161 184 202 211 . 16-33 Volts 16-33 Volts DClnput 135 150 177 185 FWRlnput 135 150 177 185 Temporal High 245 259 290 297 Temporal High 215 231 258 265 Temporal Medium 235 253 288 297 Temporal Medium 209 224 250 258 Temporal Low 232 251 282 292 Temporal Low 207 221 248 256 Non-Temporal High 255 270 303 309 Non-Temporal High 233 248 275 281 Non-Temporal Medium 242 259 293 299 Non-Temporal Medium 219 232 262 267 Non-Temporal Low 238 254 291 295 Non-Temporal Low 214 229 256 262 Horn Tones and Sound Output Data . 8-17.5 16-33 24-Volt Nominal Switch Volts Volts Reverberant Anechoic Position Sound Pattern d6 DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR DC FWR 1 Temporal High 78 78 84 84 88 88 99 98 2 Temporal Medium 74 74 80 80 86 86 96 96 3 Temporal Low 71 73 76 76 83 80 94 89 4 Non Temporal High 82 82 88 88 93 92 100 100 5 Non Temporal Medium 78 78 85 85 90 90 98 98 6 Non Temporal Low 75 75 81 81 88 84 96 92 7' Coded High 82 82 88 88 93 92 101 101 8' Coded Medium 78 78 85 85 90 90 97 98 9' Coded Low 75 75 81 81 88 85 96 92 �Settings 7,8,and 9 are not available on 2 wire horn strobe. A05-0395-007 SpectrAlert Advance Dimensions �4.7" 25" _ 6.8" Dia. ��,e... � 5 ,� , � __ � ��a _.,� /; � � � a� � �� � 0 ' � / _s---�___1- ' , I 2.5' 5.6` 7.`' �� �'�,.`.....,�� — a ' � Wall-mount horn strobes Ceiling-mount horn strobes 7.1" I'-2.25� 5.05'� �«223�I Dia. � I I OOo� a OOo�C� 5.95" 0 0 0 � o � � � ° � � Wall back box skirt Ceiling back box skirt SpectrAlert Advance Ordering Information •- �- Wall Horn Strobes Ceiling Strobes P2R*' 2-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd$,Red SCR Strobe,Standard cd,Red P2RH* 2-Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,Red SCRH Strobe,High cd,Red P2Wx 2-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,White SCW* Strobe,Standard cd,White P2WH* 2-Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,White SCWH Strobe,High cd,White P4R* 4-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,Red Horns P4RH 4-Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,Red HR Horn,Red P4W 4Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,White HW Horn,White Wall Strobes Accessories SR*' Strobe,Standard cd,Red BBS-2 Back Box Skirt,Wall,Red SRH*' Strobe,High cd,Red BBSW-2 Back Box Skirt,Wall,White SW�` Strobe,Standard cd,White BBSC-2 Back Box Skirt,Ceiling,Red SWH' Strobe,High cd,White BBSCW-2 Back Box Skirt,Ceiling,White Ceiling Horn Strobes TR-HS Trim Ring,Wall,Red PQR� 2-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,Red TRW-HS Trim Ring,Wall White PQRH 2-Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,Red TRC-HS Trim Ring,Ceiling,Red PCZW*' 2-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,White TRCW HS Trim Ring,Ceiling,White PC2WH* 2-Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,White PC4R 4-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,Red PC4RH 4Wire Horn Strobe,High cd,Red PC4W 4-Wire Horn Strobe,Standard cd,White Notes: *Add"-P"to model numberfor plain housing(no°FIRE°marking on cover),e.g.,P2R-P. t Add"-SP"to model number for°FUEGO"marking on cover,e.g.,P2R-SP. #"Standard cd"refers to strobes that indude 15,15/75,30,75,95,110,and 115 candela settings."High cd°refers to strobes that indude 135,150,177,and 185 candela settings. �� SYSTEM ozoo�s,,em sen=o�. 3825�h10 f�V2YlUe•St.�{ldY�eS,��6�174 ?roductspe6�ca�onssub�rcttorn gcwithoutnotrce.uis�sysremsensor.comfor ��� �����R Ph0112:8��-SENS�RZ•FdX:63�-3��-6495 curcen[produc[Inforrna[ion,�mduding[helarestversionotthlsdatasheet A05-0395-007•4/09•II2132